/usr/share/doc/debian-policy/policy-1.html is in debian-policy 3.9.8.0.
This file is owned by root:root, with mode 0o644.
The actual contents of the file can be viewed below.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
127
128
129
130
131
132
133
134
135
136
137
138
139
140
141
142
143
144
145
146
147
148
149
150
151
152
153
154
155
156
157
158
159
160
161
162
163
164
165
166
167
168
169
170
171
172
173
174
175
176
177
178
179
180
181
182
183
184
185
186
187
188
189
190
191
192
193
194
195
196
197
198
199
200
201
202
203
204
205
206
207
208
209
210
211
212
213
214
215
216
217
218
219
220
221
222
223
224
225
226
227
228
229
230
231
232
233
234
235
236
237
238
239
240
241
242
243
244
245
246
247
248
249
250
251
252
253
254
255
256
257
258
259
260
261
262
263
264
265
266
267
268
269
270
271
272
273
274
275
276
277
278
279
280
281
282
283
284
285
286
287
288
289
290
291
292
293
294
295
296
297
298
299
300
301
302
303
304
305
306
307
308
309
310
311
312
313
314
315
316
317
318
319
320
321
322
323
324
325
326
327
328
329
330
331
332
333
334
335
336
337
338
339
340
341
342
343
344
345
346
347
348
349
350
351
352
353
354
355
356
357
358
359
360
361
362
363
364
365
366
367
368
369
370
371
372
373
374
375
376
377
378
379
380
381
382
383
384
385
386
387
388
389
390
391
392
393
394
395
396
397
398
399
400
401
402
403
404
405
406
407
408
409
410
411
412
413
414
415
416
417
418
419
420
421
422
423
424
425
426
427
428
429
430
431
432
433
434
435
436
437
438
439
440
441
442
443
444
445
446
447
448
449
450
451
452
453
454
455
456
457
458
459
460
461
462
463
464
465
466
467
468
469
470
471
472
473
474
475
476
477
478
479
480
481
482
483
484
485
486
487
488
489
490
491
492
493
494
495
496
497
498
499
500
501
502
503
504
505
506
507
508
509
510
511
512
513
514
515
516
517
518
519
520
521
522
523
524
525
526
527
528
529
530
531
532
533
534
535
536
537
538
539
540
541
542
543
544
545
546
547
548
549
550
551
552
553
554
555
556
557
558
559
560
561
562
563
564
565
566
567
568
569
570
571
572
573
574
575
576
577
578
579
580
581
582
583
584
585
586
587
588
589
590
591
592
593
594
595
596
597
598
599
600
601
602
603
604
605
606
607
608
609
610
611
612
613
614
615
616
617
618
619
620
621
622
623
624
625
626
627
628
629
630
631
632
633
634
635
636
637
638
639
640
641
642
643
644
645
646
647
648
649
650
651
652
653
654
655
656
657
658
659
660
661
662
663
664
665
666
667
668
669
670
671
672
673
674
675
676
677
678
679
680
681
682
683
684
685
686
687
688
689
690
691
692
693
694
695
696
697
698
699
700
701
702
703
704
705
706
707
708
709
710
711
712
713
714
715
716
717
718
719
720
721
722
723
724
725
726
727
728
729
730
731
732
733
734
735
736
737
738
739
740
741
742
743
744
745
746
747
748
749
750
751
752
753
754
755
756
757
758
759
760
761
762
763
764
765
766
767
768
769
770
771
772
773
774
775
776
777
778
779
780
781
782
783
784
785
786
787
788
789
790
791
792
793
794
795
796
797
798
799
800
801
802
803
804
805
806
807
808
809
810
811
812
813
814
815
816
817
818
819
820
821
822
823
824
825
826
827
828
829
830
831
832
833
834
835
836
837
838
839
840
841
842
843
844
845
846
847
848
849
850
851
852
853
854
855
856
857
858
859
860
861
862
863
864
865
866
867
868
869
870
871
872
873
874
875
876
877
878
879
880
881
882
883
884
885
886
887
888
889
890
891
892
893
894
895
896
897
898
899
900
901
902
903
904
905
906
907
908
909
910
911
912
913
914
915
916
917
918
919
920
921
922
923
924
925
926
927
928
929
930
931
932
933
934
935
936
937
938
939
940
941
942
943
944
945
946
947
948
949
950
951
952
953
954
955
956
957
958
959
960
961
962
963
964
965
966
967
968
969
970
971
972
973
974
975
976
977
978
979
980
981
982
983
984
985
986
987
988
989
990
991
992
993
994
995
996
997
998
999
1000
1001
1002
1003
1004
1005
1006
1007
1008
1009
1010
1011
1012
1013
1014
1015
1016
1017
1018
1019
1020
1021
1022
1023
1024
1025
1026
1027
1028
1029
1030
1031
1032
1033
1034
1035
1036
1037
1038
1039
1040
1041
1042
1043
1044
1045
1046
1047
1048
1049
1050
1051
1052
1053
1054
1055
1056
1057
1058
1059
1060
1061
1062
1063
1064
1065
1066
1067
1068
1069
1070
1071
1072
1073
1074
1075
1076
1077
1078
1079
1080
1081
1082
1083
1084
1085
1086
1087
1088
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094
1095
1096
1097
1098
1099
1100
1101
1102
1103
1104
1105
1106
1107
1108
1109
1110
1111
1112
1113
1114
1115
1116
1117
1118
1119
1120
1121
1122
1123
1124
1125
1126
1127
1128
1129
1130
1131
1132
1133
1134
1135
1136
1137
1138
1139
1140
1141
1142
1143
1144
1145
1146
1147
1148
1149
1150
1151
1152
1153
1154
1155
1156
1157
1158
1159
1160
1161
1162
1163
1164
1165
1166
1167
1168
1169
1170
1171
1172
1173
1174
1175
1176
1177
1178
1179
1180
1181
1182
1183
1184
1185
1186
1187
1188
1189
1190
1191
1192
1193
1194
1195
1196
1197
1198
1199
1200
1201
1202
1203
1204
1205
1206
1207
1208
1209
1210
1211
1212
1213
1214
1215
1216
1217
1218
1219
1220
1221
1222
1223
1224
1225
1226
1227
1228
1229
1230
1231
1232
1233
1234
1235
1236
1237
1238
1239
1240
1241
1242
1243
1244
1245
1246
1247
1248
1249
1250
1251
1252
1253
1254
1255
1256
1257
1258
1259
1260
1261
1262
1263
1264
1265
1266
1267
1268
1269
1270
1271
1272
1273
1274
1275
1276
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281
1282
1283
1284
1285
1286
1287
1288
1289
1290
1291
1292
1293
1294
1295
1296
1297
1298
1299
1300
1301
1302
1303
1304
1305
1306
1307
1308
1309
1310
1311
1312
1313
1314
1315
1316
1317
1318
1319
1320
1321
1322
1323
1324
1325
1326
1327
1328
1329
1330
1331
1332
1333
1334
1335
1336
1337
1338
1339
1340
1341
1342
1343
1344
1345
1346
1347
1348
1349
1350
1351
1352
1353
1354
1355
1356
1357
1358
1359
1360
1361
1362
1363
1364
1365
1366
1367
1368
1369
1370
1371
1372
1373
1374
1375
1376
1377
1378
1379
1380
1381
1382
1383
1384
1385
1386
1387
1388
1389
1390
1391
1392
1393
1394
1395
1396
1397
1398
1399
1400
1401
1402
1403
1404
1405
1406
1407
1408
1409
1410
1411
1412
1413
1414
1415
1416
1417
1418
1419
1420
1421
1422
1423
1424
1425
1426
1427
1428
1429
1430
1431
1432
1433
1434
1435
1436
1437
1438
1439
1440
1441
1442
1443
1444
1445
1446
1447
1448
1449
1450
1451
1452
1453
1454
1455
1456
1457
1458
1459
1460
1461
1462
1463
1464
1465
1466
1467
1468
1469
1470
1471
1472
1473
1474
1475
1476
1477
1478
1479
1480
1481
1482
1483
1484
1485
1486
1487
1488
1489
1490
1491
1492
1493
1494
1495
1496
1497
1498
1499
1500
1501
1502
1503
1504
1505
1506
1507
1508
1509
1510
1511
1512
1513
1514
1515
1516
1517
1518
1519
1520
1521
1522
1523
1524
1525
1526
1527
1528
1529
1530
1531
1532
1533
1534
1535
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540
1541
1542
1543
1544
1545
1546
1547
1548
1549
1550
1551
1552
1553
1554
1555
1556
1557
1558
1559
1560
1561
1562
1563
1564
1565
1566
1567
1568
1569
1570
1571
1572
1573
1574
1575
1576
1577
1578
1579
1580
1581
1582
1583
1584
1585
1586
1587
1588
1589
1590
1591
1592
1593
1594
1595
1596
1597
1598
1599
1600
1601
1602
1603
1604
1605
1606
1607
1608
1609
1610
1611
1612
1613
1614
1615
1616
1617
1618
1619
1620
1621
1622
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628
1629
1630
1631
1632
1633
1634
1635
1636
1637
1638
1639
1640
1641
1642
1643
1644
1645
1646
1647
1648
1649
1650
1651
1652
1653
1654
1655
1656
1657
1658
1659
1660
1661
1662
1663
1664
1665
1666
1667
1668
1669
1670
1671
1672
1673
1674
1675
1676
1677
1678
1679
1680
1681
1682
1683
1684
1685
1686
1687
1688
1689
1690
1691
1692
1693
1694
1695
1696
1697
1698
1699
1700
1701
1702
1703
1704
1705
1706
1707
1708
1709
1710
1711
1712
1713
1714
1715
1716
1717
1718
1719
1720
1721
1722
1723
1724
1725
1726
1727
1728
1729
1730
1731
1732
1733
1734
1735
1736
1737
1738
1739
1740
1741
1742
1743
1744
1745
1746
1747
1748
1749
1750
1751
1752
1753
1754
1755
1756
1757
1758
1759
1760
1761
1762
1763
1764
1765
1766
1767
1768
1769
1770
1771
1772
1773
1774
1775
1776
1777
1778
1779
1780
1781
1782
1783
1784
1785
1786
1787
1788
1789
1790
1791
1792
1793
1794
1795
1796
1797
1798
1799
1800
1801
1802
1803
1804
1805
1806
1807
1808
1809
1810
1811
1812
1813
1814
1815
1816
1817
1818
1819
1820
1821
1822
1823
1824
1825
1826
1827
1828
1829
1830
1831
1832
1833
1834
1835
1836
1837
1838
1839
1840
1841
1842
1843
1844
1845
1846
1847
1848
1849
1850
1851
1852
1853
1854
1855
1856
1857
1858
1859
1860
1861
1862
1863
1864
1865
1866
1867
1868
1869
1870
1871
1872
1873
1874
1875
1876
1877
1878
1879
1880
1881
1882
1883
1884
1885
1886
1887
1888
1889
1890
1891
1892
1893
1894
1895
1896
1897
1898
1899
1900
1901
1902
1903
1904
1905
1906
1907
1908
1909
1910
1911
1912
1913
1914
1915
1916
1917
1918
1919
1920
1921
1922
1923
1924
1925
1926
1927
1928
1929
1930
1931
1932
1933
1934
1935
1936
1937
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942
1943
1944
1945
1946
1947
1948
1949
1950
1951
1952
1953
1954
1955
1956
1957
1958
1959
1960
1961
1962
1963
1964
1965
1966
1967
1968
1969
1970
1971
1972
1973
1974
1975
1976
1977
1978
1979
1980
1981
1982
1983
1984
1985
1986
1987
1988
1989
1990
1991
1992
1993
1994
1995
1996
1997
1998
1999
2000
2001
2002
2003
2004
2005
2006
2007
2008
2009
2010
2011
2012
2013
2014
2015
2016
2017
2018
2019
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
2025
2026
2027
2028
2029
2030
2031
2032
2033
2034
2035
2036
2037
2038
2039
2040
2041
2042
2043
2044
2045
2046
2047
2048
2049
2050
2051
2052
2053
2054
2055
2056
2057
2058
2059
2060
2061
2062
2063
2064
2065
2066
2067
2068
2069
2070
2071
2072
2073
2074
2075
2076
2077
2078
2079
2080
2081
2082
2083
2084
2085
2086
2087
2088
2089
2090
2091
2092
2093
2094
2095
2096
2097
2098
2099
2100
2101
2102
2103
2104
2105
2106
2107
2108
2109
2110
2111
2112
2113
2114
2115
2116
2117
2118
2119
2120
2121
2122
2123
2124
2125
2126
2127
2128
2129
2130
2131
2132
2133
2134
2135
2136
2137
2138
2139
2140
2141
2142
2143
2144
2145
2146
2147
2148
2149
2150
2151
2152
2153
2154
2155
2156
2157
2158
2159
2160
2161
2162
2163
2164
2165
2166
2167
2168
2169
2170
2171
2172
2173
2174
2175
2176
2177
2178
2179
2180
2181
2182
2183
2184
2185
2186
2187
2188
2189
2190
2191
2192
2193
2194
2195
2196
2197
2198
2199
2200
2201
2202
2203
2204
2205
2206
2207
2208
2209
2210
2211
2212
2213
2214
2215
2216
2217
2218
2219
2220
2221
2222
2223
2224
2225
2226
2227
2228
2229
2230
2231
2232
2233
2234
2235
2236
2237
2238
2239
2240
2241
2242
2243
2244
2245
2246
2247
2248
2249
2250
2251
2252
2253
2254
2255
2256
2257
2258
2259
2260
2261
2262
2263
2264
2265
2266
2267
2268
2269
2270
2271
2272
2273
2274
2275
2276
2277
2278
2279
2280
2281
2282
2283
2284
2285
2286
2287
2288
2289
2290
2291
2292
2293
2294
2295
2296
2297
2298
2299
2300
2301
2302
2303
2304
2305
2306
2307
2308
2309
2310
2311
2312
2313
2314
2315
2316
2317
2318
2319
2320
2321
2322
2323
2324
2325
2326
2327
2328
2329
2330
2331
2332
2333
2334
2335
2336
2337
2338
2339
2340
2341
2342
2343
2344
2345
2346
2347
2348
2349
2350
2351
2352
2353
2354
2355
2356
2357
2358
2359
2360
2361
2362
2363
2364
2365
2366
2367
2368
2369
2370
2371
2372
2373
2374
2375
2376
2377
2378
2379
2380
2381
2382
2383
2384
2385
2386
2387
2388
2389
2390
2391
2392
2393
2394
2395
2396
2397
2398
2399
2400
2401
2402
2403
2404
2405
2406
2407
2408
2409
2410
2411
2412
2413
2414
2415
2416
2417
2418
2419
2420
2421
2422
2423
2424
2425
2426
2427
2428
2429
2430
2431
2432
2433
2434
2435
2436
2437
2438
2439
2440
2441
2442
2443
2444
2445
2446
2447
2448
2449
2450
2451
2452
2453
2454
2455
2456
2457
2458
2459
2460
2461
2462
2463
2464
2465
2466
2467
2468
2469
2470
2471
2472
2473
2474
2475
2476
2477
2478
2479
2480
2481
2482
2483
2484
2485
2486
2487
2488
2489
2490
2491
2492
2493
2494
2495
2496
2497
2498
2499
2500
2501
2502
2503
2504
2505
2506
2507
2508
2509
2510
2511
2512
2513
2514
2515
2516
2517
2518
2519
2520
2521
2522
2523
2524
2525
2526
2527
2528
2529
2530
2531
2532
2533
2534
2535
2536
2537
2538
2539
2540
2541
2542
2543
2544
2545
2546
2547
2548
2549
2550
2551
2552
2553
2554
2555
2556
2557
2558
2559
2560
2561
2562
2563
2564
2565
2566
2567
2568
2569
2570
2571
2572
2573
2574
2575
2576
2577
2578
2579
2580
2581
2582
2583
2584
2585
2586
2587
2588
2589
2590
2591
2592
2593
2594
2595
2596
2597
2598
2599
2600
2601
2602
2603
2604
2605
2606
2607
2608
2609
2610
2611
2612
2613
2614
2615
2616
2617
2618
2619
2620
2621
2622
2623
2624
2625
2626
2627
2628
2629
2630
2631
2632
2633
2634
2635
2636
2637
2638
2639
2640
2641
2642
2643
2644
2645
2646
2647
2648
2649
2650
2651
2652
2653
2654
2655
2656
2657
2658
2659
2660
2661
2662
2663
2664
2665
2666
2667
2668
2669
2670
2671
2672
2673
2674
2675
2676
2677
2678
2679
2680
2681
2682
2683
2684
2685
2686
2687
2688
2689
2690
2691
2692
2693
2694
2695
2696
2697
2698
2699
2700
2701
2702
2703
2704
2705
2706
2707
2708
2709
2710
2711
2712
2713
2714
2715
2716
2717
2718
2719
2720
2721
2722
2723
2724
2725
2726
2727
2728
2729
2730
2731
2732
2733
2734
2735
2736
2737
2738
2739
2740
2741
2742
2743
2744
2745
2746
2747
2748
2749
2750
2751
2752
2753
2754
2755
2756
2757
2758
2759
2760
2761
2762
2763
2764
2765
2766
2767
2768
2769
2770
2771
2772
2773
2774
2775
2776
2777
2778
2779
2780
2781
2782
2783
2784
2785
2786
2787
2788
2789
2790
2791
2792
2793
2794
2795
2796
2797
2798
2799
2800
2801
2802
2803
2804
2805
2806
2807
2808
2809
2810
2811
2812
2813
2814
2815
2816
2817
2818
2819
2820
2821
2822
2823
2824
2825
2826
2827
2828
2829
2830
2831
2832
2833
2834
2835
2836
2837
2838
2839
2840
2841
2842
2843
2844
2845
2846
2847
2848
2849
2850
2851
2852
2853
2854
2855
2856
2857
2858
2859
2860
2861
2862
2863
2864
2865
2866
2867
2868
2869
2870
2871
2872
2873
2874
2875
2876
2877
2878
2879
2880
2881
2882
2883
2884
2885
2886
2887
2888
2889
2890
2891
2892
2893
2894
2895
2896
2897
2898
2899
2900
2901
2902
2903
2904
2905
2906
2907
2908
2909
2910
2911
2912
2913
2914
2915
2916
2917
2918
2919
2920
2921
2922
2923
2924
2925
2926
2927
2928
2929
2930
2931
2932
2933
2934
2935
2936
2937
2938
2939
2940
2941
2942
2943
2944
2945
2946
2947
2948
2949
2950
2951
2952
2953
2954
2955
2956
2957
2958
2959
2960
2961
2962
2963
2964
2965
2966
2967
2968
2969
2970
2971
2972
2973
2974
2975
2976
2977
2978
2979
2980
2981
2982
2983
2984
2985
2986
2987
2988
2989
2990
2991
2992
2993
2994
2995
2996
2997
2998
2999
3000
3001
3002
3003
3004
3005
3006
3007
3008
3009
3010
3011
3012
3013
3014
3015
3016
3017
3018
3019
3020
3021
3022
3023
3024
3025
3026
3027
3028
3029
3030
3031
3032
3033
3034
3035
3036
3037
3038
3039
3040
3041
3042
3043
3044
3045
3046
3047
3048
3049
3050
3051
3052
3053
3054
3055
3056
3057
3058
3059
3060
3061
3062
3063
3064
3065
3066
3067
3068
3069
3070
3071
3072
3073
3074
3075
3076
3077
3078
3079
3080
3081
3082
3083
3084
3085
3086
3087
3088
3089
3090
3091
3092
3093
3094
3095
3096
3097
3098
3099
3100
3101
3102
3103
3104
3105
3106
3107
3108
3109
3110
3111
3112
3113
3114
3115
3116
3117
3118
3119
3120
3121
3122
3123
3124
3125
3126
3127
3128
3129
3130
3131
3132
3133
3134
3135
3136
3137
3138
3139
3140
3141
3142
3143
3144
3145
3146
3147
3148
3149
3150
3151
3152
3153
3154
3155
3156
3157
3158
3159
3160
3161
3162
3163
3164
3165
3166
3167
3168
3169
3170
3171
3172
3173
3174
3175
3176
3177
3178
3179
3180
3181
3182
3183
3184
3185
3186
3187
3188
3189
3190
3191
3192
3193
3194
3195
3196
3197
3198
3199
3200
3201
3202
3203
3204
3205
3206
3207
3208
3209
3210
3211
3212
3213
3214
3215
3216
3217
3218
3219
3220
3221
3222
3223
3224
3225
3226
3227
3228
3229
3230
3231
3232
3233
3234
3235
3236
3237
3238
3239
3240
3241
3242
3243
3244
3245
3246
3247
3248
3249
3250
3251
3252
3253
3254
3255
3256
3257
3258
3259
3260
3261
3262
3263
3264
3265
3266
3267
3268
3269
3270
3271
3272
3273
3274
3275
3276
3277
3278
3279
3280
3281
3282
3283
3284
3285
3286
3287
3288
3289
3290
3291
3292
3293
3294
3295
3296
3297
3298
3299
3300
3301
3302
3303
3304
3305
3306
3307
3308
3309
3310
3311
3312
3313
3314
3315
3316
3317
3318
3319
3320
3321
3322
3323
3324
3325
3326
3327
3328
3329
3330
3331
3332
3333
3334
3335
3336
3337
3338
3339
3340
3341
3342
3343
3344
3345
3346
3347
3348
3349
3350
3351
3352
3353
3354
3355
3356
3357
3358
3359
3360
3361
3362
3363
3364
3365
3366
3367
3368
3369
3370
3371
3372
3373
3374
3375
3376
3377
3378
3379
3380
3381
3382
3383
3384
3385
3386
3387
3388
3389
3390
3391
3392
3393
3394
3395
3396
3397
3398
3399
3400
3401
3402
3403
3404
3405
3406
3407
3408
3409
3410
3411
3412
3413
3414
3415
3416
3417
3418
3419
3420
3421
3422
3423
3424
3425
3426
3427
3428
3429
3430
3431
3432
3433
3434
3435
3436
3437
3438
3439
3440
3441
3442
3443
3444
3445
3446
3447
3448
3449
3450
3451
3452
3453
3454
3455
3456
3457
3458
3459
3460
3461
3462
3463
3464
3465
3466
3467
3468
3469
3470
3471
3472
3473
3474
3475
3476
3477
3478
3479
3480
3481
3482
3483
3484
3485
3486
3487
3488
3489
3490
3491
3492
3493
3494
3495
3496
3497
3498
3499
3500
3501
3502
3503
3504
3505
3506
3507
3508
3509
3510
3511
3512
3513
3514
3515
3516
3517
3518
3519
3520
3521
3522
3523
3524
3525
3526
3527
3528
3529
3530
3531
3532
3533
3534
3535
3536
3537
3538
3539
3540
3541
3542
3543
3544
3545
3546
3547
3548
3549
3550
3551
3552
3553
3554
3555
3556
3557
3558
3559
3560
3561
3562
3563
3564
3565
3566
3567
3568
3569
3570
3571
3572
3573
3574
3575
3576
3577
3578
3579
3580
3581
3582
3583
3584
3585
3586
3587
3588
3589
3590
3591
3592
3593
3594
3595
3596
3597
3598
3599
3600
3601
3602
3603
3604
3605
3606
3607
3608
3609
3610
3611
3612
3613
3614
3615
3616
3617
3618
3619
3620
3621
3622
3623
3624
3625
3626
3627
3628
3629
3630
3631
3632
3633
3634
3635
3636
3637
3638
3639
3640
3641
3642
3643
3644
3645
3646
3647
3648
3649
3650
3651
3652
3653
3654
3655
3656
3657
3658
3659
3660
3661
3662
3663
3664
3665
3666
3667
3668
3669
3670
3671
3672
3673
3674
3675
3676
3677
3678
3679
3680
3681
3682
3683
3684
3685
3686
3687
3688
3689
3690
3691
3692
3693
3694
3695
3696
3697
3698
3699
3700
3701
3702
3703
3704
3705
3706
3707
3708
3709
3710
3711
3712
3713
3714
3715
3716
3717
3718
3719
3720
3721
3722
3723
3724
3725
3726
3727
3728
3729
3730
3731
3732
3733
3734
3735
3736
3737
3738
3739
3740
3741
3742
3743
3744
3745
3746
3747
3748
3749
3750
3751
3752
3753
3754
3755
3756
3757
3758
3759
3760
3761
3762
3763
3764
3765
3766
3767
3768
3769
3770
3771
3772
3773
3774
3775
3776
3777
3778
3779
3780
3781
3782
3783
3784
3785
3786
3787
3788
3789
3790
3791
3792
3793
3794
3795
3796
3797
3798
3799
3800
3801
3802
3803
3804
3805
3806
3807
3808
3809
3810
3811
3812
3813
3814
3815
3816
3817
3818
3819
3820
3821
3822
3823
3824
3825
3826
3827
3828
3829
3830
3831
3832
3833
3834
3835
3836
3837
3838
3839
3840
3841
3842
3843
3844
3845
3846
3847
3848
3849
3850
3851
3852
3853
3854
3855
3856
3857
3858
3859
3860
3861
3862
3863
3864
3865
3866
3867
3868
3869
3870
3871
3872
3873
3874
3875
3876
3877
3878
3879
3880
3881
3882
3883
3884
3885
3886
3887
3888
3889
3890
3891
3892
3893
3894
3895
3896
3897
3898
3899
3900
3901
3902
3903
3904
3905
3906
3907
3908
3909
3910
3911
3912
3913
3914
3915
3916
3917
3918
3919
3920
3921
3922
3923
3924
3925
3926
3927
3928
3929
3930
3931
3932
3933
3934
3935
3936
3937
3938
3939
3940
3941
3942
3943
3944
3945
3946
3947
3948
3949
3950
3951
3952
3953
3954
3955
3956
3957
3958
3959
3960
3961
3962
3963
3964
3965
3966
3967
3968
3969
3970
3971
3972
3973
3974
3975
3976
3977
3978
3979
3980
3981
3982
3983
3984
3985
3986
3987
3988
3989
3990
3991
3992
3993
3994
3995
3996
3997
3998
3999
4000
4001
4002
4003
4004
4005
4006
4007
4008
4009
4010
4011
4012
4013
4014
4015
4016
4017
4018
4019
4020
4021
4022
4023
4024
4025
4026
4027
4028
4029
4030
4031
4032
4033
4034
4035
4036
4037
4038
4039
4040
4041
4042
4043
4044
4045
4046
4047
4048
4049
4050
4051
4052
4053
4054
4055
4056
4057
4058
4059
4060
4061
4062
4063
4064
4065
4066
4067
4068
4069
4070
4071
4072
4073
4074
4075
4076
4077
4078
4079
4080
4081
4082
4083
4084
4085
4086
4087
4088
4089
4090
4091
4092
4093
4094
4095
4096
4097
4098
4099
4100
4101
4102
4103
4104
4105
4106
4107
4108
4109
4110
4111
4112
4113
4114
4115
4116
4117
4118
4119
4120
4121
4122
4123
4124
4125
4126
4127
4128
4129
4130
4131
4132
4133
4134
4135
4136
4137
4138
4139
4140
4141
4142
4143
4144
4145
4146
4147
4148
4149
4150
4151
4152
4153
4154
4155
4156
4157
4158
4159
4160
4161
4162
4163
4164
4165
4166
4167
4168
4169
4170
4171
4172
4173
4174
4175
4176
4177
4178
4179
4180
4181
4182
4183
4184
4185
4186
4187
4188
4189
4190
4191
4192
4193
4194
4195
4196
4197
4198
4199
4200
4201
4202
4203
4204
4205
4206
4207
4208
4209
4210
4211
4212
4213
4214
4215
4216
4217
4218
4219
4220
4221
4222
4223
4224
4225
4226
4227
4228
4229
4230
4231
4232
4233
4234
4235
4236
4237
4238
4239
4240
4241
4242
4243
4244
4245
4246
4247
4248
4249
4250
4251
4252
4253
4254
4255
4256
4257
4258
4259
4260
4261
4262
4263
4264
4265
4266
4267
4268
4269
4270
4271
4272
4273
4274
4275
4276
4277
4278
4279
4280
4281
4282
4283
4284
4285
4286
4287
4288
4289
4290
4291
4292
4293
4294
4295
4296
4297
4298
4299
4300
4301
4302
4303
4304
4305
4306
4307
4308
4309
4310
4311
4312
4313
4314
4315
4316
4317
4318
4319
4320
4321
4322
4323
4324
4325
4326
4327
4328
4329
4330
4331
4332
4333
4334
4335
4336
4337
4338
4339
4340
4341
4342
4343
4344
4345
4346
4347
4348
4349
4350
4351
4352
4353
4354
4355
4356
4357
4358
4359
4360
4361
4362
4363
4364
4365
4366
4367
4368
4369
4370
4371
4372
4373
4374
4375
4376
4377
4378
4379
4380
4381
4382
4383
4384
4385
4386
4387
4388
4389
4390
4391
4392
4393
4394
4395
4396
4397
4398
4399
4400
4401
4402
4403
4404
4405
4406
4407
4408
4409
4410
4411
4412
4413
4414
4415
4416
4417
4418
4419
4420
4421
4422
4423
4424
4425
4426
4427
4428
4429
4430
4431
4432
4433
4434
4435
4436
4437
4438
4439
4440
4441
4442
4443
4444
4445
4446
4447
4448
4449
4450
4451
4452
4453
4454
4455
4456
4457
4458
4459
4460
4461
4462
4463
4464
4465
4466
4467
4468
4469
4470
4471
4472
4473
4474
4475
4476
4477
4478
4479
4480
4481
4482
4483
4484
4485
4486
4487
4488
4489
4490
4491
4492
4493
4494
4495
4496
4497
4498
4499
4500
4501
4502
4503
4504
4505
4506
4507
4508
4509
4510
4511
4512
4513
4514
4515
4516
4517
4518
4519
4520
4521
4522
4523
4524
4525
4526
4527
4528
4529
4530
4531
4532
4533
4534
4535
4536
4537
4538
4539
4540
4541
4542
4543
4544
4545
4546
4547
4548
4549
4550
4551
4552
4553
4554
4555
4556
4557
4558
4559
4560
4561
4562
4563
4564
4565
4566
4567
4568
4569
4570
4571
4572
4573
4574
4575
4576
4577
4578
4579
4580
4581
4582
4583
4584
4585
4586
4587
4588
4589
4590
4591
4592
4593
4594
4595
4596
4597
4598
4599
4600
4601
4602
4603
4604
4605
4606
4607
4608
4609
4610
4611
4612
4613
4614
4615
4616
4617
4618
4619
4620
4621
4622
4623
4624
4625
4626
4627
4628
4629
4630
4631
4632
4633
4634
4635
4636
4637
4638
4639
4640
4641
4642
4643
4644
4645
4646
4647
4648
4649
4650
4651
4652
4653
4654
4655
4656
4657
4658
4659
4660
4661
4662
4663
4664
4665
4666
4667
4668
4669
4670
4671
4672
4673
4674
4675
4676
4677
4678
4679
4680
4681
4682
4683
4684
4685
4686
4687
4688
4689
4690
4691
4692
4693
4694
4695
4696
4697
4698
4699
4700
4701
4702
4703
4704
4705
4706
4707
4708
4709
4710
4711
4712
4713
4714
4715
4716
4717
4718
4719
4720
4721
4722
4723
4724
4725
4726
4727
4728
4729
4730
4731
4732
4733
4734
4735
4736
4737
4738
4739
4740
4741
4742
4743
4744
4745
4746
4747
4748
4749
4750
4751
4752
4753
4754
4755
4756
4757
4758
4759
4760
4761
4762
4763
4764
4765
4766
4767
4768
4769
4770
4771
4772
4773
4774
4775
4776
4777
4778
4779
4780
4781
4782
4783
4784
4785
4786
4787
4788
4789
4790
4791
4792
4793
4794
4795
4796
4797
4798
4799
4800
4801
4802
4803
4804
4805
4806
4807
4808
4809
4810
4811
4812
4813
4814
4815
4816
4817
4818
4819
4820
4821
4822
4823
4824
4825
4826
4827
4828
4829
4830
4831
4832
4833
4834
4835
4836
4837
4838
4839
4840
4841
4842
4843
4844
4845
4846
4847
4848
4849
4850
4851
4852
4853
4854
4855
4856
4857
4858
4859
4860
4861
4862
4863
4864
4865
4866
4867
4868
4869
4870
4871
4872
4873
4874
4875
4876
4877
4878
4879
4880
4881
4882
4883
4884
4885
4886
4887
4888
4889
4890
4891
4892
4893
4894
4895
4896
4897
4898
4899
4900
4901
4902
4903
4904
4905
4906
4907
4908
4909
4910
4911
4912
4913
4914
4915
4916
4917
4918
4919
4920
4921
4922
4923
4924
4925
4926
4927
4928
4929
4930
4931
4932
4933
4934
4935
4936
4937
4938
4939
4940
4941
4942
4943
4944
4945
4946
4947
4948
4949
4950
4951
4952
4953
4954
4955
4956
4957
4958
4959
4960
4961
4962
4963
4964
4965
4966
4967
4968
4969
4970
4971
4972
4973
4974
4975
4976
4977
4978
4979
4980
4981
4982
4983
4984
4985
4986
4987
4988
4989
4990
4991
4992
4993
4994
4995
4996
4997
4998
4999
5000
5001
5002
5003
5004
5005
5006
5007
5008
5009
5010
5011
5012
5013
5014
5015
5016
5017
5018
5019
5020
5021
5022
5023
5024
5025
5026
5027
5028
5029
5030
5031
5032
5033
5034
5035
5036
5037
5038
5039
5040
5041
5042
5043
5044
5045
5046
5047
5048
5049
5050
5051
5052
5053
5054
5055
5056
5057
5058
5059
5060
5061
5062
5063
5064
5065
5066
5067
5068
5069
5070
5071
5072
5073
5074
5075
5076
5077
5078
5079
5080
5081
5082
5083
5084
5085
5086
5087
5088
5089
5090
5091
5092
5093
5094
5095
5096
5097
5098
5099
5100
5101
5102
5103
5104
5105
5106
5107
5108
5109
5110
5111
5112
5113
5114
5115
5116
5117
5118
5119
5120
5121
5122
5123
5124
5125
5126
5127
5128
5129
5130
5131
5132
5133
5134
5135
5136
5137
5138
5139
5140
5141
5142
5143
5144
5145
5146
5147
5148
5149
5150
5151
5152
5153
5154
5155
5156
5157
5158
5159
5160
5161
5162
5163
5164
5165
5166
5167
5168
5169
5170
5171
5172
5173
5174
5175
5176
5177
5178
5179
5180
5181
5182
5183
5184
5185
5186
5187
5188
5189
5190
5191
5192
5193
5194
5195
5196
5197
5198
5199
5200
5201
5202
5203
5204
5205
5206
5207
5208
5209
5210
5211
5212
5213
5214
5215
5216
5217
5218
5219
5220
5221
5222
5223
5224
5225
5226
5227
5228
5229
5230
5231
5232
5233
5234
5235
5236
5237
5238
5239
5240
5241
5242
5243
5244
5245
5246
5247
5248
5249
5250
5251
5252
5253
5254
5255
5256
5257
5258
5259
5260
5261
5262
5263
5264
5265
5266
5267
5268
5269
5270
5271
5272
5273
5274
5275
5276
5277
5278
5279
5280
5281
5282
5283
5284
5285
5286
5287
5288
5289
5290
5291
5292
5293
5294
5295
5296
5297
5298
5299
5300
5301
5302
5303
5304
5305
5306
5307
5308
5309
5310
5311
5312
5313
5314
5315
5316
5317
5318
5319
5320
5321
5322
5323
5324
5325
5326
5327
5328
5329
5330
5331
5332
5333
5334
5335
5336
5337
5338
5339
5340
5341
5342
5343
5344
5345
5346
5347
5348
5349
5350
5351
5352
5353
5354
5355
5356
5357
5358
5359
5360
5361
5362
5363
5364
5365
5366
5367
5368
5369
5370
5371
5372
5373
5374
5375
5376
5377
5378
5379
5380
5381
5382
5383
5384
5385
5386
5387
5388
5389
5390
5391
5392
5393
5394
5395
5396
5397
5398
5399
5400
5401
5402
5403
5404
5405
5406
5407
5408
5409
5410
5411
5412
5413
5414
5415
5416
5417
5418
5419
5420
5421
5422
5423
5424
5425
5426
5427
5428
5429
5430
5431
5432
5433
5434
5435
5436
5437
5438
5439
5440
5441
5442
5443
5444
5445
5446
5447
5448
5449
5450
5451
5452
5453
5454
5455
5456
5457
5458
5459
5460
5461
5462
5463
5464
5465
5466
5467
5468
5469
5470
5471
5472
5473
5474
5475
5476
5477
5478
5479
5480
5481
5482
5483
5484
5485
5486
5487
5488
5489
5490
5491
5492
5493
5494
5495
5496
5497
5498
5499
5500
5501
5502
5503
5504
5505
5506
5507
5508
5509
5510
5511
5512
5513
5514
5515
5516
5517
5518
5519
5520
5521
5522
5523
5524
5525
5526
5527
5528
5529
5530
5531
5532
5533
5534
5535
5536
5537
5538
5539
5540
5541
5542
5543
5544
5545
5546
5547
5548
5549
5550
5551
5552
5553
5554
5555
5556
5557
5558
5559
5560
5561
5562
5563
5564
5565
5566
5567
5568
5569
5570
5571
5572
5573
5574
5575
5576
5577
5578
5579
5580
5581
5582
5583
5584
5585
5586
5587
5588
5589
5590
5591
5592
5593
5594
5595
5596
5597
5598
5599
5600
5601
5602
5603
5604
5605
5606
5607
5608
5609
5610
5611
5612
5613
5614
5615
5616
5617
5618
5619
5620
5621
5622
5623
5624
5625
5626
5627
5628
5629
5630
5631
5632
5633
5634
5635
5636
5637
5638
5639
5640
5641
5642
5643
5644
5645
5646
5647
5648
5649
5650
5651
5652
5653
5654
5655
5656
5657
5658
5659
5660
5661
5662
5663
5664
5665
5666
5667
5668
5669
5670
5671
5672
5673
5674
5675
5676
5677
5678
5679
5680
5681
5682
5683
5684
5685
5686
5687
5688
5689
5690
5691
5692
5693
5694
5695
5696
5697
5698
5699
5700
5701
5702
5703
5704
5705
5706
5707
5708
5709
5710
5711
5712
5713
5714
5715
5716
5717
5718
5719
5720
5721
5722
5723
5724
5725
5726
5727
5728
5729
5730
5731
5732
5733
5734
5735
5736
5737
5738
5739
5740
5741
5742
5743
5744
5745
5746
5747
5748
5749
5750
5751
5752
5753
5754
5755
5756
5757
5758
5759
5760
5761
5762
5763
5764
5765
5766
5767
5768
5769
5770
5771
5772
5773
5774
5775
5776
5777
5778
5779
5780
5781
5782
5783
5784
5785
5786
5787
5788
5789
5790
5791
5792
5793
5794
5795
5796
5797
5798
5799
5800
5801
5802
5803
5804
5805
5806
5807
5808
5809
5810
5811
5812
5813
5814
5815
5816
5817
5818
5819
5820
5821
5822
5823
5824
5825
5826
5827
5828
5829
5830
5831
5832
5833
5834
5835
5836
5837
5838
5839
5840
5841
5842
5843
5844
5845
5846
5847
5848
5849
5850
5851
5852
5853
5854
5855
5856
5857
5858
5859
5860
5861
5862
5863
5864
5865
5866
5867
5868
5869
5870
5871
5872
5873
5874
5875
5876
5877
5878
5879
5880
5881
5882
5883
5884
5885
5886
5887
5888
5889
5890
5891
5892
5893
5894
5895
5896
5897
5898
5899
5900
5901
5902
5903
5904
5905
5906
5907
5908
5909
5910
5911
5912
5913
5914
5915
5916
5917
5918
5919
5920
5921
5922
5923
5924
5925
5926
5927
5928
5929
5930
5931
5932
5933
5934
5935
5936
5937
5938
5939
5940
5941
5942
5943
5944
5945
5946
5947
5948
5949
5950
5951
5952
5953
5954
5955
5956
5957
5958
5959
5960
5961
5962
5963
5964
5965
5966
5967
5968
5969
5970
5971
5972
5973
5974
5975
5976
5977
5978
5979
5980
5981
5982
5983
5984
5985
5986
5987
5988
5989
5990
5991
5992
5993
5994
5995
5996
5997
5998
5999
6000
6001
6002
6003
6004
6005
6006
6007
6008
6009
6010
6011
6012
6013
6014
6015
6016
6017
6018
6019
6020
6021
6022
6023
6024
6025
6026
6027
6028
6029
6030
6031
6032
6033
6034
6035
6036
6037
6038
6039
6040
6041
6042
6043
6044
6045
6046
6047
6048
6049
6050
6051
6052
6053
6054
6055
6056
6057
6058
6059
6060
6061
6062
6063
6064
6065
6066
6067
6068
6069
6070
6071
6072
6073
6074
6075
6076
6077
6078
6079
6080
6081
6082
6083
6084
6085
6086
6087
6088
6089
6090
6091
6092
6093
6094
6095
6096
6097
6098
6099
6100
6101
6102
6103
6104
6105
6106
6107
6108
6109
6110
6111
6112
6113
6114
6115
6116
6117
6118
6119
6120
6121
6122
6123
6124
6125
6126
6127
6128
6129
6130
6131
6132
6133
6134
6135
6136
6137
6138
6139
6140
6141
6142
6143
6144
6145
6146
6147
6148
6149
6150
6151
6152
6153
6154
6155
6156
6157
6158
6159
6160
6161
6162
6163
6164
6165
6166
6167
6168
6169
6170
6171
6172
6173
6174
6175
6176
6177
6178
6179
6180
6181
6182
6183
6184
6185
6186
6187
6188
6189
6190
6191
6192
6193
6194
6195
6196
6197
6198
6199
6200
6201
6202
6203
6204
6205
6206
6207
6208
6209
6210
6211
6212
6213
6214
6215
6216
6217
6218
6219
6220
6221
6222
6223
6224
6225
6226
6227
6228
6229
6230
6231
6232
6233
6234
6235
6236
6237
6238
6239
6240
6241
6242
6243
6244
6245
6246
6247
6248
6249
6250
6251
6252
6253
6254
6255
6256
6257
6258
6259
6260
6261
6262
6263
6264
6265
6266
6267
6268
6269
6270
6271
6272
6273
6274
6275
6276
6277
6278
6279
6280
6281
6282
6283
6284
6285
6286
6287
6288
6289
6290
6291
6292
6293
6294
6295
6296
6297
6298
6299
6300
6301
6302
6303
6304
6305
6306
6307
6308
6309
6310
6311
6312
6313
6314
6315
6316
6317
6318
6319
6320
6321
6322
6323
6324
6325
6326
6327
6328
6329
6330
6331
6332
6333
6334
6335
6336
6337
6338
6339
6340
6341
6342
6343
6344
6345
6346
6347
6348
6349
6350
6351
6352
6353
6354
6355
6356
6357
6358
6359
6360
6361
6362
6363
6364
6365
6366
6367
6368
6369
6370
6371
6372
6373
6374
6375
6376
6377
6378
6379
6380
6381
6382
6383
6384
6385
6386
6387
6388
6389
6390
6391
6392
6393
6394
6395
6396
6397
6398
6399
6400
6401
6402
6403
6404
6405
6406
6407
6408
6409
6410
6411
6412
6413
6414
6415
6416
6417
6418
6419
6420
6421
6422
6423
6424
6425
6426
6427
6428
6429
6430
6431
6432
6433
6434
6435
6436
6437
6438
6439
6440
6441
6442
6443
6444
6445
6446
6447
6448
6449
6450
6451
6452
6453
6454
6455
6456
6457
6458
6459
6460
6461
6462
6463
6464
6465
6466
6467
6468
6469
6470
6471
6472
6473
6474
6475
6476
6477
6478
6479
6480
6481
6482
6483
6484
6485
6486
6487
6488
6489
6490
6491
6492
6493
6494
6495
6496
6497
6498
6499
6500
6501
6502
6503
6504
6505
6506
6507
6508
6509
6510
6511
6512
6513
6514
6515
6516
6517
6518
6519
6520
6521
6522
6523
6524
6525
6526
6527
6528
6529
6530
6531
6532
6533
6534
6535
6536
6537
6538
6539
6540
6541
6542
6543
6544
6545
6546
6547
6548
6549
6550
6551
6552
6553
6554
6555
6556
6557
6558
6559
6560
6561
6562
6563
6564
6565
6566
6567
6568
6569
6570
6571
6572
6573
6574
6575
6576
6577
6578
6579
6580
6581
6582
6583
6584
6585
6586
6587
6588
6589
6590
6591
6592
6593
6594
6595
6596
6597
6598
6599
6600
6601
6602
6603
6604
6605
6606
6607
6608
6609
6610
6611
6612
6613
6614
6615
6616
6617
6618
6619
6620
6621
6622
6623
6624
6625
6626
6627
6628
6629
6630
6631
6632
6633
6634
6635
6636
6637
6638
6639
6640
6641
6642
6643
6644
6645
6646
6647
6648
6649
6650
6651
6652
6653
6654
6655
6656
6657
6658
6659
6660
6661
6662
6663
6664
6665
6666
6667
6668
6669
6670
6671
6672
6673
6674
6675
6676
6677
6678
6679
6680
6681
6682
6683
6684
6685
6686
6687
6688
6689
6690
6691
6692
6693
6694
6695
6696
6697
6698
6699
6700
6701
6702
6703
6704
6705
6706
6707
6708
6709
6710
6711
6712
6713
6714
6715
6716
6717
6718
6719
6720
6721
6722
6723
6724
6725
6726
6727
6728
6729
6730
6731
6732
6733
6734
6735
6736
6737
6738
6739
6740
6741
6742
6743
6744
6745
6746
6747
6748
6749
6750
6751
6752
6753
6754
6755
6756
6757
6758
6759
6760
6761
6762
6763
6764
6765
6766
6767
6768
6769
6770
6771
6772
6773
6774
6775
6776
6777
6778
6779
6780
6781
6782
6783
6784
6785
6786
6787
6788
6789
6790
6791
6792
6793
6794
6795
6796
6797
6798
6799
6800
6801
6802
6803
6804
6805
6806
6807
6808
6809
6810
6811
6812
6813
6814
6815
6816
6817
6818
6819
6820
6821
6822
6823
6824
6825
6826
6827
6828
6829
6830
6831
6832
6833
6834
6835
6836
6837
6838
6839
6840
6841
6842
6843
6844
6845
6846
6847
6848
6849
6850
6851
6852
6853
6854
6855
6856
6857
6858
6859
6860
6861
6862
6863
6864
6865
6866
6867
6868
6869
6870
6871
6872
6873
6874
6875
6876
6877
6878
6879
6880
6881
6882
6883
6884
6885
6886
6887
6888
6889
6890
6891
6892
6893
6894
6895
6896
6897
6898
6899
6900
6901
6902
6903
6904
6905
6906
6907
6908
6909
6910
6911
6912
6913
6914
6915
6916
6917
6918
6919
6920
6921
6922
6923
6924
6925
6926
6927
6928
6929
6930
6931
6932
6933
6934
6935
6936
6937
6938
6939
6940
6941
6942
6943
6944
6945
6946
6947
6948
6949
6950
6951
6952
6953
6954
6955
6956
6957
6958
6959
6960
6961
6962
6963
6964
6965
6966
6967
6968
6969
6970
6971
6972
6973
6974
6975
6976
6977
6978
6979
6980
6981
6982
6983
6984
6985
6986
6987
6988
6989
6990
6991
6992
6993
6994
6995
6996
6997
6998
6999
7000
7001
7002
7003
7004
7005
7006
7007
7008
7009
7010
7011
7012
7013
7014
7015
7016
7017
7018
7019
7020
7021
7022
7023
7024
7025
7026
7027
7028
7029
7030
7031
7032
7033
7034
7035
7036
7037
7038
7039
7040
7041
7042
7043
7044
7045
7046
7047
7048
7049
7050
7051
7052
7053
7054
7055
7056
7057
7058
7059
7060
7061
7062
7063
7064
7065
7066
7067
7068
7069
7070
7071
7072
7073
7074
7075
7076
7077
7078
7079
7080
7081
7082
7083
7084
7085
7086
7087
7088
7089
7090
7091
7092
7093
7094
7095
7096
7097
7098
7099
7100
7101
7102
7103
7104
7105
7106
7107
7108
7109
7110
7111
7112
7113
7114
7115
7116
7117
7118
7119
7120
7121
7122
7123
7124
7125
7126
7127
7128
7129
7130
7131
7132
7133
7134
7135
7136
7137
7138
7139
7140
7141
7142
7143
7144
7145
7146
7147
7148
7149
7150
7151
7152
7153
7154
7155
7156
7157
7158
7159
7160
7161
7162
7163
7164
7165
7166
7167
7168
7169
7170
7171
7172
7173
7174
7175
7176
7177
7178
7179
7180
7181
7182
7183
7184
7185
7186
7187
7188
7189
7190
7191
7192
7193
7194
7195
7196
7197
7198
7199
7200
7201
7202
7203
7204
7205
7206
7207
7208
7209
7210
7211
7212
7213
7214
7215
7216
7217
7218
7219
7220
7221
7222
7223
7224
7225
7226
7227
7228
7229
7230
7231
7232
7233
7234
7235
7236
7237
7238
7239
7240
7241
7242
7243
7244
7245
7246
7247
7248
7249
7250
7251
7252
7253
7254
7255
7256
7257
7258
7259
7260
7261
7262
7263
7264
7265
7266
7267
7268
7269
7270
7271
7272
7273
7274
7275
7276
7277
7278
7279
7280
7281
7282
7283
7284
7285
7286
7287
7288
7289
7290
7291
7292
7293
7294
7295
7296
7297
7298
7299
7300
7301
7302
7303
7304
7305
7306
7307
7308
7309
7310
7311
7312
7313
7314
7315
7316
7317
7318
7319
7320
7321
7322
7323
7324
7325
7326
7327
7328
7329
7330
7331
7332
7333
7334
7335
7336
7337
7338
7339
7340
7341
7342
7343
7344
7345
7346
7347
7348
7349
7350
7351
7352
7353
7354
7355
7356
7357
7358
7359
7360
7361
7362
7363
7364
7365
7366
7367
7368
7369
7370
7371
7372
7373
7374
7375
7376
7377
7378
7379
7380
7381
7382
7383
7384
7385
7386
7387
7388
7389
7390
7391
7392
7393
7394
7395
7396
7397
7398
7399
7400
7401
7402
7403
7404
7405
7406
7407
7408
7409
7410
7411
7412
7413
7414
7415
7416
7417
7418
7419
7420
7421
7422
7423
7424
7425
7426
7427
7428
7429
7430
7431
7432
7433
7434
7435
7436
7437
7438
7439
7440
7441
7442
7443
7444
7445
7446
7447
7448
7449
7450
7451
7452
7453
7454
7455
7456
7457
7458
7459
7460
7461
7462
7463
7464
7465
7466
7467
7468
7469
7470
7471
7472
7473
7474
7475
7476
7477
7478
7479
7480
7481
7482
7483
7484
7485
7486
7487
7488
7489
7490
7491
7492
7493
7494
7495
7496
7497
7498
7499
7500
7501
7502
7503
7504
7505
7506
7507
7508
7509
7510
7511
7512
7513
7514
7515
7516
7517
7518
7519
7520
7521
7522
7523
7524
7525
7526
7527
7528
7529
7530
7531
7532
7533
7534
7535
7536
7537
7538
7539
7540
7541
7542
7543
7544
7545
7546
7547
7548
7549
7550
7551
7552
7553
7554
7555
7556
7557
7558
7559
7560
7561
7562
7563
7564
7565
7566
7567
7568
7569
7570
7571
7572
7573
7574
7575
7576
7577
7578
7579
7580
7581
7582
7583
7584
7585
7586
7587
7588
7589
7590
7591
7592
7593
7594
7595
7596
7597
7598
7599
7600
7601
7602
7603
7604
7605
7606
7607
7608
7609
7610
7611
7612
7613
7614
7615
7616
7617
7618
7619
7620
7621
7622
7623
7624
7625
7626
7627
7628
7629
7630
7631
7632
7633
7634
7635
7636
7637
7638
7639
7640
7641
7642
7643
7644
7645
7646
7647
7648
7649
7650
7651
7652
7653
7654
7655
7656
7657
7658
7659
7660
7661
7662
7663
7664
7665
7666
7667
7668
7669
7670
7671
7672
7673
7674
7675
7676
7677
7678
7679
7680
7681
7682
7683
7684
7685
7686
7687
7688
7689
7690
7691
7692
7693
7694
7695
7696
7697
7698
7699
7700
7701
7702
7703
7704
7705
7706
7707
7708
7709
7710
7711
7712
7713
7714
7715
7716
7717
7718
7719
7720
7721
7722
7723
7724
7725
7726
7727
7728
7729
7730
7731
7732
7733
7734
7735
7736
7737
7738
7739
7740
7741
7742
7743
7744
7745
7746
7747
7748
7749
7750
7751
7752
7753
7754
7755
7756
7757
7758
7759
7760
7761
7762
7763
7764
7765
7766
7767
7768
7769
7770
7771
7772
7773
7774
7775
7776
7777
7778
7779
7780
7781
7782
7783
7784
7785
7786
7787
7788
7789
7790
7791
7792
7793
7794
7795
7796
7797
7798
7799
7800
7801
7802
7803
7804
7805
7806
7807
7808
7809
7810
7811
7812
7813
7814
7815
7816
7817
7818
7819
7820
7821
7822
7823
7824
7825
7826
7827
7828
7829
7830
7831
7832
7833
7834
7835
7836
7837
7838
7839
7840
7841
7842
7843
7844
7845
7846
7847
7848
7849
7850
7851
7852
7853
7854
7855
7856
7857
7858
7859
7860
7861
7862
7863
7864
7865
7866
7867
7868
7869
7870
7871
7872
7873
7874
7875
7876
7877
7878
7879
7880
7881
7882
7883
7884
7885
7886
7887
7888
7889
7890
7891
7892
7893
7894
7895
7896
7897
7898
7899
7900
7901
7902
7903
7904
7905
7906
7907
7908
7909
7910
7911
7912
7913
7914
7915
7916
7917
7918
7919
7920
7921
7922
7923
7924
7925
7926
7927
7928
7929
7930
7931
7932
7933
7934
7935
7936
7937
7938
7939
7940
7941
7942
7943
7944
7945
7946
7947
7948
7949
7950
7951
7952
7953
7954
7955
7956
7957
7958
7959
7960
7961
7962
7963
7964
7965
7966
7967
7968
7969
7970
7971
7972
7973
7974
7975
7976
7977
7978
7979
7980
7981
7982
7983
7984
7985
7986
7987
7988
7989
7990
7991
7992
7993
7994
7995
7996
7997
7998
7999
8000
8001
8002
8003
8004
8005
8006
8007
8008
8009
8010
8011
8012
8013
8014
8015
8016
8017
8018
8019
8020
8021
8022
8023
8024
8025
8026
8027
8028
8029
8030
8031
8032
8033
8034
8035
8036
8037
8038
8039
8040
8041
8042
8043
8044
8045
8046
8047
8048
8049
8050
8051
8052
8053
8054
8055
8056
8057
8058
8059
8060
8061
8062
8063
8064
8065
8066
8067
8068
8069
8070
8071
8072
8073
8074
8075
8076
8077
8078
8079
8080
8081
8082
8083
8084
8085
8086
8087
8088
8089
8090
8091
8092
8093
8094
8095
8096
8097
8098
8099
8100
8101
8102
8103
8104
8105
8106
8107
8108
8109
8110
8111
8112
8113
8114
8115
8116
8117
8118
8119
8120
8121
8122
8123
8124
8125
8126
8127
8128
8129
8130
8131
8132
8133
8134
8135
8136
8137
8138
8139
8140
8141
8142
8143
8144
8145
8146
8147
8148
8149
8150
8151
8152
8153
8154
8155
8156
8157
8158
8159
8160
8161
8162
8163
8164
8165
8166
8167
8168
8169
8170
8171
8172
8173
8174
8175
8176
8177
8178
8179
8180
8181
8182
8183
8184
8185
8186
8187
8188
8189
8190
8191
8192
8193
8194
8195
8196
8197
8198
8199
8200
8201
8202
8203
8204
8205
8206
8207
8208
8209
8210
8211
8212
8213
8214
8215
8216
8217
8218
8219
8220
8221
8222
8223
8224
8225
8226
8227
8228
8229
8230
8231
8232
8233
8234
8235
8236
8237
8238
8239
8240
8241
8242
8243
8244
8245
8246
8247
8248
8249
8250
8251
8252
8253
8254
8255
8256
8257
8258
8259
8260
8261
8262
8263
8264
8265
8266
8267
8268
8269
8270
8271
8272
8273
8274
8275
8276
8277
8278
8279
8280
8281
8282
8283
8284
8285
8286
8287
8288
8289
8290
8291
8292
8293
8294
8295
8296
8297
8298
8299
8300
8301
8302
8303
8304
8305
8306
8307
8308
8309
8310
8311
8312
8313
8314
8315
8316
8317
8318
8319
8320
8321
8322
8323
8324
8325
8326
8327
8328
8329
8330
8331
8332
8333
8334
8335
8336
8337
8338
8339
8340
8341
8342
8343
8344
8345
8346
8347
8348
8349
8350
8351
8352
8353
8354
8355
8356
8357
8358
8359
8360
8361
8362
8363
8364
8365
8366
8367
8368
8369
8370
8371
8372
8373
8374
8375
8376
8377
8378
8379
8380
8381
8382
8383
8384
8385
8386
8387
8388
8389
8390
8391
8392
8393
8394
8395
8396
8397
8398
8399
8400
8401
8402
8403
8404
8405
8406
8407
8408
8409
8410
8411
8412
8413
8414
8415
8416
8417
8418
8419
8420
8421
8422
8423
8424
8425
8426
8427
8428
8429
8430
8431
8432
8433
8434
8435
8436
8437
8438
8439
8440
8441
8442
8443
8444
8445
8446
8447
8448
8449
8450
8451
8452
8453
8454
8455
8456
8457
8458
8459
8460
8461
8462
8463
8464
8465
8466
8467
8468
8469
8470
8471
8472
8473
8474
8475
8476
8477
8478
8479
8480
8481
8482
8483
8484
8485
8486
8487
8488
8489
8490
8491
8492
8493
8494
8495
8496
8497
8498
8499
8500
8501
8502
8503
8504
8505
8506
8507
8508
8509
8510
8511
8512
8513
8514
8515
8516
8517
8518
8519
8520
8521
8522
8523
8524
8525
8526
8527
8528
8529
8530
8531
8532
8533
8534
8535
8536
8537
8538
8539
8540
8541
8542
8543
8544
8545
8546
8547
8548
8549
8550
8551
8552
8553
8554
8555
8556
8557
8558
8559
8560
8561
8562
8563
8564
8565
8566
8567
8568
8569
8570
8571
8572
8573
8574
8575
8576
8577
8578
8579
8580
8581
8582
8583
8584
8585
8586
8587
8588
8589
8590
8591
8592
8593
8594
8595
8596
8597
8598
8599
8600
8601
8602
8603
8604
8605
8606
8607
8608
8609
8610
8611
8612
8613
8614
8615
8616
8617
8618
8619
8620
8621
8622
8623
8624
8625
8626
8627
8628
8629
8630
8631
8632
8633
8634
8635
8636
8637
8638
8639
8640
8641
8642
8643
8644
8645
8646
8647
8648
8649
8650
8651
8652
8653
8654
8655
8656
8657
8658
8659
8660
8661
8662
8663
8664
8665
8666
8667
8668
8669
8670
8671
8672
8673
8674
8675
8676
8677
8678
8679
8680
8681
8682
8683
8684
8685
8686
8687
8688
8689
8690
8691
8692
8693
8694
8695
8696
8697
8698
8699
8700
8701
8702
8703
8704
8705
8706
8707
8708
8709
8710
8711
8712
8713
8714
8715
8716
8717
8718
8719
8720
8721
8722
8723
8724
8725
8726
8727
8728
8729
8730
8731
8732
8733
8734
8735
8736
8737
8738
8739
8740
8741
8742
8743
8744
8745
8746
8747
8748
8749
8750
8751
8752
8753
8754
8755
8756
8757
8758
8759
8760
8761
8762
8763
8764
8765
8766
8767
8768
8769
8770
8771
8772
8773
8774
8775
8776
8777
8778
8779
8780
8781
8782
8783
8784
8785
8786
8787
8788
8789
8790
8791
8792
8793
8794
8795
8796
8797
8798
8799
8800
8801
8802
8803
8804
8805
8806
8807
8808
8809
8810
8811
8812
8813
8814
8815
8816
8817
8818
8819
8820
8821
8822
8823
8824
8825
8826
8827
8828
8829
8830
8831
8832
8833
8834
8835
8836
8837
8838
8839
8840
8841
8842
8843
8844
8845
8846
8847
8848
8849
8850
8851
8852
8853
8854
8855
8856
8857
8858
8859
8860
8861
8862
8863
8864
8865
8866
8867
8868
8869
8870
8871
8872
8873
8874
8875
8876
8877
8878
8879
8880
8881
8882
8883
8884
8885
8886
8887
8888
8889
8890
8891
8892
8893
8894
8895
8896
8897
8898
8899
8900
8901
8902
8903
8904
8905
8906
8907
8908
8909
8910
8911
8912
8913
8914
8915
8916
8917
8918
8919
8920
8921
8922
8923
8924
8925
8926
8927
8928
8929
8930
8931
8932
8933
8934
8935
8936
8937
8938
8939
8940
8941
8942
8943
8944
8945
8946
8947
8948
8949
8950
8951
8952
8953
8954
8955
8956
8957
8958
8959
8960
8961
8962
8963
8964
8965
8966
8967
8968
8969
8970
8971
8972
8973
8974
8975
8976
8977
8978
8979
8980
8981
8982
8983
8984
8985
8986
8987
8988
8989
8990
8991
8992
8993
8994
8995
8996
8997
8998
8999
9000
9001
9002
9003
9004
9005
9006
9007
9008
9009
9010
9011
9012
9013
9014
9015
9016
9017
9018
9019
9020
9021
9022
9023
9024
9025
9026
9027
9028
9029
9030
9031
9032
9033
9034
9035
9036
9037
9038
9039
9040
9041
9042
9043
9044
9045
9046
9047
9048
9049
9050
9051
9052
9053
9054
9055
9056
9057
9058
9059
9060
9061
9062
9063
9064
9065
9066
9067
9068
9069
9070
9071
9072
9073
9074
9075
9076
9077
9078
9079
9080
9081
9082
9083
9084
9085
9086
9087
9088
9089
9090
9091
9092
9093
9094
9095
9096
9097
9098
9099
9100
9101
9102
9103
9104
9105
9106
9107
9108
9109
9110
9111
9112
9113
9114
9115
9116
9117
9118
9119
9120
9121
9122
9123
9124
9125
9126
9127
9128
9129
9130
9131
9132
9133
9134
9135
9136
9137
9138
9139
9140
9141
9142
9143
9144
9145
9146
9147
9148
9149
9150
9151
9152
9153
9154
9155
9156
9157
9158
9159
9160
9161
9162
9163
9164
9165
9166
9167
9168
9169
9170
9171
9172
9173
9174
9175
9176
9177
9178
9179
9180
9181
9182
9183
9184
9185
9186
9187
9188
9189
9190
9191
9192
9193
9194
9195
9196
9197
9198
9199
9200
9201
9202
9203
9204
9205
9206
9207
9208
9209
9210
9211
9212
9213
9214
9215
9216
9217
9218
9219
9220
9221
9222
9223
9224
9225
9226
9227
9228
9229
9230
9231
9232
9233
9234
9235
9236
9237
9238
9239
9240
9241
9242
9243
9244
9245
9246
9247
9248
9249
9250
9251
9252
9253
9254
9255
9256
9257
9258
9259
9260
9261
9262
9263
9264
9265
9266
9267
9268
9269
9270
9271
9272
9273
9274
9275
9276
9277
9278
9279
9280
9281
9282
9283
9284
9285
9286
9287
9288
9289
9290
9291
9292
9293
9294
9295
9296
9297
9298
9299
9300
9301
9302
9303
9304
9305
9306
9307
9308
9309
9310
9311
9312
9313
9314
9315
9316
9317
9318
9319
9320
9321
9322
9323
9324
9325
9326
9327
9328
9329
9330
9331
9332
9333
9334
9335
9336
9337
9338
9339
9340
9341
9342
9343
9344
9345
9346
9347
9348
9349
9350
9351
9352
9353
9354
9355
9356
9357
9358
9359
9360
9361
9362
9363
9364
9365
9366
9367
9368
9369
9370
9371
9372
9373
9374
9375
9376
9377
9378
9379
9380
9381
9382
9383
9384
9385
9386
9387
9388
9389
9390
9391
9392
9393
9394
9395
9396
9397
9398
9399
9400
9401
9402
9403
9404
9405
9406
9407
9408
9409
9410
9411
9412
9413
9414
9415
9416
9417
9418
9419
9420
9421
9422
9423
9424
9425
9426
9427
9428
9429
9430
9431
9432
9433
9434
9435
9436
9437
9438
9439
9440
9441
9442
9443
9444
9445
9446
9447
9448
9449
9450
9451
9452
9453
9454
9455
9456
9457
9458
9459
9460
9461
9462
9463
9464
9465
9466
9467
9468
9469
9470
9471
9472
9473
9474
9475
9476
9477
9478
9479
9480
9481
9482
9483
9484
9485
9486
9487
9488
9489
9490
9491
9492
9493
9494
9495
9496
9497
9498
9499
9500
9501
9502
9503
9504
9505
9506
9507
9508
9509
9510
9511
9512
9513
9514
9515
9516
9517
9518
9519
9520
9521
9522
9523
9524
9525
9526
9527
9528
9529
9530
9531
9532
9533
9534
9535
9536
9537
9538
9539
9540
9541
9542
9543
9544
9545
9546
9547
9548
9549
9550
9551
9552
9553
9554
9555
9556
9557
9558
9559
9560
9561
9562
9563
9564
9565
9566
9567
9568
9569
9570
9571
9572
9573
9574
9575
9576
9577
9578
9579
9580
9581
9582
9583
9584
9585
9586
9587
9588
9589
9590
9591
9592
9593
9594
9595
9596
9597
9598
9599
9600
9601
9602
9603
9604
9605
9606
9607
9608
9609
9610
9611
9612
9613
9614
9615
9616
9617
9618
9619
9620
9621
9622
9623
9624
9625
9626
9627
9628
9629
9630
9631
9632
9633
9634
9635
9636
9637
9638
9639
9640
9641
9642
9643
9644
9645
9646
9647
9648
9649
9650
9651
9652
9653
9654
9655
9656
9657
9658
9659
9660
9661
9662
9663
9664
9665
9666
9667
9668
9669
9670
9671
9672
9673
9674
9675
9676
9677
9678
9679
9680
9681
9682
9683
9684
9685
9686
9687
9688
9689
9690
9691
9692
9693
9694
9695
9696
9697
9698
9699
9700
9701
9702
9703
9704
9705
9706
9707
9708
9709
9710
9711
9712
9713
9714
9715
9716
9717
9718
9719
9720
9721
9722
9723
9724
9725
9726
9727
9728
9729
9730
9731
9732
9733
9734
9735
9736
9737
9738
9739
9740
9741
9742
9743
9744
9745
9746
9747
9748
9749
9750
9751
9752
9753
9754
9755
9756
9757
9758
9759
9760
9761
9762
9763
9764
9765
9766
9767
9768
9769
9770
9771
9772
9773
9774
9775
9776
9777
9778
9779
9780
9781
9782
9783
9784
9785
9786
9787
9788
9789
9790
9791
9792
9793
9794
9795
9796
9797
9798
9799
9800
9801
9802
9803
9804
9805
9806
9807
9808
9809
9810
9811
9812
9813
9814
9815
9816
9817
9818
9819
9820
9821
9822
9823
9824
9825
9826
9827
9828
9829
9830
9831
9832
9833
9834
9835
9836
9837
9838
9839
9840
9841
9842
9843
9844
9845
9846
9847
9848
9849
9850
9851
9852
9853
9854
9855
9856
9857
9858
9859
9860
9861
9862
9863
9864
9865
9866
9867
9868
9869
9870
9871
9872
9873
9874
9875
9876
9877
9878
9879
9880
9881
9882
9883
9884
9885
9886
9887
9888
9889
9890
9891
9892
9893
9894
9895
9896
9897
9898
9899
9900
9901
9902
9903
9904
9905
9906
9907
9908
9909
9910
9911
9912
9913
9914
9915
9916
9917
9918
9919
9920
9921
9922
9923
9924
9925
9926
9927
9928
9929
9930
9931
9932
9933
9934
9935
9936
9937
9938
9939
9940
9941
9942
9943
9944
9945
9946
9947
9948
9949
9950
9951
9952
9953
9954
9955
9956
9957
9958
9959
9960
9961
9962
9963
9964
9965
9966
9967
9968
9969
9970
9971
9972
9973
9974
9975
9976
9977
9978
9979
9980
9981
9982
9983
9984
9985
9986
9987
9988
9989
9990
9991
9992
9993
9994
9995
9996
9997
9998
9999
10000
10001
10002
10003
10004
10005
10006
10007
10008
10009
10010
10011
10012
10013
10014
10015
10016
10017
10018
10019
10020
10021
10022
10023
10024
10025
10026
10027
10028
10029
10030
10031
10032
10033
10034
10035
10036
10037
10038
10039
10040
10041
10042
10043
10044
10045
10046
10047
10048
10049
10050
10051
10052
10053
10054
10055
10056
10057
10058
10059
10060
10061
10062
10063
10064
10065
10066
10067
10068
10069
10070
10071
10072
10073
10074
10075
10076
10077
10078
10079
10080
10081
10082
10083
10084
10085
10086
10087
10088
10089
10090
10091
10092
10093
10094
10095
10096
10097
10098
10099
10100
10101
10102
10103
10104
10105
10106
10107
10108
10109
10110
10111
10112
10113
10114
10115
10116
10117
10118
10119
10120
10121
10122
10123
10124
10125
10126
10127
10128
10129
10130
10131
10132
10133
10134
10135
10136
10137
10138
10139
10140
10141
10142
10143
10144
10145
10146
10147
10148
10149
10150
10151
10152
10153
10154
10155
10156
10157
10158
10159
10160
10161
10162
10163
10164
10165
10166
10167
10168
10169
10170
10171
10172
10173
10174
10175
10176
10177
10178
10179
10180
10181
10182
10183
10184
10185
10186
10187
10188
10189
10190
10191
10192
10193
10194
10195
10196
10197
10198
10199
10200
10201
10202
10203
10204
10205
10206
10207
10208
10209
10210
10211
10212
10213
10214
10215
10216
10217
10218
10219
10220
10221
10222
10223
10224
10225
10226
10227
10228
10229
10230
10231
10232
10233
10234
10235
10236
10237
10238
10239
10240
10241
10242
10243
10244
10245
10246
10247
10248
10249
10250
10251
10252
10253
10254
10255
10256
10257
10258
10259
10260
10261
10262
10263
10264
10265
10266
10267
10268
10269
10270
10271
10272
10273
10274
10275
10276
10277
10278
10279
10280
10281
10282
10283
10284
10285
10286
10287
10288
10289
10290
10291
10292
10293
10294
10295
10296
10297
10298
10299
10300
10301
10302
10303
10304
10305
10306
10307
10308
10309
10310
10311
10312
10313
10314
10315
10316
10317
10318
10319
10320
10321
10322
10323
10324
10325
10326
10327
10328
10329
10330
10331
10332
10333
10334
10335
10336
10337
10338
10339
10340
10341
10342
10343
10344
10345
10346
10347
10348
10349
10350
10351
10352
10353
10354
10355
10356
10357
10358
10359
10360
10361
10362
10363
10364
10365
10366
10367
10368
10369
10370
10371
10372
10373
10374
10375
10376
10377
10378
10379
10380
10381
10382
10383
10384
10385
10386
10387
10388
10389
10390
10391
10392
10393
10394
10395
10396
10397
10398
10399
10400
10401
10402
10403
10404
10405
10406
10407
10408
10409
10410
10411
10412
10413
10414
10415
10416
10417
10418
10419
10420
10421
10422
10423
10424
10425
10426
10427
10428
10429
10430
10431
10432
10433
10434
10435
10436
10437
10438
10439
10440
10441
10442
10443
10444
10445
10446
10447
10448
10449
10450
10451
10452
10453
10454
10455
10456
10457
10458
10459
10460
10461
10462
10463
10464
10465
10466
10467
10468
10469
10470
10471
10472
10473
10474
10475
10476
10477
10478
10479
10480
10481
10482
10483
10484
10485
10486
10487
10488
10489
10490
10491
10492
10493
10494
10495
10496
10497
10498
10499
10500
10501
10502
10503
10504
10505
10506
10507
10508
10509
10510
10511
10512
10513
10514
10515
10516
10517
10518
10519
10520
10521
10522
10523
10524
10525
10526
10527
10528
10529
10530
10531
10532
10533
10534
10535
10536
10537
10538
10539
10540
10541
10542
10543
10544
10545
10546
10547
10548
10549
10550
10551
10552
10553
10554
10555
10556
10557
10558
10559
10560
10561
10562
10563
10564
10565
10566
10567
10568
10569
10570
10571
10572
10573
10574
10575
10576
10577
10578
10579
10580
10581
10582
10583
10584
10585
10586
10587
10588
10589
10590
10591
10592
10593
10594
10595
10596
10597
10598
10599
10600
10601
10602
10603
10604
10605
10606
10607
10608
10609
10610
10611
10612
10613
10614
10615
10616
10617
10618
10619
10620
10621
10622
10623
10624
10625
10626
10627
10628
10629
10630
10631
10632
10633
10634
10635
10636
10637
10638
10639
10640
10641
10642
10643
10644
10645
10646
10647
10648
10649
10650
10651
10652
10653
10654
10655
10656
10657
10658
10659
10660
10661
10662
10663
10664
10665
10666
10667
10668
10669
10670
10671
10672
10673
10674
10675
10676
10677
10678
10679
10680
10681
10682
10683
10684
10685
10686
10687
10688
10689
10690
10691
10692
10693
10694
10695
10696
10697
10698
10699
10700
10701
10702
10703
10704
10705
10706
10707
10708
10709
10710
10711
10712
10713
10714
10715
10716
10717
10718
10719
10720
10721
10722
10723
10724
10725
10726
10727
10728
10729
10730
10731
10732
10733
10734
10735
10736
10737
10738
10739
10740
10741
10742
10743
10744
10745
10746
10747
10748
10749
10750
10751
10752
10753
10754
10755
10756
10757
10758
10759
10760
10761
10762
10763
10764
10765
10766
10767
10768
10769
10770
10771
10772
10773
10774
10775
10776
10777
10778
10779
10780
10781
10782
10783
10784
10785
10786
10787
10788
10789
10790
10791
10792
10793
10794
10795
10796
10797
10798
10799
10800
10801
10802
10803
10804
10805
10806
10807
10808
10809
10810
10811
10812
10813
10814
10815
10816
10817
10818
10819
10820
10821
10822
10823
10824
10825
10826
10827
10828
10829
10830
10831
10832
10833
10834
10835
10836
10837
10838
10839
10840
10841
10842
10843
10844
10845
10846
10847
10848
10849
10850
10851
10852
10853
10854
10855
10856
10857
10858
10859
10860
10861
10862
10863
10864
10865
10866
10867
10868
10869
10870
10871
10872
10873
10874
10875
10876
10877
10878
10879
10880
10881
10882
10883
10884
10885
10886
10887
10888
10889
10890
10891
10892
10893
10894
10895
10896
10897
10898
10899
10900
10901
10902
10903
10904
10905
10906
10907
10908
10909
10910
10911
10912
10913
10914
10915
10916
10917
10918
10919
10920
10921
10922
10923
10924
10925
10926
10927
10928
10929
10930
10931
10932
10933
10934
10935
10936
10937
10938
10939
10940
10941
10942
10943
10944
10945
10946
10947
10948
10949
10950
10951
10952
10953
10954
10955
10956
10957
10958
10959
10960
10961
10962
10963
10964
10965
10966
10967
10968
10969
10970
10971
10972
10973
10974
10975
10976
10977
10978
10979
10980
10981
10982
10983
10984
10985
10986
10987
10988
10989
10990
10991
10992
10993
10994
10995
10996
10997
10998
10999
11000
11001
11002
11003
11004
11005
11006
11007
11008
11009
11010
11011
11012
11013
11014
11015
11016
11017
11018
11019
11020
11021
11022
11023
11024
11025
11026
11027
11028
11029
11030
11031
11032
11033
11034
11035
11036
11037
11038
11039
11040
11041
11042
11043
11044
11045
11046
11047
11048
11049
11050
11051
11052
11053
11054
11055
11056
11057
11058
11059
11060
11061
11062
11063
11064
11065
11066
11067
11068
11069
11070
11071
11072
11073
11074
11075
11076
11077
11078
11079
11080
11081
11082
11083
11084
11085
11086
11087
11088
11089
11090
11091
11092
11093
11094
11095
11096
11097
11098
11099
11100
11101
11102
11103
11104
11105
11106
11107
11108
11109
11110
11111
11112
11113
11114
11115
11116
11117
11118
11119
11120
11121
11122
11123
11124
11125
11126
11127
11128
11129
11130
11131
11132
11133
11134
11135
11136
11137
11138
11139
11140
11141
11142
11143
11144
11145
11146
11147
11148
11149
11150
11151
11152
11153
11154
11155
11156
11157
11158
11159
11160
11161
11162
11163
11164
11165
11166
11167
11168
11169
11170
11171
11172
11173
11174
11175
11176
11177
11178
11179
11180
11181
11182
11183
11184
11185
11186
11187
11188
11189
11190
11191
11192
11193
11194
11195
11196
11197
11198
11199
11200
11201
11202
11203
11204
11205
11206
11207
11208
11209
11210
11211
11212
11213
11214
11215
11216
11217
11218
11219
11220
11221
11222
11223
11224
11225
11226
11227
11228
11229
11230
11231
11232
11233
11234
11235
11236
11237
11238
11239
11240
11241
11242
11243
11244
11245
11246
11247
11248
11249
11250
11251
11252
11253
11254
11255
11256
11257
11258
11259
11260
11261
11262
11263
11264
11265
11266
11267
11268
11269
11270
11271
11272
11273
11274
11275
11276
11277
11278
11279
11280
11281
11282
11283
11284
11285
11286
11287
11288
11289
11290
11291
11292
11293
11294
11295
11296
11297
11298
11299
11300
11301
11302
11303
11304
11305
11306
11307
11308
11309
11310
11311
11312
11313
11314
11315
11316
11317
11318
11319
11320
11321
11322
11323
11324
11325
11326
11327
11328
11329
11330
11331
11332
11333
11334
11335
11336
11337
11338
11339
11340
11341
11342
11343
11344
11345
11346
11347
11348
11349
11350
11351
11352
11353
11354
11355
11356
11357
11358
11359
11360
11361
11362
11363
11364
11365
11366
11367
11368
11369
11370
11371
11372
11373
11374
11375
11376
11377
11378
11379
11380
11381
11382
11383
11384
11385
11386
11387
11388
11389
11390
11391
11392
11393
11394
11395
11396
11397
11398
11399
11400
11401
11402
11403
11404
11405
11406
11407
11408
11409
11410
11411
11412
11413
11414
11415
11416
11417
11418
11419
11420
11421
11422
11423
11424
11425
11426
11427
11428
11429
11430
11431
11432
11433
11434
11435
11436
11437
11438
11439
11440
11441
11442
11443
11444
11445
11446
11447
11448
11449
11450
11451
11452
11453
11454
11455
11456
11457
11458
11459
11460
11461
11462
11463
11464
11465
11466
11467
11468
11469
11470
11471
11472
11473
11474
11475
11476
11477
11478
11479
11480
11481
11482
11483
11484
11485
11486
11487
11488
11489
11490
11491
11492
11493
11494
11495
11496
11497
11498
11499
11500
11501
11502
11503
11504
11505
11506
11507
11508
11509
11510
11511
11512
11513
11514
11515
11516
11517
11518
11519
11520
11521
11522
11523
11524
11525
11526
11527
11528
11529
11530
11531
11532
11533
11534
11535
11536
11537
11538
11539
11540
11541
11542
11543
11544
11545
11546
11547
11548
11549
11550
11551
11552
11553
11554
11555
11556
11557
11558
11559
11560
11561
11562
11563
11564
11565
11566
11567
11568
11569
11570
11571
11572
11573
11574
11575
11576
11577
11578
11579
11580
11581
11582
11583
11584
11585
11586
11587
11588
11589
11590
11591
11592
11593
11594
11595
11596
11597
11598
11599
11600
11601
11602
11603
11604
11605
11606
11607
11608
11609
11610
11611
11612
11613
11614
11615
11616
11617
11618
11619
11620
11621
11622
11623
11624
11625
11626
11627
11628
11629
11630
11631
11632
11633
11634
11635
11636
11637
11638
11639
11640
11641
11642
11643
11644
11645
11646
11647
11648
11649
11650
11651
11652
11653
11654
11655
11656
11657
11658
11659
11660
11661
11662
11663
11664
11665
11666
11667
11668
11669
11670
11671
11672
11673
11674
11675
11676
11677
11678
11679
11680
11681
11682
11683
11684
11685
11686
11687
11688
11689
11690
11691
11692
11693
11694
11695
11696
11697
11698
11699
11700
11701
11702
11703
11704
11705
11706
11707
11708
11709
11710
11711
11712
11713
11714
11715
11716
11717
11718
11719
11720
11721
11722
11723
11724
11725
11726
11727
11728
11729
11730
11731
11732
11733
11734
11735
11736
11737
11738
11739
11740
11741
11742
11743
11744
11745
11746
11747
11748
11749
11750
11751
11752
11753
11754
11755
11756
11757
11758
11759
11760
11761
11762
11763
11764
11765
11766
11767
11768
11769
11770
11771
11772
11773
11774
11775
11776
11777
11778
11779
11780
11781
11782
11783
11784
11785
11786
11787
11788
11789
11790
11791
11792
11793
11794
11795
11796
11797
11798
11799
11800
11801
11802
11803
11804
11805
11806
11807
11808
11809
11810
11811
11812
11813
11814
11815
11816
11817
11818
11819
11820
11821
11822
11823
11824
11825
11826
11827
11828
11829
11830
11831
11832
11833
11834
11835
11836
11837
11838
11839
11840
11841
11842
11843
11844
11845
11846
11847
11848
11849
11850
11851
11852
11853
11854
11855
11856
11857
11858
11859
11860
11861
11862
11863
11864
11865
11866
11867
11868
11869
11870
11871
11872
11873
11874
11875
11876
11877
11878
11879
11880
11881
11882
11883
11884
11885
11886
11887
11888
11889
11890
11891
11892
11893
11894
11895
11896
11897
11898
11899
11900
11901
11902
11903
11904
11905
11906
11907
11908
11909
11910
11911
11912
11913
11914
11915
11916
11917
11918
11919
11920
11921
11922
11923
11924
11925
11926
11927
11928
11929
11930
11931
11932
11933
11934
11935
11936
11937
11938
11939
11940
11941
11942
11943
11944
11945
11946
11947
11948
11949
11950
11951
11952
11953
11954
11955
11956
11957
11958
11959
11960
11961
11962
11963
11964
11965
11966
11967
11968
11969
11970
11971
11972
11973
11974
11975
11976
11977
11978
11979
11980
11981
11982
11983
11984
11985
11986
11987
11988
11989
11990
11991
11992
11993
11994
11995
11996
11997
11998
11999
12000
12001
12002
12003
12004
12005
12006
12007
12008
12009
12010
12011
12012
12013
12014
12015
12016
12017
12018
12019
12020
12021
12022
12023
12024
12025
12026
12027
12028
12029
12030
12031
12032
12033
12034
12035
12036
12037
12038
12039
12040
12041
12042
12043
12044
12045
12046
12047
12048
12049
12050
12051
12052
12053
12054
12055
12056
12057
12058
12059
12060
12061
12062
12063
12064
12065
12066
12067
12068
12069
12070
12071
12072
12073
12074
12075
12076
12077
12078
12079
12080
12081
12082
12083
12084
12085
12086
12087
12088
12089
12090
12091
12092
12093
12094
12095
12096
12097
12098
12099
12100
12101
12102
12103
12104
12105
12106
12107
12108
12109
12110
12111
12112
12113
12114
12115
12116
12117
12118
12119
12120
12121
12122
12123
12124
12125
12126
12127
12128
12129
12130
12131
12132
12133
12134
12135
12136
12137
12138
12139
12140
12141
12142
12143
12144
12145
12146
12147
12148
12149
12150
12151
12152
12153
12154
12155
12156
12157
12158
12159
12160
12161
12162
12163
12164
12165
12166
12167
12168
12169
12170
12171
12172
12173
12174
12175
12176
12177
12178
12179
12180
12181
12182
12183
12184
12185
12186
12187
12188
12189
12190
12191
12192
12193
12194
12195
12196
12197
12198
12199
12200
12201
12202
12203
12204
12205
12206
12207
12208
12209
12210
12211
12212
12213
12214
12215
12216
12217
12218
12219
12220
12221
12222
12223
12224
12225
12226
12227
12228
12229
12230
12231
12232
12233
12234
12235
12236
12237
12238
12239
12240
12241
12242
12243
12244
12245
12246
12247
12248
12249
12250
12251
12252
12253
12254
12255
12256
12257
12258
12259
12260
12261
12262
12263
12264
12265
12266
12267
12268
12269
12270
12271
12272
12273
12274
12275
12276
12277
12278
12279
12280
12281
12282
12283
12284
12285
12286
12287
12288
12289
12290
12291
12292
12293
12294
12295
12296
12297
12298
12299
12300
12301
12302
12303
12304
12305
12306
12307
12308
12309
12310
12311
12312
12313
12314
12315
12316
12317
12318
12319
12320
12321
12322
12323
12324
12325
12326
12327
12328
12329
12330
12331
12332
12333
12334
12335
12336
12337
12338
12339
12340
12341
12342
12343
12344
12345
12346
12347
12348
12349
12350
12351
12352
12353
12354
12355
12356
12357
12358
12359
12360
12361
12362
12363
12364
12365
12366
12367
12368
12369
12370
12371
12372
12373
12374
12375
12376
12377
12378
12379
12380
12381
12382
12383
12384
12385
12386
12387
12388
12389
12390
12391
12392
12393
12394
12395
12396
12397
12398
12399
12400
12401
12402
12403
12404
12405
12406
12407
12408
12409
12410
12411
12412
12413
12414
12415
12416
12417
12418
12419
12420
12421
12422
12423
12424
12425
12426
12427
12428
12429
12430
12431
12432
12433
12434
12435
12436
12437
12438
12439
12440
12441
12442
12443
12444
12445
12446
12447
12448
12449
12450
12451
12452
12453
12454
12455
12456
12457
12458
12459
12460
12461
12462
12463
12464
12465
12466
12467
12468
12469
12470
12471
12472
12473
12474
12475
12476
12477
12478
12479
12480
12481
12482
12483
12484
12485
12486
12487
12488
12489
12490
12491
12492
12493
12494
12495
12496
12497
12498
12499
12500
12501
12502
12503
12504
12505
12506
12507
12508
12509
12510
12511
12512
12513
12514
12515
12516
12517
12518
12519
12520
12521
12522
12523
12524
12525
12526
12527
12528
12529
12530
12531
12532
12533
12534
12535
12536
12537
12538
12539
12540
12541
12542
12543
12544
12545
12546
12547
12548
12549
12550
12551
12552
12553
12554
12555
12556
12557
12558
12559
12560
12561
12562
12563
12564
12565
12566
12567
12568
12569
12570
12571
12572
12573
12574
12575
12576
12577
12578
12579
12580
12581
12582
12583
12584
12585
12586
12587
12588
12589
12590
12591
12592
12593
12594
12595
12596
12597
12598
12599
12600
12601
12602
12603
12604
12605
12606
12607
12608
12609
12610
12611
12612
12613
12614
12615
12616
12617
12618
12619
12620
12621
12622
12623
12624
12625
12626
12627
12628
12629
12630
12631
12632
12633
12634
12635
12636
12637
12638
12639
12640
12641
12642
12643
12644
12645
12646
12647
12648
12649
12650
12651
12652
12653
12654
12655
12656
12657
12658
12659
12660
12661
12662
12663
12664
12665
12666
12667
12668
12669
12670
12671
12672
12673
12674
12675
12676
12677
12678
12679
12680
12681
12682
12683
12684
12685
12686
12687
12688
12689
12690
12691
12692
12693
12694
12695
12696
12697
12698
12699
12700
12701
12702
12703
12704
12705
12706
12707
12708
12709
12710
12711
12712
12713
12714
12715
12716
12717
12718
12719
12720
12721
12722
12723
12724
12725
12726
12727
12728
12729
12730
12731
12732
12733
12734
12735
12736
12737
12738
12739
12740
12741
12742
12743
12744
12745
12746
12747
12748
12749
12750
12751
12752
12753
12754
12755
12756
12757
12758
12759
12760
12761
12762
12763
12764
12765
12766
12767
12768
12769
12770
12771
12772
12773
12774
12775
12776
12777
12778
12779
12780
12781
12782
12783
12784
12785
12786
12787
12788
12789
12790
12791
12792
12793
12794
12795
12796
12797
12798
12799
12800
12801
12802
12803
12804
12805
12806
12807
12808
12809
12810
12811
12812
12813
12814
12815
12816
12817
12818
12819
12820
12821
12822
12823
12824
12825
12826
12827
12828
12829
12830
12831
12832
12833
12834
12835
12836
12837
12838
12839
12840
12841
12842
12843
12844
12845
12846
12847
12848
12849
12850
12851
12852
12853
12854
12855
12856
12857
12858
12859
12860
12861
12862
12863
12864
12865
12866
12867
12868
12869
12870
12871
12872
12873
12874
12875
12876
12877
12878
12879
12880
12881
12882
12883
12884
12885
12886
12887
12888
12889
12890
12891
12892
12893
12894
12895
12896
12897
12898
12899
12900
12901
12902
12903
12904
12905
12906
12907
12908
12909
12910
12911
12912
12913
12914
12915
12916
12917
12918
12919
12920
12921
12922
12923
12924
12925
12926
12927
12928
12929
12930
12931
12932
12933
12934
12935
12936
12937
12938
12939
12940
12941
12942
12943
12944
12945
12946
12947
12948
12949
12950
12951
12952
12953
12954
12955
12956
12957
12958
12959
12960
12961
12962
12963
12964
12965
12966
12967
12968
12969
12970
12971
12972
12973
12974
12975
12976
12977
12978
12979
12980
12981
12982
12983
12984
12985
12986
12987
12988
12989
12990
12991
12992
12993
12994
12995
12996
12997
12998
12999
13000
13001
13002
13003
13004
13005
13006
13007
13008
13009
13010
13011
13012
13013
13014
13015
13016
13017
13018
13019
13020
13021
13022
13023
13024
13025
13026
13027
13028
13029
13030
13031
13032
13033
13034
13035
13036
13037
13038
13039
13040
13041
13042
13043
13044
13045
13046
13047
13048
13049
13050
13051
13052
13053
13054
13055
13056
13057
13058
13059
13060
13061
13062
13063
13064
13065
13066
13067
13068
13069
13070
13071
13072
13073
13074
13075
13076
13077
13078
13079
13080
13081
13082
13083
13084
13085
13086
13087
13088
13089
13090
13091
13092
13093
13094
13095
13096
13097
13098
13099
13100
13101
13102
13103
13104
13105
13106
13107
13108
13109
13110
13111
13112
13113
13114
13115
13116
13117
13118
13119
13120
13121
13122
13123
13124
13125
13126
13127
13128
13129
13130
13131
13132
13133
13134
13135
13136
13137
13138
13139
13140
13141
13142
13143
13144
13145
13146
13147
13148
13149
13150
13151
13152
13153
13154
13155
13156
13157
13158
13159
13160
13161
13162
13163
13164
13165
13166
13167
13168
13169
13170
13171
13172
13173
13174
13175
13176
13177
13178
13179
13180
13181
13182
13183
13184
13185
13186
13187
13188
13189
13190
13191
13192
13193
13194
13195
13196
13197
13198
13199
13200
13201
13202
13203
13204
13205
13206
13207
13208
13209
13210
13211
13212
13213
13214
13215
13216
13217
13218
13219
13220
13221
13222
13223
13224
13225
13226
13227
13228
13229
13230
13231
13232
13233
13234
13235
13236
13237
13238
13239
13240
13241
13242
13243
13244
13245
13246
13247
13248
13249
13250
13251
13252
13253
13254
13255
13256
13257
13258
13259
13260
13261
13262
13263
13264
13265
13266
13267
13268
13269
13270
13271
13272
13273
13274
13275
13276
13277
13278
13279
13280
13281
13282
13283
13284
13285
13286
13287
13288
13289
13290
13291
13292
13293
13294
13295
13296
13297
13298
13299
13300
13301
13302
13303
13304
13305
13306
13307
13308
13309
13310
13311
13312
13313
13314
13315
13316
13317
13318
13319
13320
13321
13322
13323
13324
13325
13326
13327
13328
13329
13330
13331
13332
13333
13334
13335
13336
13337
13338
13339
13340
13341
13342
13343
13344
13345
13346
13347
13348
13349
13350
13351
13352
13353
13354
13355
13356
13357
13358
13359
13360
13361
13362
13363
13364
13365
13366
13367
13368
13369
13370
13371
13372
13373
13374
13375
13376
13377
13378
13379
13380
13381
13382
13383
13384
13385
13386
13387
13388
13389
13390
13391
13392
13393
13394
13395
13396
13397
13398
13399
13400
13401
13402
13403
13404
13405
13406
13407
13408
13409
13410
13411
13412
13413
13414
13415
13416
13417
13418
13419
13420
13421
13422
13423
13424
13425
13426
13427
13428
13429
13430
13431
13432
13433
13434
13435
13436
13437
13438
13439
13440
13441
13442
13443
13444
13445
13446
13447
13448
13449
13450
13451
13452
13453
13454
13455
13456
13457
13458
13459
13460
13461
13462
13463
13464
13465
13466
13467
13468
13469
13470
13471
13472
13473
13474
13475
13476
13477
13478
13479
13480
13481
13482
13483
13484
13485
13486
13487
13488
13489
13490
13491
13492
13493
13494
13495
13496
13497
13498
13499
13500
13501
13502
13503
13504
13505
13506
13507
13508
13509
13510
13511
13512
13513
13514
13515
13516
13517
13518
13519
13520
13521
13522
13523
13524
13525
13526
13527
13528
13529
13530
13531
13532
13533
13534
13535
13536
13537
13538
13539
13540
13541
13542
13543
13544
13545
13546
13547
13548
13549
13550
13551
13552
13553
13554
13555
13556
13557
13558
13559
13560
13561
13562
13563
13564
13565
13566
13567
13568
13569
13570
13571
13572
13573
13574
13575
13576
13577
13578
13579
13580
13581
13582
13583
13584
13585
13586
13587
13588
13589
13590
13591
13592
13593
13594
13595
13596
13597
13598
13599
13600
13601
13602
13603
13604
13605
13606
13607
13608
13609
13610
13611
13612
13613
13614
13615
13616
13617
13618
13619
13620
13621
13622
13623
13624
13625
13626
13627
13628
13629
13630
13631
13632
13633
13634
13635
13636
13637
13638
13639
13640
13641
13642
13643
13644
13645
13646
13647
13648
13649
13650
13651
13652
13653
13654
13655
13656
13657
13658
13659
13660
13661
13662
13663
13664
13665
13666
13667
13668
13669
13670
13671
13672
13673
13674
13675
13676
13677
13678
13679
13680
13681
13682
13683
13684
13685
13686
13687
13688
13689
13690
13691
13692
13693
13694
13695
13696
13697
13698
13699
13700
13701
13702
13703
13704
13705
13706
13707
13708
13709
13710
13711
13712
13713
13714
13715
13716
13717
13718
13719
13720
13721
13722
13723
13724
13725
13726
13727
13728
13729
13730
13731
13732
13733
13734
13735
13736
13737
13738
13739
13740
13741
13742
13743
13744
13745
13746
13747
13748
13749
13750
13751
13752
13753
13754
13755
13756
13757
13758
13759
13760
13761
13762
13763
13764
13765
13766
13767
13768
13769
13770
13771
13772
13773
13774
13775
13776
13777
13778
13779
13780
13781
13782
13783
13784
13785
13786
13787
13788
13789
13790
13791
13792
13793
13794
13795
13796
13797
13798
13799
13800
13801
13802
13803
13804
13805
13806
13807
13808
13809
13810
13811
13812
13813
13814
13815
13816
13817
13818
13819
13820
13821
13822
13823
13824
13825
13826
13827
13828
13829
13830 | <!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.0//EN">
<html>
<head>
<meta http-equiv="content-type" content="text/html; charset=iso-8859-1">
<title>Debian Policy Manual</title>
<link href="#index" rel="start">
<link href="#contents" rel="contents">
<link href="#copyright" rel="copyright">
<link href="#ch-scope" rel="chapter" title="1 About this manual">
<link href="#ch-archive" rel="chapter" title="2 The Debian Archive">
<link href="#ch-binary" rel="chapter" title="3 Binary packages">
<link href="#ch-source" rel="chapter" title="4 Source packages">
<link href="#ch-controlfields" rel="chapter" title="5 Control files and their fields">
<link href="#ch-maintainerscripts" rel="chapter" title="6 Package maintainer scripts and installation procedure">
<link href="#ch-relationships" rel="chapter" title="7 Declaring relationships between packages">
<link href="#ch-sharedlibs" rel="chapter" title="8 Shared libraries">
<link href="#ch-opersys" rel="chapter" title="9 The Operating System">
<link href="#ch-files" rel="chapter" title="10 Files">
<link href="#ch-customized-programs" rel="chapter" title="11 Customized programs">
<link href="#ch-docs" rel="chapter" title="12 Documentation">
<link href="#ap-pkg-scope" rel="appendix" title="A Introduction and scope of these appendices">
<link href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg" rel="appendix" title="B Binary packages (from old Packaging Manual)">
<link href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg" rel="appendix" title="C Source packages (from old Packaging Manual)">
<link href="#ap-pkg-controlfields" rel="appendix" title="D Control files and their fields (from old Packaging Manual)">
<link href="#ap-pkg-conffiles" rel="appendix" title="E Configuration file handling (from old Packaging Manual)">
<link href="#ap-pkg-alternatives" rel="appendix" title="F Alternative versions of an interface - update-alternatives (from old Packaging Manual)">
<link href="#ap-pkg-diversions" rel="appendix" title="G Diversions - overriding a package's version of a file (from old Packaging Manual)">
<link href="#s1.1" rel="section" title="1.1 Scope">
<link href="#s1.2" rel="section" title="1.2 New versions of this document">
<link href="#s-authors" rel="section" title="1.3 Authors and Maintainers">
<link href="#s-related" rel="section" title="1.4 Related documents">
<link href="#s-definitions" rel="section" title="1.5 Definitions">
<link href="#s-dfsg" rel="section" title="2.1 The Debian Free Software Guidelines">
<link href="#s-sections" rel="section" title="2.2 Archive areas">
<link href="#s-pkgcopyright" rel="section" title="2.3 Copyright considerations">
<link href="#s-subsections" rel="section" title="2.4 Sections">
<link href="#s-priorities" rel="section" title="2.5 Priorities">
<link href="#s3.1" rel="section" title="3.1 The package name">
<link href="#s-versions" rel="section" title="3.2 The version of a package">
<link href="#s-maintainer" rel="section" title="3.3 The maintainer of a package">
<link href="#s-descriptions" rel="section" title="3.4 The description of a package">
<link href="#s-dependencies" rel="section" title="3.5 Dependencies">
<link href="#s-virtual_pkg" rel="section" title="3.6 Virtual packages">
<link href="#s3.7" rel="section" title="3.7 Base system">
<link href="#s3.8" rel="section" title="3.8 Essential packages">
<link href="#s-maintscripts" rel="section" title="3.9 Maintainer Scripts">
<link href="#s-standardsversion" rel="section" title="4.1 Standards conformance">
<link href="#s-pkg-relations" rel="section" title="4.2 Package relationships">
<link href="#s4.3" rel="section" title="4.3 Changes to the upstream sources">
<link href="#s-dpkgchangelog" rel="section" title="4.4 Debian changelog: debian/changelog">
<link href="#s-dpkgcopyright" rel="section" title="4.5 Copyright: debian/copyright">
<link href="#s4.6" rel="section" title="4.6 Error trapping in makefiles">
<link href="#s-timestamps" rel="section" title="4.7 Time Stamps">
<link href="#s-restrictions" rel="section" title="4.8 Restrictions on objects in source packages">
<link href="#s-debianrules" rel="section" title="4.9 Main building script: debian/rules">
<link href="#s-substvars" rel="section" title="4.10 Variable substitutions: debian/substvars">
<link href="#s-debianwatch" rel="section" title="4.11 Optional upstream source location: debian/watch">
<link href="#s-debianfiles" rel="section" title="4.12 Generated files list: debian/files">
<link href="#s-embeddedfiles" rel="section" title="4.13 Convenience copies of code">
<link href="#s-readmesource" rel="section" title="4.14 Source package handling: debian/README.source">
<link href="#s-controlsyntax" rel="section" title="5.1 Syntax of control files">
<link href="#s-sourcecontrolfiles" rel="section" title="5.2 Source package control files -- debian/control">
<link href="#s-binarycontrolfiles" rel="section" title="5.3 Binary package control files -- DEBIAN/control">
<link href="#s-debiansourcecontrolfiles" rel="section" title="5.4 Debian source control files -- .dsc">
<link href="#s-debianchangesfiles" rel="section" title="5.5 Debian changes files -- .changes">
<link href="#s-controlfieldslist" rel="section" title="5.6 List of fields">
<link href="#s5.7" rel="section" title="5.7 User-defined fields">
<link href="#s-obsolete-control-data-fields" rel="section" title="5.8 Obsolete fields">
<link href="#s6.1" rel="section" title="6.1 Introduction to package maintainer scripts">
<link href="#s-idempotency" rel="section" title="6.2 Maintainer scripts idempotency">
<link href="#s-controllingterminal" rel="section" title="6.3 Controlling terminal for maintainer scripts">
<link href="#s-exitstatus" rel="section" title="6.4 Exit status">
<link href="#s-mscriptsinstact" rel="section" title="6.5 Summary of ways maintainer scripts are called">
<link href="#s-unpackphase" rel="section" title="6.6 Details of unpack phase of installation or upgrade">
<link href="#s-configdetails" rel="section" title="6.7 Details of configuration">
<link href="#s-removedetails" rel="section" title="6.8 Details of removal and/or configuration purging">
<link href="#s-depsyntax" rel="section" title="7.1 Syntax of relationship fields">
<link href="#s-binarydeps" rel="section" title="7.2 Binary Dependencies - Depends, Recommends, Suggests, Enhances, Pre-Depends">
<link href="#s-breaks" rel="section" title="7.3 Packages which break other packages - Breaks">
<link href="#s-conflicts" rel="section" title="7.4 Conflicting binary packages - Conflicts">
<link href="#s-virtual" rel="section" title="7.5 Virtual packages - Provides">
<link href="#s-replaces" rel="section" title="7.6 Overwriting files and replacing packages - Replaces">
<link href="#s-sourcebinarydeps" rel="section" title="7.7 Relationships between source and binary packages - Build-Depends, Build-Depends-Indep, Build-Conflicts, Build-Conflicts-Indep">
<link href="#s-built-using" rel="section" title="7.8 Additional source packages used to build the binary - Built-Using">
<link href="#s-sharedlibs-runtime" rel="section" title="8.1 Run-time shared libraries">
<link href="#s-sharedlibs-support-files" rel="section" title="8.2 Shared library support files">
<link href="#s-sharedlibs-static" rel="section" title="8.3 Static libraries">
<link href="#s-sharedlibs-dev" rel="section" title="8.4 Development files">
<link href="#s-sharedlibs-intradeps" rel="section" title="8.5 Dependencies between the packages of the same library">
<link href="#s-sharedlibs-depends" rel="section" title="8.6 Dependencies between the library and other packages">
<link href="#s9.1" rel="section" title="9.1 File system hierarchy">
<link href="#s9.2" rel="section" title="9.2 Users and groups">
<link href="#s-sysvinit" rel="section" title="9.3 System run levels and init.d scripts">
<link href="#s9.4" rel="section" title="9.4 Console messages from init.d scripts">
<link href="#s-cron-jobs" rel="section" title="9.5 Cron jobs">
<link href="#s-menus" rel="section" title="9.6 Menus">
<link href="#s-mime" rel="section" title="9.7 Multimedia handlers">
<link href="#s9.8" rel="section" title="9.8 Keyboard configuration">
<link href="#s9.9" rel="section" title="9.9 Environment variables">
<link href="#s-doc-base" rel="section" title="9.10 Registering Documents using doc-base">
<link href="#s-alternateinit" rel="section" title="9.11 Alternate init systems">
<link href="#s-binaries" rel="section" title="10.1 Binaries">
<link href="#s-libraries" rel="section" title="10.2 Libraries">
<link href="#s10.3" rel="section" title="10.3 Shared libraries">
<link href="#s-scripts" rel="section" title="10.4 Scripts">
<link href="#s10.5" rel="section" title="10.5 Symbolic links">
<link href="#s10.6" rel="section" title="10.6 Device files">
<link href="#s-config-files" rel="section" title="10.7 Configuration files">
<link href="#s10.8" rel="section" title="10.8 Log files">
<link href="#s-permissions-owners" rel="section" title="10.9 Permissions and owners">
<link href="#s-filenames" rel="section" title="10.10 File names">
<link href="#s-arch-spec" rel="section" title="11.1 Architecture specification strings">
<link href="#s11.2" rel="section" title="11.2 Daemons">
<link href="#s11.3" rel="section" title="11.3 Using pseudo-ttys and modifying wtmp, utmp and lastlog">
<link href="#s11.4" rel="section" title="11.4 Editors and pagers">
<link href="#s-web-appl" rel="section" title="11.5 Web servers and applications">
<link href="#s-mail-transport-agents" rel="section" title="11.6 Mail transport, delivery and user agents">
<link href="#s11.7" rel="section" title="11.7 News system configuration">
<link href="#s11.8" rel="section" title="11.8 Programs for the X Window System">
<link href="#s-perl" rel="section" title="11.9 Perl programs and modules">
<link href="#s-emacs" rel="section" title="11.10 Emacs lisp programs">
<link href="#s11.11" rel="section" title="11.11 Games">
<link href="#s12.1" rel="section" title="12.1 Manual pages">
<link href="#s12.2" rel="section" title="12.2 Info documents">
<link href="#s-docs-additional" rel="section" title="12.3 Additional documentation">
<link href="#s12.4" rel="section" title="12.4 Preferred documentation formats">
<link href="#s-copyrightfile" rel="section" title="12.5 Copyright information">
<link href="#s12.6" rel="section" title="12.6 Examples">
<link href="#s-changelogs" rel="section" title="12.7 Changelog files">
<link href="#s-pkg-bincreating" rel="section" title="B.1 Creating package files - dpkg-deb">
<link href="#s-pkg-controlarea" rel="section" title="B.2 Package control information files">
<link href="#s-pkg-controlfile" rel="section" title="B.3 The main control information file: control">
<link href="#sB.4" rel="section" title="B.4 Time Stamps">
<link href="#s-pkg-sourcetools" rel="section" title="C.1 Tools for processing source packages">
<link href="#s-pkg-sourcetree" rel="section" title="C.2 The Debian package source tree">
<link href="#s-pkg-sourcearchives" rel="section" title="C.3 Source packages as archives">
<link href="#sC.4" rel="section" title="C.4 Unpacking a Debian source package without dpkg-source">
<link href="#sD.1" rel="section" title="D.1 Syntax of control files">
<link href="#sD.2" rel="section" title="D.2 List of fields">
<link href="#sE.1" rel="section" title="E.1 Automatic handling of configuration files by dpkg">
<link href="#sE.2" rel="section" title="E.2 Fully-featured maintainer script configuration handling">
<link href="#s-main" rel="subsection" title="2.2.1 The main archive area">
<link href="#s-contrib" rel="subsection" title="2.2.2 The contrib archive area">
<link href="#s-non-free" rel="subsection" title="2.2.3 The non-free archive area">
<link href="#s3.2.1" rel="subsection" title="3.2.1 Version numbers based on dates">
<link href="#s-synopsis" rel="subsection" title="3.4.1 The single line synopsis">
<link href="#s-extendeddesc" rel="subsection" title="3.4.2 The extended description">
<link href="#s-maintscriptprompt" rel="subsection" title="3.9.1 Prompting in maintainer scripts">
<link href="#s-debianrules-options" rel="subsection" title="4.9.1 debian/rules and DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS">
<link href="#s-f-Source" rel="subsection" title="5.6.1 Source">
<link href="#s-f-Maintainer" rel="subsection" title="5.6.2 Maintainer">
<link href="#s-f-Uploaders" rel="subsection" title="5.6.3 Uploaders">
<link href="#s-f-Changed-By" rel="subsection" title="5.6.4 Changed-By">
<link href="#s-f-Section" rel="subsection" title="5.6.5 Section">
<link href="#s-f-Priority" rel="subsection" title="5.6.6 Priority">
<link href="#s-f-Package" rel="subsection" title="5.6.7 Package">
<link href="#s-f-Architecture" rel="subsection" title="5.6.8 Architecture">
<link href="#s-f-Essential" rel="subsection" title="5.6.9 Essential">
<link href="#s5.6.10" rel="subsection" title="5.6.10 Package interrelationship fields: Depends, Pre-Depends, Recommends, Suggests, Breaks, Conflicts, Provides, Replaces, Enhances">
<link href="#s-f-Standards-Version" rel="subsection" title="5.6.11 Standards-Version">
<link href="#s-f-Version" rel="subsection" title="5.6.12 Version">
<link href="#s-f-Description" rel="subsection" title="5.6.13 Description">
<link href="#s-f-Distribution" rel="subsection" title="5.6.14 Distribution">
<link href="#s-f-Date" rel="subsection" title="5.6.15 Date">
<link href="#s-f-Format" rel="subsection" title="5.6.16 Format">
<link href="#s-f-Urgency" rel="subsection" title="5.6.17 Urgency">
<link href="#s-f-Changes" rel="subsection" title="5.6.18 Changes">
<link href="#s-f-Binary" rel="subsection" title="5.6.19 Binary">
<link href="#s-f-Installed-Size" rel="subsection" title="5.6.20 Installed-Size">
<link href="#s-f-Files" rel="subsection" title="5.6.21 Files">
<link href="#s-f-Closes" rel="subsection" title="5.6.22 Closes">
<link href="#s-f-Homepage" rel="subsection" title="5.6.23 Homepage">
<link href="#s-f-Checksums" rel="subsection" title="5.6.24 Checksums-Sha1 and Checksums-Sha256">
<link href="#s5.6.25" rel="subsection" title="5.6.25 DM-Upload-Allowed">
<link href="#s-f-VCS-fields" rel="subsection" title="5.6.26 Version Control System (VCS) fields">
<link href="#s-f-Package-List" rel="subsection" title="5.6.27 Package-List">
<link href="#s-f-Package-Type" rel="subsection" title="5.6.28 Package-Type">
<link href="#s-f-Dgit" rel="subsection" title="5.6.29 Dgit">
<link href="#s-f-DM-Upload-Allowed" rel="subsection" title="5.8.1 DM-Upload-Allowed">
<link href="#s7.6.1" rel="subsection" title="7.6.1 Overwriting files in other packages">
<link href="#s7.6.2" rel="subsection" title="7.6.2 Replacing whole packages, forcing their removal">
<link href="#s-ldconfig" rel="subsection" title="8.1.1 ldconfig">
<link href="#s-dpkg-shlibdeps" rel="subsection" title="8.6.1 Generating dependencies on shared libraries">
<link href="#s-sharedlibs-updates" rel="subsection" title="8.6.2 Shared library ABI changes">
<link href="#s-sharedlibs-symbols" rel="subsection" title="8.6.3 The symbols system">
<link href="#s-symbols-paths" rel="subsection" title="8.6.3.1 The symbols files present on the system">
<link href="#s-symbols" rel="subsection" title="8.6.3.2 The symbols File Format">
<link href="#s-providing-symbols" rel="subsection" title="8.6.3.3 Providing a symbols file">
<link href="#s-sharedlibs-shlibdeps" rel="subsection" title="8.6.4 The shlibs system">
<link href="#s-shlibs-paths" rel="subsection" title="8.6.4.1 The shlibs files present on the system">
<link href="#s-shlibs" rel="subsection" title="8.6.4.2 The shlibs File Format">
<link href="#s8.6.4.3" rel="subsection" title="8.6.4.3 Providing a shlibs file">
<link href="#s-fhs" rel="subsection" title="9.1.1 File System Structure">
<link href="#s9.1.2" rel="subsection" title="9.1.2 Site-specific programs">
<link href="#s9.1.3" rel="subsection" title="9.1.3 The system-wide mail directory">
<link href="#s-fhs-run" rel="subsection" title="9.1.4 /run and /run/lock">
<link href="#s9.2.1" rel="subsection" title="9.2.1 Introduction">
<link href="#s9.2.2" rel="subsection" title="9.2.2 UID and GID classes">
<link href="#s-/etc/init.d" rel="subsection" title="9.3.1 Introduction">
<link href="#s-writing-init" rel="subsection" title="9.3.2 Writing the scripts">
<link href="#s9.3.3" rel="subsection" title="9.3.3 Interfacing with the initscript system">
<link href="#s9.3.3.1" rel="subsection" title="9.3.3.1 Managing the links">
<link href="#s9.3.3.2" rel="subsection" title="9.3.3.2 Running initscripts">
<link href="#s9.3.4" rel="subsection" title="9.3.4 Boot-time initialization">
<link href="#s9.3.5" rel="subsection" title="9.3.5 Example">
<link href="#s-cron-files" rel="subsection" title="9.5.1 Cron job file names">
<link href="#s-media-types-freedesktop" rel="subsection" title="9.7.1 Registration of media type handlers with desktop entries">
<link href="#s-mailcap" rel="subsection" title="9.7.2 Registration of media type handlers with mailcap entries">
<link href="#s-file-media-type" rel="subsection" title="9.7.3 Providing media types to files">
<link href="#s-upstart" rel="subsection" title="9.11.1 Event-based boot with upstart">
<link href="#s10.7.1" rel="subsection" title="10.7.1 Definitions">
<link href="#s10.7.2" rel="subsection" title="10.7.2 Location">
<link href="#s10.7.3" rel="subsection" title="10.7.3 Behavior">
<link href="#s10.7.4" rel="subsection" title="10.7.4 Sharing configuration files">
<link href="#s10.7.5" rel="subsection" title="10.7.5 User configuration files ("dotfiles")">
<link href="#s10.9.1" rel="subsection" title="10.9.1 The use of dpkg-statoverride">
<link href="#s-arch-wildcard-spec" rel="subsection" title="11.1.1 Architecture wildcards">
<link href="#s11.8.1" rel="subsection" title="11.8.1 Providing X support and package priorities">
<link href="#s11.8.2" rel="subsection" title="11.8.2 Packages providing an X server">
<link href="#s11.8.3" rel="subsection" title="11.8.3 Packages providing a terminal emulator">
<link href="#s11.8.4" rel="subsection" title="11.8.4 Packages providing a window manager">
<link href="#s11.8.5" rel="subsection" title="11.8.5 Packages providing fonts">
<link href="#s-appdefaults" rel="subsection" title="11.8.6 Application defaults files">
<link href="#s11.8.7" rel="subsection" title="11.8.7 Installation directory issues">
<link href="#s-copyrightformat" rel="subsection" title="12.5.1 Machine-readable copyright information">
<link href="#s-pkg-dpkg-source" rel="subsection" title="C.1.1 dpkg-source - packs and unpacks Debian source packages">
<link href="#s-pkg-dpkg-buildpackage" rel="subsection" title="C.1.2 dpkg-buildpackage - overall package-building control script">
<link href="#s-pkg-dpkg-gencontrol" rel="subsection" title="C.1.3 dpkg-gencontrol - generates binary package control files">
<link href="#s-pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps" rel="subsection" title="C.1.4 dpkg-shlibdeps - calculates shared library dependencies">
<link href="#s-pkg-dpkg-distaddfile" rel="subsection" title="C.1.5 dpkg-distaddfile - adds a file to debian/files">
<link href="#s-pkg-dpkg-genchanges" rel="subsection" title="C.1.6 dpkg-genchanges - generates a .changes upload control file">
<link href="#s-pkg-dpkg-parsechangelog" rel="subsection" title="C.1.7 dpkg-parsechangelog - produces parsed representation of a changelog">
<link href="#s-pkg-dpkg-architecture" rel="subsection" title="C.1.8 dpkg-architecture - information about the build and host system">
<link href="#s-pkg-debianrules" rel="subsection" title="C.2.1 debian/rules - the main building script">
<link href="#s-pkg-srcsubstvars" rel="subsection" title="C.2.2 debian/substvars and variable substitutions">
<link href="#sC.2.3" rel="subsection" title="C.2.3 debian/files">
<link href="#sC.2.4" rel="subsection" title="C.2.4 debian/tmp">
<link href="#sC.4.1" rel="subsection" title="C.4.1 Restrictions on objects in source packages">
<link href="#s-pkg-f-Filename" rel="subsection" title="D.2.1 Filename and MSDOS-Filename">
<link href="#s-pkg-f-Size" rel="subsection" title="D.2.2 Size and MD5sum">
<link href="#s-pkg-f-Status" rel="subsection" title="D.2.3 Status">
<link href="#s-pkg-f-Config-Version" rel="subsection" title="D.2.4 Config-Version">
<link href="#s-pkg-f-Conffiles" rel="subsection" title="D.2.5 Conffiles">
<link href="#sD.2.6" rel="subsection" title="D.2.6 Obsolete fields">
</head>
<body>
<p><a name="index"></a></p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">1</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">2</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">3</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">4</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">5</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">7</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">9</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">10</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">11</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">12</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br></h1>
<hr>
<h2 id="abstract">Abstract</h2>
<p>
This manual describes the policy requirements for the Debian distribution.
This includes the structure and contents of the Debian archive and several
design issues of the operating system, as well as technical requirements that
each package must satisfy to be included in the distribution.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="copyright">Copyright Notice</h2>
<p>
Copyright © 1996,1997,1998 Ian Jackson and Christian Schwarz.
</p>
<p>
These are the copyright dates of the original Policy manual. Since then, this
manual has been updated by many others. No comprehensive collection of
copyright notices for subsequent work exists.
</p>
<p>
This manual is free software; you may redistribute it and/or modify it under
the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later version.
</p>
<p>
This is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but <em>without any
warranty</em>; without even the implied warranty of merchantability or fitness
for a particular purpose. See the GNU General Public License for more details.
</p>
<p>
A copy of the GNU General Public License is available as
<code>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL</code> in the Debian distribution or on
the World Wide Web at <code><a href="http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/gpl.html">the
GNU General Public Licence</a></code>. You can also obtain it by writing to
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301, USA.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="contents">Contents</h2>
<ul>
<li><a href="#ch-scope">1 About this manual</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s1.1">1.1 Scope</a></li>
<li><a href="#s1.2">1.2 New versions of this document</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-authors">1.3 Authors and Maintainers</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-related">1.4 Related documents</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-definitions">1.5 Definitions</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#ch-archive">2 The Debian Archive</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-dfsg">2.1 The Debian Free Software Guidelines</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-sections">2.2 Archive areas</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-main">2.2.1 The main archive area</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-contrib">2.2.2 The contrib archive area</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-non-free">2.2.3 The non-free archive area</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#s-pkgcopyright">2.3 Copyright considerations</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-subsections">2.4 Sections</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-priorities">2.5 Priorities</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#ch-binary">3 Binary packages</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s3.1">3.1 The package name</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-versions">3.2 The version of a package</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s3.2.1">3.2.1 Version numbers based on dates</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#s-maintainer">3.3 The maintainer of a package</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-descriptions">3.4 The description of a package</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-synopsis">3.4.1 The single line synopsis</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-extendeddesc">3.4.2 The extended description</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#s-dependencies">3.5 Dependencies</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-virtual_pkg">3.6 Virtual packages</a></li>
<li><a href="#s3.7">3.7 Base system</a></li>
<li><a href="#s3.8">3.8 Essential packages</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-maintscripts">3.9 Maintainer Scripts</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-maintscriptprompt">3.9.1 Prompting in maintainer scripts</a>
</ul></li>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#ch-source">4 Source packages</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-standardsversion">4.1 Standards conformance</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-relations">4.2 Package relationships</a></li>
<li><a href="#s4.3">4.3 Changes to the upstream sources</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-dpkgchangelog">4.4 Debian changelog: <code>debian/changelog</code></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-dpkgcopyright">4.5 Copyright: <code>debian/copyright</code></a></li>
<li><a href="#s4.6">4.6 Error trapping in makefiles</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-timestamps">4.7 Time Stamps</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-restrictions">4.8 Restrictions on objects in source packages</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-debianrules">4.9 Main building script: <code>debian/rules</code></a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-debianrules-options">4.9.1 <code>debian/rules</code> and <samp>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</samp></a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#s-substvars">4.10 Variable substitutions: <code>debian/substvars</code></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-debianwatch">4.11 Optional upstream source location: <code>debian/watch</code></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-debianfiles">4.12 Generated files list: <code>debian/files</code></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-embeddedfiles">4.13 Convenience copies of code</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-readmesource">4.14 Source package handling: <code>debian/README.source</code></a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#ch-controlfields">5 Control files and their fields</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-controlsyntax">5.1 Syntax of control files</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-sourcecontrolfiles">5.2 Source package control files -- <code>debian/control</code></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-binarycontrolfiles">5.3 Binary package control files -- <code>DEBIAN/control</code></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-debiansourcecontrolfiles">5.4 Debian source control files -- <samp>.dsc</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-debianchangesfiles">5.5 Debian changes files -- <code>.changes</code></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-controlfieldslist">5.6 List of fields</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-f-Source">5.6.1 <samp>Source</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Maintainer">5.6.2 <samp>Maintainer</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Uploaders">5.6.3 <samp>Uploaders</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Changed-By">5.6.4 <samp>Changed-By</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Section">5.6.5 <samp>Section</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Priority">5.6.6 <samp>Priority</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Package">5.6.7 <samp>Package</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Architecture">5.6.8 <samp>Architecture</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Essential">5.6.9 <samp>Essential</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s5.6.10">5.6.10 Package interrelationship fields: <samp>Depends</samp>, <samp>Pre-Depends</samp>, <samp>Recommends</samp>, <samp>Suggests</samp>, <samp>Breaks</samp>, <samp>Conflicts</samp>, <samp>Provides</samp>, <samp>Replaces</samp>, <samp>Enhances</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Standards-Version">5.6.11 <samp>Standards-Version</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Version">5.6.12 <samp>Version</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Description">5.6.13 <samp>Description</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Distribution">5.6.14 <samp>Distribution</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Date">5.6.15 <samp>Date</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Format">5.6.16 <samp>Format</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Urgency">5.6.17 <samp>Urgency</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Changes">5.6.18 <samp>Changes</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Binary">5.6.19 <samp>Binary</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Installed-Size">5.6.20 <samp>Installed-Size</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Files">5.6.21 <samp>Files</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Closes">5.6.22 <samp>Closes</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Homepage">5.6.23 <samp>Homepage</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Checksums">5.6.24 <samp>Checksums-Sha1</samp> and <samp>Checksums-Sha256</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s5.6.25">5.6.25 <samp>DM-Upload-Allowed</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-VCS-fields">5.6.26 Version Control System (VCS) fields</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Package-List">5.6.27 <samp>Package-List</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Package-Type">5.6.28 <samp>Package-Type</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-f-Dgit">5.6.29 <samp>Dgit</samp></a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#s5.7">5.7 User-defined fields</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-obsolete-control-data-fields">5.8 Obsolete fields</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-f-DM-Upload-Allowed">5.8.1 <samp>DM-Upload-Allowed</samp></a>
</ul></li>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6 Package maintainer scripts and installation procedure</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s6.1">6.1 Introduction to package maintainer scripts</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-idempotency">6.2 Maintainer scripts idempotency</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-controllingterminal">6.3 Controlling terminal for maintainer scripts</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-exitstatus">6.4 Exit status</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-mscriptsinstact">6.5 Summary of ways maintainer scripts are called</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-unpackphase">6.6 Details of unpack phase of installation or upgrade</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-configdetails">6.7 Details of configuration</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-removedetails">6.8 Details of removal and/or configuration purging</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#ch-relationships">7 Declaring relationships between packages</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-depsyntax">7.1 Syntax of relationship fields</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-binarydeps">7.2 Binary Dependencies - <samp>Depends</samp>, <samp>Recommends</samp>, <samp>Suggests</samp>, <samp>Enhances</samp>, <samp>Pre-Depends</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-breaks">7.3 Packages which break other packages - <samp>Breaks</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-conflicts">7.4 Conflicting binary packages - <samp>Conflicts</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-virtual">7.5 Virtual packages - <samp>Provides</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-replaces">7.6 Overwriting files and replacing packages - <samp>Replaces</samp></a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s7.6.1">7.6.1 Overwriting files in other packages</a></li>
<li><a href="#s7.6.2">7.6.2 Replacing whole packages, forcing their removal</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#s-sourcebinarydeps">7.7 Relationships between source and binary packages - <samp>Build-Depends</samp>, <samp>Build-Depends-Indep</samp>, <samp>Build-Conflicts</samp>, <samp>Build-Conflicts-Indep</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-built-using">7.8 Additional source packages used to build the binary - <samp>Built-Using</samp></a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8 Shared libraries</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-sharedlibs-runtime">8.1 Run-time shared libraries</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-ldconfig">8.1.1 <samp>ldconfig</samp></a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#s-sharedlibs-support-files">8.2 Shared library support files</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-sharedlibs-static">8.3 Static libraries</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-sharedlibs-dev">8.4 Development files</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-sharedlibs-intradeps">8.5 Dependencies between the packages of the same library</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-sharedlibs-depends">8.6 Dependencies between the library and other packages</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-dpkg-shlibdeps">8.6.1 Generating dependencies on shared libraries</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-sharedlibs-updates">8.6.2 Shared library ABI changes</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-sharedlibs-symbols">8.6.3 The <samp>symbols</samp> system</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-sharedlibs-shlibdeps">8.6.4 The <samp>shlibs</samp> system</a>
</ul></li>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#ch-opersys">9 The Operating System</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s9.1">9.1 File system hierarchy</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-fhs">9.1.1 File System Structure</a></li>
<li><a href="#s9.1.2">9.1.2 Site-specific programs</a></li>
<li><a href="#s9.1.3">9.1.3 The system-wide mail directory</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-fhs-run">9.1.4 <code>/run</code> and <code>/run/lock</code></a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#s9.2">9.2 Users and groups</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s9.2.1">9.2.1 Introduction</a></li>
<li><a href="#s9.2.2">9.2.2 UID and GID classes</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#s-sysvinit">9.3 System run levels and <code>init.d</code> scripts</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-/etc/init.d">9.3.1 Introduction</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-writing-init">9.3.2 Writing the scripts</a></li>
<li><a href="#s9.3.3">9.3.3 Interfacing with the initscript system</a></li>
<li><a href="#s9.3.4">9.3.4 Boot-time initialization</a></li>
<li><a href="#s9.3.5">9.3.5 Example</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#s9.4">9.4 Console messages from <code>init.d</code> scripts</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-cron-jobs">9.5 Cron jobs</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-cron-files">9.5.1 Cron job file names</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#s-menus">9.6 Menus</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-mime">9.7 Multimedia handlers</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-media-types-freedesktop">9.7.1 Registration of media type handlers with desktop entries</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-mailcap">9.7.2 Registration of media type handlers with mailcap entries</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-file-media-type">9.7.3 Providing media types to files</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#s9.8">9.8 Keyboard configuration</a></li>
<li><a href="#s9.9">9.9 Environment variables</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-doc-base">9.10 Registering Documents using doc-base</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-alternateinit">9.11 Alternate init systems</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-upstart">9.11.1 Event-based boot with upstart</a>
</ul></li>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#ch-files">10 Files</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-binaries">10.1 Binaries</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-libraries">10.2 Libraries</a></li>
<li><a href="#s10.3">10.3 Shared libraries</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-scripts">10.4 Scripts</a></li>
<li><a href="#s10.5">10.5 Symbolic links</a></li>
<li><a href="#s10.6">10.6 Device files</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-config-files">10.7 Configuration files</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s10.7.1">10.7.1 Definitions</a></li>
<li><a href="#s10.7.2">10.7.2 Location</a></li>
<li><a href="#s10.7.3">10.7.3 Behavior</a></li>
<li><a href="#s10.7.4">10.7.4 Sharing configuration files</a></li>
<li><a href="#s10.7.5">10.7.5 User configuration files ("dotfiles")</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#s10.8">10.8 Log files</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-permissions-owners">10.9 Permissions and owners</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s10.9.1">10.9.1 The use of <code>dpkg-statoverride</code></a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#s-filenames">10.10 File names</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#ch-customized-programs">11 Customized programs</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-arch-spec">11.1 Architecture specification strings</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-arch-wildcard-spec">11.1.1 Architecture wildcards</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#s11.2">11.2 Daemons</a></li>
<li><a href="#s11.3">11.3 Using pseudo-ttys and modifying wtmp, utmp and lastlog</a></li>
<li><a href="#s11.4">11.4 Editors and pagers</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-web-appl">11.5 Web servers and applications</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-mail-transport-agents">11.6 Mail transport, delivery and user agents</a></li>
<li><a href="#s11.7">11.7 News system configuration</a></li>
<li><a href="#s11.8">11.8 Programs for the X Window System</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s11.8.1">11.8.1 Providing X support and package priorities</a></li>
<li><a href="#s11.8.2">11.8.2 Packages providing an X server</a></li>
<li><a href="#s11.8.3">11.8.3 Packages providing a terminal emulator</a></li>
<li><a href="#s11.8.4">11.8.4 Packages providing a window manager</a></li>
<li><a href="#s11.8.5">11.8.5 Packages providing fonts</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-appdefaults">11.8.6 Application defaults files</a></li>
<li><a href="#s11.8.7">11.8.7 Installation directory issues</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#s-perl">11.9 Perl programs and modules</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-emacs">11.10 Emacs lisp programs</a></li>
<li><a href="#s11.11">11.11 Games</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#ch-docs">12 Documentation</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s12.1">12.1 Manual pages</a></li>
<li><a href="#s12.2">12.2 Info documents</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-docs-additional">12.3 Additional documentation</a></li>
<li><a href="#s12.4">12.4 Preferred documentation formats</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-copyrightfile">12.5 Copyright information</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-copyrightformat">12.5.1 Machine-readable copyright information</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#s12.6">12.6 Examples</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-changelogs">12.7 Changelog files</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A Introduction and scope of these appendices</a><li><a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B Binary packages (from old Packaging Manual)</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-bincreating">B.1 Creating package files - <code>dpkg-deb</code></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-controlarea">B.2 Package control information files</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-controlfile">B.3 The main control information file: <samp>control</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#sB.4">B.4 Time Stamps</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C Source packages (from old Packaging Manual)</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-sourcetools">C.1 Tools for processing source packages</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-dpkg-source">C.1.1 <code>dpkg-source</code> - packs and unpacks Debian source packages</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-dpkg-buildpackage">C.1.2 <code>dpkg-buildpackage</code> - overall package-building control script</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-dpkg-gencontrol">C.1.3 <code>dpkg-gencontrol</code> - generates binary package control files</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps">C.1.4 <code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> - calculates shared library dependencies</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-dpkg-distaddfile">C.1.5 <code>dpkg-distaddfile</code> - adds a file to <code>debian/files</code></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-dpkg-genchanges">C.1.6 <code>dpkg-genchanges</code> - generates a <code>.changes</code> upload control file</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-dpkg-parsechangelog">C.1.7 <code>dpkg-parsechangelog</code> - produces parsed representation of a changelog</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-dpkg-architecture">C.1.8 <code>dpkg-architecture</code> - information about the build and host system</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-sourcetree">C.2 The Debian package source tree</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-debianrules">C.2.1 <code>debian/rules</code> - the main building script</a></li>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-srcsubstvars">C.2.2 <code>debian/substvars</code> and variable substitutions</a></li>
<li><a href="#sC.2.3">C.2.3 <code>debian/files</code></a></li>
<li><a href="#sC.2.4">C.2.4 <code>debian/tmp</code></a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-sourcearchives">C.3 Source packages as archives</a></li>
<li><a href="#sC.4">C.4 Unpacking a Debian source package without <code>dpkg-source</code></a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#sC.4.1">C.4.1 Restrictions on objects in source packages</a>
</ul></li>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D Control files and their fields (from old Packaging Manual)</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#sD.1">D.1 Syntax of control files</a></li>
<li><a href="#sD.2">D.2 List of fields</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-f-Filename">D.2.1 <samp>Filename</samp> and <samp>MSDOS-Filename</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-f-Size">D.2.2 <samp>Size</samp> and <samp>MD5sum</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-f-Status">D.2.3 <samp>Status</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-f-Config-Version">D.2.4 <samp>Config-Version</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#s-pkg-f-Conffiles">D.2.5 <samp>Conffiles</samp></a></li>
<li><a href="#sD.2.6">D.2.6 Obsolete fields</a>
</ul></li>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E Configuration file handling (from old Packaging Manual)</a>
<ul>
<li><a href="#sE.1">E.1 Automatic handling of configuration files by <code>dpkg</code></a></li>
<li><a href="#sE.2">E.2 Fully-featured maintainer script configuration handling</a>
</ul></li>
<li><a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F Alternative versions of an interface - <code>update-alternatives</code> (from old Packaging Manual)</a><li><a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G Diversions - overriding a package's version of a file (from old Packaging Manual)</a></li>
</ul>
<p><a name="ch-scope"></a></p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#index">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ 1 ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">2</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">3</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">4</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">5</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">7</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">9</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">10</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">11</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">12</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br>Chapter 1 - About this manual
</h1>
<hr>
<h2 id="s1.1">1.1 Scope</h2>
<p>
This manual describes the policy requirements for the Debian distribution.
This includes the structure and contents of the Debian archive and several
design issues of the operating system, as well as technical requirements that
each package must satisfy to be included in the distribution.
</p>
<p>
This manual also describes Debian policy as it relates to creating Debian
packages. It is not a tutorial on how to build packages, nor is it exhaustive
where it comes to describing the behavior of the packaging system. Instead,
this manual attempts to define the interface to the package management system
that the developers have to be conversant with.[<a href="#f1" name="fr1">1</a>]
</p>
<p>
The footnotes present in this manual are merely informative, and are not part
of Debian policy itself.
</p>
<p>
The appendices to this manual are not necessarily normative, either. Please
see <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">Introduction and scope of these appendices,
Appendix A</a> for more information.
</p>
<p>
In the normative part of this manual, the words <em>must</em>, <em>should</em>
and <em>may</em>, and the adjectives <em>required</em>, <em>recommended</em>
and <em>optional</em>, are used to distinguish the significance of the various
guidelines in this policy document. Packages that do not conform to the
guidelines denoted by <em>must</em> (or <em>required</em>) will generally not
be considered acceptable for the Debian distribution. Non-conformance with
guidelines denoted by <em>should</em> (or <em>recommended</em>) will generally
be considered a bug, but will not necessarily render a package unsuitable for
distribution. Guidelines denoted by <em>may</em> (or <em>optional</em>) are
truly optional and adherence is left to the maintainer's discretion.
</p>
<p>
These classifications are roughly equivalent to the bug severities
<em>serious</em> (for <em>must</em> or <em>required</em> directive violations),
<em>minor</em>, <em>normal</em> or <em>important</em> (for <em>should</em> or
<em>recommended</em> directive violations) and <em>wishlist</em> (for
<em>optional</em> items). [<a href="#f2" name="fr2">2</a>]
</p>
<p>
Much of the information presented in this manual will be useful even when
building a package which is to be distributed in some other way or is intended
for local use only.
</p>
<p>
udebs (stripped-down binary packages used by the Debian Installer) do not
comply with all of the requirements discussed here. See the <code><a
href="http://d-i.alioth.debian.org/doc/internals/ch03.html">Debian Installer
internals manual</a></code> for more information about them.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s1.2">1.2 New versions of this document</h2>
<p>
This manual is distributed via the Debian package <code><code><a
href="http://packages.debian.org/debian-policy">debian-policy</a></code></code>
(<code>packages.debian.org</code> <code><a
href="http://packages.debian.org/debian-policy">http://packages.debian.org/debian-policy</a></code>).
</p>
<p>
The current version of this document is also available from the Debian web
mirrors at <samp><code><a
href="http://www.debian.org/doc/debian-policy/">/doc/debian-policy/</a></code></samp>.
( <code>www.debian.org</code> <code><a
href="http://www.debian.org/doc/debian-policy/">http://www.debian.org/doc/debian-policy/</a></code>)
Also available from the same directory are several other formats:
<code>policy.html.tar.gz</code> (<code><a
href="http://www.debian.org/doc/debian-policy/policy.html.tar.gz">http://www.debian.org/doc/debian-policy/policy.html.tar.gz</a></code>),
<code>policy.pdf.gz</code> (<code><a
href="http://www.debian.org/doc/debian-policy/policy.pdf.gz">http://www.debian.org/doc/debian-policy/policy.pdf.gz</a></code>)
and <code>policy.ps.gz</code> (<code><a
href="http://www.debian.org/doc/debian-policy/policy.ps.gz">http://www.debian.org/doc/debian-policy/policy.ps.gz</a></code>).
</p>
<p>
The <code>debian-policy</code> package also includes the file
<code>upgrading-checklist.txt.gz</code> which indicates policy changes between
versions of this document.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-authors">1.3 Authors and Maintainers</h2>
<p>
Originally called "Debian GNU/Linux Policy Manual", this manual was
initially written in 1996 by Ian Jackson. It was revised on November 27th,
1996 by David A. Morris. Christian Schwarz added new sections on March 15th,
1997, and reworked/restructured it in April-July 1997. Christoph Lameter
contributed the "Web Standard". Julian Gilbey largely restructured
it in 2001.
</p>
<p>
Since September 1998, the responsibility for the contents of this document lies
on the <code><a href="mailto:debian-policy@lists.debian.org">debian-policy
mailing list</a></code>. Proposals are discussed there and inserted into
policy after a certain consensus is established. The actual editing is done by
a group of maintainers that have no editorial powers. These are the current
maintainers:
</p>
<ol type="1" start="1" >
<li>
<p>
Russ Allbery
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="2" >
<li>
<p>
Bill Allombert
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="3" >
<li>
<p>
Andreas Barth
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="4" >
<li>
<p>
Jonathan Nieder
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<p>
While the authors of this document have tried hard to avoid typos and other
errors, these do still occur. If you discover an error in this manual or if
you want to give any comments, suggestions, or criticisms please send an email
to the Debian Policy List, <code><a
href="mailto:debian-policy@lists.debian.org">mailto:debian-policy@lists.debian.org</a></code>,
or submit a bug report against the <samp>debian-policy</samp> package.
</p>
<p>
Please do not try to reach the individual authors or maintainers of the Policy
Manual regarding changes to the Policy.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-related">1.4 Related documents</h2>
<p>
There are several other documents other than this Policy Manual that are
necessary to fully understand some Debian policies and procedures.
</p>
<p>
The external "sub-policy" documents are referred to in:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-fhs">File System Structure, Section 9.1.1</a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-virtual_pkg">Virtual packages, Section 3.6</a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-menus">Menus, Section 9.6</a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-perl">Perl programs and modules, Section 11.9</a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-maintscriptprompt">Prompting in maintainer scripts, Section
3.9.1</a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-emacs">Emacs lisp programs, Section 11.10</a>
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
In addition to those, which carry the weight of policy, there is the Debian
Developer's Reference. This document describes procedures and resources for
Debian developers, but it is <em>not</em> normative; rather, it includes things
that don't belong in the Policy, such as best practices for developers.
</p>
<p>
The Developer's Reference is available in the <code>developers-reference</code>
package. It's also available from the Debian web mirrors at <samp><code><a
href="http://www.debian.org/doc/developers-reference/">/doc/developers-reference/</a></code></samp>.
</p>
<p>
Finally, a <a href="#s-copyrightformat">specification for machine-readable
copyright files</a> is maintained as part of the <code>debian-policy</code>
package using the same procedure as the other policy documents. Use of this
format is optional.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-definitions">1.5 Definitions</h2>
<p>
The following terms are used in this Policy Manual:
</p>
<dl>
<dt>ASCII</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The character encoding specified by ANSI X3.4-1986 and its predecessor
standards, referred to in MIME as US-ASCII, and corresponding to an encoding in
eight bits per character of the first 128 <code><a
href="http://www.unicode.org/">Unicode</a></code> characters, with the eighth
bit always zero.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>UTF-8</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The transformation format (sometimes called encoding) of <code><a
href="http://www.unicode.org/">Unicode</a></code> defined by <code><a
href="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3629.txt">RFC 3629</a></code>. UTF-8
has the useful property of having ASCII as a subset, so any text encoded in
ASCII is trivially also valid UTF-8.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<p><a name="ch-archive"></a></p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#ch-scope">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">1</a> ]
[ 2 ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">3</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">4</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">5</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">7</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">9</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">10</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">11</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">12</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br>Chapter 2 - The Debian Archive
</h1>
<hr>
<p>
The Debian system is maintained and distributed as a collection of
<em>packages</em>. Since there are so many of them (currently well over
15000), they are split into <em>sections</em> and given <em>priorities</em> to
simplify the handling of them.
</p>
<p>
The effort of the Debian project is to build a free operating system, but not
every package we want to make accessible is <em>free</em> in our sense (see the
Debian Free Software Guidelines, below), or may be imported/exported without
restrictions. Thus, the archive is split into areas[<a href="#f3"
name="fr3">3</a>] based on their licenses and other restrictions.
</p>
<p>
The aims of this are:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
to allow us to make as much software available as we can
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
to allow us to encourage everyone to write free software, and
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
to allow us to make it easy for people to produce CD-ROMs of our system without
violating any licenses, import/export restrictions, or any other laws.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
The <em>main</em> archive area forms the <em>Debian distribution</em>.
</p>
<p>
Packages in the other archive areas (<samp>contrib</samp>,
<samp>non-free</samp>) are not considered to be part of the Debian
distribution, although we support their use and provide infrastructure for them
(such as our bug-tracking system and mailing lists). This Debian Policy Manual
applies to these packages as well.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-dfsg">2.1 The Debian Free Software Guidelines</h2>
<p>
The Debian Free Software Guidelines (DFSG) form our definition of "free
software". These are:
</p>
<dl>
<dt>1. Free Redistribution</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The license of a Debian component may not restrict any party from selling or
giving away the software as a component of an aggregate software distribution
containing programs from several different sources. The license may not
require a royalty or other fee for such sale.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>2. Source Code</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The program must include source code, and must allow distribution in source
code as well as compiled form.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>3. Derived Works</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The license must allow modifications and derived works, and must allow them to
be distributed under the same terms as the license of the original software.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>4. Integrity of The Author's Source Code</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The license may restrict source-code from being distributed in modified form
<em>only</em> if the license allows the distribution of "patch files"
with the source code for the purpose of modifying the program at build time.
The license must explicitly permit distribution of software built from modified
source code. The license may require derived works to carry a different name
or version number from the original software. (This is a compromise. The
Debian Project encourages all authors to not restrict any files, source or
binary, from being modified.)
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>5. No Discrimination Against Persons or Groups</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The license must not discriminate against any person or group of persons.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>6. No Discrimination Against Fields of Endeavor</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The license must not restrict anyone from making use of the program in a
specific field of endeavor. For example, it may not restrict the program from
being used in a business, or from being used for genetic research.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>7. Distribution of License</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The rights attached to the program must apply to all to whom the program is
redistributed without the need for execution of an additional license by those
parties.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>8. License Must Not Be Specific to Debian</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The rights attached to the program must not depend on the program's being part
of a Debian system. If the program is extracted from Debian and used or
distributed without Debian but otherwise within the terms of the program's
license, all parties to whom the program is redistributed must have the same
rights as those that are granted in conjunction with the Debian system.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>9. License Must Not Contaminate Other Software</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The license must not place restrictions on other software that is distributed
along with the licensed software. For example, the license must not insist
that all other programs distributed on the same medium must be free software.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>10. Example Licenses</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The "GPL," "BSD," and "Artistic" licenses are
examples of licenses that we consider <em>free</em>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-sections">2.2 Archive areas</h2>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-main">2.2.1 The main archive area</h3>
<p>
The <em>main</em> archive area comprises the Debian distribution. Only the
packages in this area are considered part of the distribution. None of the
packages in the <em>main</em> archive area require software outside of that
area to function. Anyone may use, share, modify and redistribute the packages
in this archive area freely[<a href="#f4" name="fr4">4</a>].
</p>
<p>
Every package in <em>main</em> must comply with the DFSG (Debian Free Software
Guidelines).
</p>
<p>
In addition, the packages in <em>main</em>
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
must not require or recommend a package outside of <em>main</em> for
compilation or execution (thus, the package must not declare a
"Pre-Depends", "Depends", "Recommends",
"Build-Depends", or "Build-Depends-Indep" relationship on a
non-<em>main</em> package),
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them, and
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
must meet all policy requirements presented in this manual.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-contrib">2.2.2 The contrib archive area</h3>
<p>
The <em>contrib</em> archive area contains supplemental packages intended to
work with the Debian distribution, but which require software outside of the
distribution to either build or function.
</p>
<p>
Every package in <em>contrib</em> must comply with the DFSG.
</p>
<p>
In addition, the packages in <em>contrib</em>
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them, and
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
must meet all policy requirements presented in this manual.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
Examples of packages which would be included in <em>contrib</em> are:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
free packages which require <em>contrib</em>, <em>non-free</em> packages or
packages which are not in our archive at all for compilation or execution, and
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
wrapper packages or other sorts of free accessories for non-free programs.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-non-free">2.2.3 The non-free archive area</h3>
<p>
The <em>non-free</em> archive area contains supplemental packages intended to
work with the Debian distribution that do not comply with the DFSG or have
other problems that make their distribution problematic. They may not comply
with all of the policy requirements in this manual due to restrictions on
modifications or other limitations.
</p>
<p>
Packages must be placed in <em>non-free</em> if they are not compliant with the
DFSG or are encumbered by patents or other legal issues that make their
distribution problematic.
</p>
<p>
In addition, the packages in <em>non-free</em>
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them, and
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
must meet all policy requirements presented in this manual that it is possible
for them to meet. [<a href="#f5" name="fr5">5</a>]
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-pkgcopyright">2.3 Copyright considerations</h2>
<p>
Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of its copyright
information and distribution license in the file
<code>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</code> (see <a
href="#s-copyrightfile">Copyright information, Section 12.5</a> for further
details).
</p>
<p>
We reserve the right to restrict files from being included anywhere in our
archives if
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
their use or distribution would break a law,
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
there is an ethical conflict in their distribution or use,
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
we would have to sign a license for them, or
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
their distribution would conflict with other project policies.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
Programs whose authors encourage the user to make donations are fine for the
main distribution, provided that the authors do not claim that not donating is
immoral, unethical, illegal or something similar; in such a case they must go
in <em>non-free</em>.
</p>
<p>
Packages whose copyright permission notices (or patent problems) do not even
allow redistribution of binaries only, and where no special permission has been
obtained, must not be placed on the Debian FTP site and its mirrors at all.
</p>
<p>
Note that under international copyright law (this applies in the United States,
too), <em>no</em> distribution or modification of a work is allowed without an
explicit notice saying so. Therefore a program without a copyright notice
<em>is</em> copyrighted and you may not do anything to it without risking being
sued! Likewise if a program has a copyright notice but no statement saying
what is permitted then nothing is permitted.
</p>
<p>
Many authors are unaware of the problems that restrictive copyrights (or lack
of copyright notices) can cause for the users of their supposedly-free
software. It is often worthwhile contacting such authors diplomatically to ask
them to modify their license terms. However, this can be a politically
difficult thing to do and you should ask for advice on the
<samp>debian-legal</samp> mailing list first, as explained below.
</p>
<p>
When in doubt about a copyright, send mail to <code><a
href="mailto:debian-legal@lists.debian.org">mailto:debian-legal@lists.debian.org</a></code>.
Be prepared to provide us with the copyright statement. Software covered by
the GPL, public domain software and BSD-like copyrights are safe; be wary of
the phrases "commercial use prohibited" and "distribution
restricted".
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-subsections">2.4 Sections</h2>
<p>
The packages in the archive areas <em>main</em>, <em>contrib</em> and
<em>non-free</em> are grouped further into <em>sections</em> to simplify
handling.
</p>
<p>
The archive area and section for each package should be specified in the
package's <samp>Section</samp> control record (see <a
href="#s-f-Section"><samp>Section</samp>, Section 5.6.5</a>). However, the
maintainer of the Debian archive may override this selection to ensure the
consistency of the Debian distribution. The <samp>Section</samp> field should
be of the form:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<em>section</em> if the package is in the <em>main</em> archive area,
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<em>area/section</em> if the package is in the <em>contrib</em> or
<em>non-free</em> archive areas.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
The Debian archive maintainers provide the authoritative list of sections. At
present, they are: admin, cli-mono, comm, database, debug, devel, doc, editors,
education, electronics, embedded, fonts, games, gnome, gnu-r, gnustep,
graphics, hamradio, haskell, httpd, interpreters, introspection, java, kde,
kernel, libdevel, libs, lisp, localization, mail, math, metapackages, misc,
net, news, ocaml, oldlibs, otherosfs, perl, php, python, ruby, science, shells,
sound, tasks, tex, text, utils, vcs, video, web, x11, xfce, zope. The
additional section <em>debian-installer</em> contains special packages used by
the installer and is not used for normal Debian packages.
</p>
<p>
For more information about the sections and their definitions, see the <code><a
href="http://packages.debian.org/unstable/">list of sections in
unstable</a></code>.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-priorities">2.5 Priorities</h2>
<p>
Each package should have a <em>priority</em> value, which is included in the
package's <em>control record</em> (see <a
href="#s-f-Priority"><samp>Priority</samp>, Section 5.6.6</a>). This
information is used by the Debian package management tools to separate
high-priority packages from less-important packages.
</p>
<p>
The following <em>priority levels</em> are recognized by the Debian package
management tools.
</p>
<dl>
<dt><samp>required</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
Packages which are necessary for the proper functioning of the system (usually,
this means that dpkg functionality depends on these packages). Removing a
<samp>required</samp> package may cause your system to become totally broken
and you may not even be able to use <code>dpkg</code> to put things back, so
only do so if you know what you are doing. Systems with only the
<samp>required</samp> packages are probably unusable, but they do have enough
functionality to allow the sysadmin to boot and install more software.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>important</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
Important programs, including those which one would expect to find on any
Unix-like system. If the expectation is that an experienced Unix person who
found it missing would say "What on earth is going on, where is
<code>foo</code>?", it must be an <samp>important</samp> package.[<a
href="#f6" name="fr6">6</a>] Other packages without which the system will not
run well or be usable must also have priority <samp>important</samp>. This
does <em>not</em> include Emacs, the X Window System, TeX or any other large
applications. The <samp>important</samp> packages are just a bare minimum of
commonly-expected and necessary tools.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>standard</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
These packages provide a reasonably small but not too limited character-mode
system. This is what will be installed by default if the user doesn't select
anything else. It doesn't include many large applications.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>optional</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
(In a sense everything that isn't required is optional, but that's not what is
meant here.) This is all the software that you might reasonably want to install
if you didn't know what it was and don't have specialized requirements. This
is a much larger system and includes the X Window System, a full TeX
distribution, and many applications. Note that optional packages should not
conflict with each other.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>extra</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
This contains all packages that conflict with others with required, important,
standard or optional priorities, or are only likely to be useful if you already
know what they are or have specialized requirements (such as packages
containing only detached debugging symbols).
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<p>
Packages must not depend on packages with lower priority values (excluding
build-time dependencies). In order to ensure this, the priorities of one or
more packages may need to be adjusted.
</p>
<p><a name="ch-binary"></a></p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#ch-archive">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">1</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">2</a> ]
[ 3 ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">4</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">5</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">7</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">9</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">10</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">11</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">12</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br>Chapter 3 - Binary packages
</h1>
<hr>
<p>
The Debian distribution is based on the Debian package management system,
called <code>dpkg</code>. Thus, all packages in the Debian distribution must
be provided in the <samp>.deb</samp> file format.
</p>
<p>
A <samp>.deb</samp> package contains two sets of files: a set of files to
install on the system when the package is installed, and a set of files that
provide additional metadata about the package or which are executed when the
package is installed or removed. This second set of files is called
<em>control information files</em>. Among those files are the package
maintainer scripts and <code>control</code>, the <a
href="#s-binarycontrolfiles">binary package control file</a> that contains the
control fields for the package. Other control information files include the <a
href="#s-sharedlibs-symbols"><code>symbols</code> file</a> or <a
href="#s-sharedlibs-shlibdeps"><code>shlibs</code> file</a> used to store
shared library dependency information and the <code>conffiles</code> file that
lists the package's configuration files (described in <a
href="#s-config-files">Configuration files, Section 10.7</a>).
</p>
<p>
There is unfortunately a collision of terminology here between control
information files and files in the Debian control file format. Throughout this
document, a <em>control file</em> refers to a file in the Debian control file
format. These files are documented in <a href="#ch-controlfields">Control
files and their fields, Chapter 5</a>. Only files referred to specifically as
<em>control information files</em> are the files included in the control
information file member of the <code>.deb</code> file format used by binary
packages. Most control information files are not in the Debian control file
format.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s3.1">3.1 The package name</h2>
<p>
Every package must have a name that's unique within the Debian archive.
</p>
<p>
The package name is included in the control field <samp>Package</samp>, the
format of which is described in <a href="#s-f-Package"><samp>Package</samp>,
Section 5.6.7</a>. The package name is also included as a part of the file
name of the <samp>.deb</samp> file.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-versions">3.2 The version of a package</h2>
<p>
Every package has a version number recorded in its <samp>Version</samp> control
file field, described in <a href="#s-f-Version"><samp>Version</samp>, Section
5.6.12</a>.
</p>
<p>
The package management system imposes an ordering on version numbers, so that
it can tell whether packages are being up- or downgraded and so that package
system front end applications can tell whether a package it finds available is
newer than the one installed on the system. The version number format has the
most significant parts (as far as comparison is concerned) at the beginning.
</p>
<p>
If an upstream package has problematic version numbers they should be converted
to a sane form for use in the <samp>Version</samp> field.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s3.2.1">3.2.1 Version numbers based on dates</h3>
<p>
In general, Debian packages should use the same version numbers as the upstream
sources. However, upstream version numbers based on some date formats
(sometimes used for development or "snapshot" releases) will not be
ordered correctly by the package management software. For example,
<code>dpkg</code> will consider "96May01" to be greater than
"96Dec24".
</p>
<p>
To prevent having to use epochs for every new upstream version, the date-based
portion of any upstream version number should be given in a way that sorts
correctly: four-digit year first, followed by a two-digit numeric month,
followed by a two-digit numeric date, possibly with punctuation between the
components.
</p>
<p>
Native Debian packages (i.e., packages which have been written especially for
Debian) whose version numbers include dates should also follow these rules. If
punctuation is desired between the date components, remember that hyphen
(<samp>-</samp>) cannot be used in native package versions. Period
(<samp>.</samp>) is normally a good choice.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-maintainer">3.3 The maintainer of a package</h2>
<p>
Every package must have a maintainer, except for orphaned packages as described
below. The maintainer may be one person or a group of people reachable from a
common email address, such as a mailing list. The maintainer is responsible
for maintaining the Debian packaging files, evaluating and responding
appropriately to reported bugs, uploading new versions of the package (either
directly or through a sponsor), ensuring that the package is placed in the
appropriate archive area and included in Debian releases as appropriate for the
stability and utility of the package, and requesting removal of the package
from the Debian distribution if it is no longer useful or maintainable.
</p>
<p>
The maintainer must be specified in the <samp>Maintainer</samp> control field
with their correct name and a working email address. The email address given
in the <samp>Maintainer</samp> control field must accept mail from those role
accounts in Debian used to send automated mails regarding the package. This
includes non-spam mail from the bug-tracking system, all mail from the Debian
archive maintenance software, and other role accounts or automated processes
that are commonly agreed on by the project.[<a href="#f7" name="fr7">7</a>] If
one person or team maintains several packages, they should use the same form of
their name and email address in the <samp>Maintainer</samp> fields of those
packages.
</p>
<p>
The format of the <samp>Maintainer</samp> control field is described in <a
href="#s-f-Maintainer"><samp>Maintainer</samp>, Section 5.6.2</a>.
</p>
<p>
If the maintainer of the package is a team of people with a shared email
address, the <samp>Uploaders</samp> control field must be present and must
contain at least one human with their personal email address. See <a
href="#s-f-Uploaders"><samp>Uploaders</samp>, Section 5.6.3</a> for the syntax
of that field.
</p>
<p>
An orphaned package is one with no current maintainer. Orphaned packages
should have their <samp>Maintainer</samp> control field set to <samp>Debian QA
Group <packages@qa.debian.org></samp>. These packages are considered
maintained by the Debian project as a whole until someone else volunteers to
take over maintenance.[<a href="#f8" name="fr8">8</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-descriptions">3.4 The description of a package</h2>
<p>
Every Debian package must have a <samp>Description</samp> control field which
contains a synopsis and extended description of the package. Technical
information about the format of the <samp>Description</samp> field is in <a
href="#s-f-Description"><samp>Description</samp>, Section 5.6.13</a>.
</p>
<p>
The description should describe the package (the program) to a user (system
administrator) who has never met it before so that they have enough information
to decide whether they want to install it. This description should not just be
copied verbatim from the program's documentation.
</p>
<p>
Put important information first, both in the synopsis and extended description.
Sometimes only the first part of the synopsis or of the description will be
displayed. You can assume that there will usually be a way to see the whole
extended description.
</p>
<p>
The description should also give information about the significant dependencies
and conflicts between this package and others, so that the user knows why these
dependencies and conflicts have been declared.
</p>
<p>
Instructions for configuring or using the package should not be included (that
is what installation scripts, manual pages, info files, etc., are for).
Copyright statements and other administrivia should not be included either
(that is what the copyright file is for).
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-synopsis">3.4.1 The single line synopsis</h3>
<p>
The single line synopsis should be kept brief - certainly under 80 characters.
</p>
<p>
Do not include the package name in the synopsis line. The display software
knows how to display this already, and you do not need to state it. Remember
that in many situations the user may only see the synopsis line - make it as
informative as you can.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-extendeddesc">3.4.2 The extended description</h3>
<p>
Do not try to continue the single line synopsis into the extended description.
This will not work correctly when the full description is displayed, and makes
no sense where only the summary (the single line synopsis) is available.
</p>
<p>
The extended description should describe what the package does and how it
relates to the rest of the system (in terms of, for example, which subsystem it
is which part of).
</p>
<p>
The description field needs to make sense to anyone, even people who have no
idea about any of the things the package deals with.[<a href="#f9"
name="fr9">9</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-dependencies">3.5 Dependencies</h2>
<p>
Every package must specify the dependency information about other packages that
are required for the first to work correctly.
</p>
<p>
For example, a dependency entry must be provided for any shared libraries
required by a dynamically-linked executable binary in a package.
</p>
<p>
Packages are not required to declare any dependencies they have on other
packages which are marked <samp>Essential</samp> (see below), and should not do
so unless they depend on a particular version of that package.[<a href="#f10"
name="fr10">10</a>]
</p>
<p>
Sometimes, unpacking one package requires that another package be first
unpacked <em>and</em> configured. In this case, the depending package must
specify this dependency in the <samp>Pre-Depends</samp> control field.
</p>
<p>
You should not specify a <samp>Pre-Depends</samp> entry for a package before
this has been discussed on the <samp>debian-devel</samp> mailing list and a
consensus about doing that has been reached.
</p>
<p>
The format of the package interrelationship control fields is described in <a
href="#ch-relationships">Declaring relationships between packages, Chapter
7</a>.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-virtual_pkg">3.6 Virtual packages</h2>
<p>
Sometimes, there are several packages which offer more-or-less the same
functionality. In this case, it's useful to define a <em>virtual package</em>
whose name describes that common functionality. (The virtual packages only
exist logically, not physically; that's why they are called <em>virtual</em>.)
The packages with this particular function will then <em>provide</em> the
virtual package. Thus, any other package requiring that function can simply
depend on the virtual package without having to specify all possible packages
individually.
</p>
<p>
All packages should use virtual package names where appropriate, and arrange to
create new ones if necessary. They should not use virtual package names
(except privately, amongst a cooperating group of packages) unless they have
been agreed upon and appear in the list of virtual package names. (See also <a
href="#s-virtual">Virtual packages - <samp>Provides</samp>, Section 7.5</a>)
</p>
<p>
The latest version of the authoritative list of virtual package names can be
found in the <samp>debian-policy</samp> package. It is also available from the
Debian web mirrors at <samp><code><a
href="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/virtual-package-names-list.txt">/doc/packaging-manuals/virtual-package-names-list.txt</a></code></samp>.
</p>
<p>
The procedure for updating the list is described in the preface to the list.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s3.7">3.7 Base system</h2>
<p>
The <samp>base system</samp> is a minimum subset of the Debian system that is
installed before everything else on a new system. Only very few packages are
allowed to form part of the base system, in order to keep the required disk
usage very small.
</p>
<p>
The base system consists of all those packages with priority
<samp>required</samp> or <samp>important</samp>. Many of them will be tagged
<samp>essential</samp> (see below).
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s3.8">3.8 Essential packages</h2>
<p>
Essential is defined as the minimal set of functionality that must be available
and usable on the system at all times, even when packages are in the
"Unpacked" state. Packages are tagged <samp>essential</samp> for a
system using the <samp>Essential</samp> control field. The format of the
<samp>Essential</samp> control field is described in <a
href="#s-f-Essential"><samp>Essential</samp>, Section 5.6.9</a>.
</p>
<p>
Since these packages cannot be easily removed (one has to specify an extra
<em>force option</em> to <code>dpkg</code> to do so), this flag must not be
used unless absolutely necessary. A shared library package must not be tagged
<samp>essential</samp>; dependencies will prevent its premature removal, and we
need to be able to remove it when it has been superseded.
</p>
<p>
Since dpkg will not prevent upgrading of other packages while an
<samp>essential</samp> package is in an unconfigured state, all
<samp>essential</samp> packages must supply all of their core functionality
even when unconfigured. If the package cannot satisfy this requirement it must
not be tagged as essential, and any packages depending on this package must
instead have explicit dependency fields as appropriate.
</p>
<p>
Maintainers should take great care in adding any programs, interfaces, or
functionality to <samp>essential</samp> packages. Packages may assume that
functionality provided by <samp>essential</samp> packages is always available
without declaring explicit dependencies, which means that removing
functionality from the Essential set is very difficult and is almost never
done. Any capability added to an <samp>essential</samp> package therefore
creates an obligation to support that capability as part of the Essential set
in perpetuity.
</p>
<p>
You must not tag any packages <samp>essential</samp> before this has been
discussed on the <samp>debian-devel</samp> mailing list and a consensus about
doing that has been reached.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-maintscripts">3.9 Maintainer Scripts</h2>
<p>
The package installation scripts should avoid producing output which is
unnecessary for the user to see and should rely on <code>dpkg</code> to stave
off boredom on the part of a user installing many packages. This means,
amongst other things, not passing the <samp>--verbose</samp> option to
<code>update-alternatives</code>.
</p>
<p>
Errors which occur during the execution of an installation script must be
checked and the installation must not continue after an error.
</p>
<p>
Note that in general <a href="#s-scripts">Scripts, Section 10.4</a> applies to
package maintainer scripts, too.
</p>
<p>
You should not use <code>dpkg-divert</code> on a file belonging to another
package without consulting the maintainer of that package first. When adding
or removing diversions, package maintainer scripts must provide the
<samp>--package</samp> flag to <code>dpkg-divert</code> and must not use
<samp>--local</samp>.
</p>
<p>
All packages which supply an instance of a common command name (or, in general,
filename) should generally use <code>update-alternatives</code>, so that they
may be installed together. If <code>update-alternatives</code> is not used,
then each package must use <samp>Conflicts</samp> to ensure that other packages
are removed. (In this case, it may be appropriate to specify a conflict
against earlier versions of something that previously did not use
<code>update-alternatives</code>; this is an exception to the usual rule that
versioned conflicts should be avoided.)
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-maintscriptprompt">3.9.1 Prompting in maintainer scripts</h3>
<p>
Package maintainer scripts may prompt the user if necessary. Prompting must be
done by communicating through a program, such as <code>debconf</code>, which
conforms to the Debian Configuration Management Specification, version 2 or
higher.
</p>
<p>
Packages which are essential, or which are dependencies of essential packages,
may fall back on another prompting method if no such interface is available
when they are executed.
</p>
<p>
The Debian Configuration Management Specification is included in the
<code>debconf_specification</code> files in the <code>debian-policy</code>
package. It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at <samp><code><a
href="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/debconf_specification.html">/doc/packaging-manuals/debconf_specification.html</a></code></samp>.
</p>
<p>
Packages which use the Debian Configuration Management Specification may
contain the additional control information files <code>config</code> and
<code>templates</code>. <code>config</code> is an additional maintainer script
used for package configuration, and <code>templates</code> contains templates
used for user prompting. The <code>config</code> script might be run before
the <code>preinst</code> script and before the package is unpacked or any of
its dependencies or pre-dependencies are satisfied. Therefore it must work
using only the tools present in <em>essential</em> packages.[<a href="#f11"
name="fr11">11</a>]
</p>
<p>
Packages which use the Debian Configuration Management Specification must allow
for translation of their user-visible messages by using a gettext-based system
such as the one provided by the <code>po-debconf</code> package.
</p>
<p>
Packages should try to minimize the amount of prompting they need to do, and
they should ensure that the user will only ever be asked each question once.
This means that packages should try to use appropriate shared configuration
files (such as <code>/etc/papersize</code> and <code>/etc/news/server</code>),
and shared <code>debconf</code> variables rather than each prompting for their
own list of required pieces of information.
</p>
<p>
It also means that an upgrade should not ask the same questions again, unless
the user has used <samp>dpkg --purge</samp> to remove the package's
configuration. The answers to configuration questions should be stored in an
appropriate place in <code>/etc</code> so that the user can modify them, and
how this has been done should be documented.
</p>
<p>
If a package has a vitally important piece of information to pass to the user
(such as "don't run me as I am, you must edit the following configuration
files first or you risk your system emitting badly-formatted messages"),
it should display this in the <code>config</code> or <code>postinst</code>
script and prompt the user to hit return to acknowledge the message. Copyright
messages do not count as vitally important (they belong in
<code>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</code>); neither do
instructions on how to use a program (these should be in on-line documentation,
where all the users can see them).
</p>
<p>
Any necessary prompting should almost always be confined to the
<code>config</code> or <code>postinst</code> script. If it is done in the
<code>postinst</code>, it should be protected with a conditional so that
unnecessary prompting doesn't happen if a package's installation fails and the
<code>postinst</code> is called with <samp>abort-upgrade</samp>,
<samp>abort-remove</samp> or <samp>abort-deconfigure</samp>.
</p>
<p><a name="ch-source"></a></p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#ch-binary">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">1</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">2</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">3</a> ]
[ 4 ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">5</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">7</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">9</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">10</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">11</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">12</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br>Chapter 4 - Source packages
</h1>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-standardsversion">4.1 Standards conformance</h2>
<p>
Source packages should specify the most recent version number of this policy
document with which your package complied when it was last updated.
</p>
<p>
This information may be used to file bug reports automatically if your package
becomes too much out of date.
</p>
<p>
The version is specified in the <samp>Standards-Version</samp> control field.
The format of the <samp>Standards-Version</samp> field is described in <a
href="#s-f-Standards-Version"><samp>Standards-Version</samp>, Section
5.6.11</a>.
</p>
<p>
You should regularly, and especially if your package has become out of date,
check for the newest Policy Manual available and update your package, if
necessary. When your package complies with the new standards you should update
the <samp>Standards-Version</samp> source package field and release it.[<a
href="#f12" name="fr12">12</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-pkg-relations">4.2 Package relationships</h2>
<p>
Source packages should specify which binary packages they require to be
installed or not to be installed in order to build correctly. For example, if
building a package requires a certain compiler, then the compiler should be
specified as a build-time dependency.
</p>
<p>
It is not necessary to explicitly specify build-time relationships on a minimal
set of packages that are always needed to compile, link and put in a Debian
package a standard "Hello World!" program written in C or C++. The
required packages are called <em>build-essential</em>, and an informational
list can be found in <code>/usr/share/doc/build-essential/list</code> (which is
contained in the <samp>build-essential</samp> package).[<a href="#f13"
name="fr13">13</a>]
</p>
<p>
When specifying the set of build-time dependencies, one should list only those
packages explicitly required by the build. It is not necessary to list
packages which are required merely because some other package in the list of
build-time dependencies depends on them.[<a href="#f14" name="fr14">14</a>]
</p>
<p>
If build-time dependencies are specified, it must be possible to build the
package and produce working binaries on a system with only essential and
build-essential packages installed and also those required to satisfy the
build-time relationships (including any implied relationships). In particular,
this means that version clauses should be used rigorously in build-time
relationships so that one cannot produce bad or inconsistently configured
packages when the relationships are properly satisfied.
</p>
<p>
<a href="#ch-relationships">Declaring relationships between packages, Chapter
7</a> explains the technical details.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s4.3">4.3 Changes to the upstream sources</h2>
<p>
If changes to the source code are made that are not specific to the needs of
the Debian system, they should be sent to the upstream authors in whatever form
they prefer so as to be included in the upstream version of the package.
</p>
<p>
If you need to configure the package differently for Debian or for Linux, and
the upstream source doesn't provide a way to do so, you should add such
configuration facilities (for example, a new <code>autoconf</code> test or
<samp>#define</samp>) and send the patch to the upstream authors, with the
default set to the way they originally had it. You can then easily override
the default in your <code>debian/rules</code> or wherever is appropriate.
</p>
<p>
You should make sure that the <code>configure</code> utility detects the
correct architecture specification string (refer to <a
href="#s-arch-spec">Architecture specification strings, Section 11.1</a> for
details).
</p>
<p>
If you need to edit a <code>Makefile</code> where GNU-style
<code>configure</code> scripts are used, you should edit the <code>.in</code>
files rather than editing the <code>Makefile</code> directly. This allows the
user to reconfigure the package if necessary. You should <em>not</em>
configure the package and edit the generated <code>Makefile</code>! This makes
it impossible for someone else to later reconfigure the package without losing
the changes you made.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-dpkgchangelog">4.4 Debian changelog: <code>debian/changelog</code></h2>
<p>
Changes in the Debian version of the package should be briefly explained in the
Debian changelog file <code>debian/changelog</code>.[<a href="#f15"
name="fr15">15</a>] This includes modifications made in the Debian package
compared to the upstream one as well as other changes and updates to the
package. [<a href="#f16" name="fr16">16</a>]
</p>
<p>
The format of the <code>debian/changelog</code> allows the package building
tools to discover which version of the package is being built and find out
other release-specific information.
</p>
<p>
That format is a series of entries like this:
</p>
<pre>
<var>package</var> (<var>version</var>) <var>distribution(s)</var>; urgency=<var>urgency</var>
<var>[optional blank line(s), stripped]</var>
* <var>change details</var>
<var>more change details</var>
<var>[blank line(s), included in output of dpkg-parsechangelog]</var>
* <var>even more change details</var>
<var>[optional blank line(s), stripped]</var>
-- <var>maintainer name</var> <<var>email address</var>><var>[two spaces]</var> <var>date</var>
</pre>
<p>
<var>package</var> and <var>version</var> are the source package name and
version number.
</p>
<p>
<var>distribution(s)</var> lists the distributions where this version should be
installed when it is uploaded - it is copied to the <samp>Distribution</samp>
field in the <code>.changes</code> file. See <a
href="#s-f-Distribution"><samp>Distribution</samp>, Section 5.6.14</a>.
</p>
<p>
<var>urgency</var> is the value for the <samp>Urgency</samp> field in the
<code>.changes</code> file for the upload (see <a
href="#s-f-Urgency"><samp>Urgency</samp>, Section 5.6.17</a>). It is not
possible to specify an urgency containing commas; commas are used to separate
<samp><var>keyword</var>=<var>value</var></samp> settings in the
<code>dpkg</code> changelog format (though there is currently only one useful
<var>keyword</var>, <samp>urgency</samp>).
</p>
<p>
The change details may in fact be any series of lines starting with at least
two spaces, but conventionally each change starts with an asterisk and a
separating space and continuation lines are indented so as to bring them in
line with the start of the text above. Blank lines may be used here to
separate groups of changes, if desired.
</p>
<p>
If this upload resolves bugs recorded in the Bug Tracking System (BTS), they
may be automatically closed on the inclusion of this package into the Debian
archive by including the string: <samp>closes: Bug#<var>nnnnn</var></samp> in
the change details.[<a href="#f17" name="fr17">17</a>] This information is
conveyed via the <samp>Closes</samp> field in the <samp>.changes</samp> file
(see <a href="#s-f-Closes"><samp>Closes</samp>, Section 5.6.22</a>).
</p>
<p>
The maintainer name and email address used in the changelog should be the
details of the person who prepared this release of the package. They are
<em>not</em> necessarily those of the uploader or usual package maintainer.[<a
href="#f18" name="fr18">18</a>] The information here will be copied to the
<samp>Changed-By</samp> field in the <samp>.changes</samp> file (see <a
href="#s-f-Changed-By"><samp>Changed-By</samp>, Section 5.6.4</a>), and then
later used to send an acknowledgement when the upload has been installed.
</p>
<p>
The <var>date</var> has the following format[<a href="#f19" name="fr19">19</a>]
(compatible and with the same semantics of RFC 2822 and RFC 5322):
</p>
<pre>
day-of-week, dd month yyyy hh:mm:ss +zzzz
</pre>
<p>
where:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
day-of week is one of: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
dd is a one- or two-digit day of the month (01-31)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
month is one of: Jan, Feb, Mar, Apr, May, Jun, Jul, Aug, Sep, Oct, Nov, Dec
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
yyyy is the four-digit year (e.g. 2010)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
hh is the two-digit hour (00-23)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
mm is the two-digit minutes (00-59)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
ss is the two-digit seconds (00-60)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
+zzzz or -zzzz is the the time zone offset from Coordinated Universal Time
(UTC). "+" indicates that the time is ahead of (i.e., east of) UTC
and "-" indicates that the time is behind (i.e., west of) UTC. The
first two digits indicate the hour difference from UTC and the last two digits
indicate the number of additional minutes difference from UTC. The last two
digits must be in the range 00-59.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
The first "title" line with the package name must start at the left
hand margin. The "trailer" line with the maintainer and date details
must be preceded by exactly one space. The maintainer details and the date
must be separated by exactly two spaces.
</p>
<p>
The entire changelog must be encoded in UTF-8.
</p>
<p>
For more information on placement of the changelog files within binary
packages, please see <a href="#s-changelogs">Changelog files, Section 12.7</a>.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-dpkgcopyright">4.5 Copyright: <code>debian/copyright</code></h2>
<p>
Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of its copyright
information and distribution license in the file
<code>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</code> (see <a
href="#s-copyrightfile">Copyright information, Section 12.5</a> for further
details). Also see <a href="#s-pkgcopyright">Copyright considerations, Section
2.3</a> for further considerations related to copyrights for packages.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s4.6">4.6 Error trapping in makefiles</h2>
<p>
When <code>make</code> invokes a command in a makefile (including your
package's upstream makefiles and <code>debian/rules</code>), it does so using
<code>sh</code>. This means that <code>sh</code>'s usual bad error handling
properties apply: if you include a miniature script as one of the commands in
your makefile you'll find that if you don't do anything about it then errors
are not detected and <code>make</code> will blithely continue after problems.
</p>
<p>
Every time you put more than one shell command (this includes using a loop) in
a makefile command you must make sure that errors are trapped. For simple
compound commands, such as changing directory and then running a program, using
<samp>&&</samp> rather than semicolon as a command separator is
sufficient. For more complex commands including most loops and conditionals
you should include a separate <samp>set -e</samp> command at the start of every
makefile command that's actually one of these miniature shell scripts.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-timestamps">4.7 Time Stamps</h2>
<p>
Maintainers should preserve the modification times of the upstream source files
in a package, as far as is reasonably possible.[<a href="#f20"
name="fr20">20</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-restrictions">4.8 Restrictions on objects in source packages</h2>
<p>
The source package may not contain any hard links[<a href="#f21"
name="fr21">21</a>], device special files, sockets or setuid or setgid
files.[<a href="#f22" name="fr22">22</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-debianrules">4.9 Main building script: <code>debian/rules</code></h2>
<p>
This file must be an executable makefile, and contains the package-specific
recipes for compiling the package and building binary package(s) from the
source.
</p>
<p>
It must start with the line <samp>#!/usr/bin/make -f</samp>, so that it can be
invoked by saying its name rather than invoking <code>make</code> explicitly.
That is, invoking either of <samp>make -f debian/rules <em>args...</em></samp>
or <samp>./debian/rules <em>args...</em></samp> must result in identical
behavior.
</p>
<p>
The following targets are required and must be implemented by
<code>debian/rules</code>: <samp>clean</samp>, <samp>binary</samp>,
<samp>binary-arch</samp>, <samp>binary-indep</samp>, <samp>build</samp>,
<samp>build-arch</samp> and <samp>build-indep</samp>. These are the targets
called by <code>dpkg-buildpackage</code>.
</p>
<p>
Since an interactive <code>debian/rules</code> script makes it impossible to
auto-compile that package and also makes it hard for other people to reproduce
the same binary package, all required targets must be non-interactive. It also
follows that any target that these targets depend on must also be
non-interactive.
</p>
<p>
For packages in the main archive, no required targets may attempt network
access.
</p>
<p>
The targets are as follows:
</p>
<dl>
<dt><samp>build</samp> (required)</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The <samp>build</samp> target should perform all the configuration and
compilation of the package. If a package has an interactive pre-build
configuration routine, the Debian source package must either be built after
this has taken place (so that the binary package can be built without rerunning
the configuration) or the configuration routine modified to become
non-interactive. (The latter is preferable if there are architecture-specific
features detected by the configuration routine.)
</p>
<p>
For some packages, notably ones where the same source tree is compiled in
different ways to produce two binary packages, the <samp>build</samp> target
does not make much sense. For these packages it is good enough to provide two
(or more) targets (<samp>build-a</samp> and <samp>build-b</samp> or whatever)
for each of the ways of building the package, and a <samp>build</samp> target
that does nothing. The <samp>binary</samp> target will have to build the
package in each of the possible ways and make the binary package out of each.
</p>
<p>
The <samp>build</samp> target must not do anything that might require root
privilege.
</p>
<p>
The <samp>build</samp> target may need to run the <samp>clean</samp> target
first - see below.
</p>
<p>
When a package has a configuration and build routine which takes a long time,
or when the makefiles are poorly designed, or when <samp>build</samp> needs to
run <samp>clean</samp> first, it is a good idea to <samp>touch build</samp>
when the build process is complete. This will ensure that if
<samp>debian/rules build</samp> is run again it will not rebuild the whole
program.[<a href="#f23" name="fr23">23</a>]
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>build-arch</samp> (required), <samp>build-indep</samp> (required)</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The <samp>build-arch</samp> target must perform all the configuration and
compilation required for producing all architecture-dependant binary packages
(those packages for which the body of the <samp>Architecture</samp> field in
<samp>debian/control</samp> is not <samp>all</samp>). Similarly, the
<samp>build-indep</samp> target must perform all the configuration and
compilation required for producing all architecture-independent binary packages
(those packages for which the body of the <samp>Architecture</samp> field in
<samp>debian/control</samp> is <samp>all</samp>). The <samp>build</samp>
target should either depend on those targets or take the same actions as
invoking those targets would perform.[<a href="#f24" name="fr24">24</a>]
</p>
<p>
The <samp>build-arch</samp> and <samp>build-indep</samp> targets must not do
anything that might require root privilege.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>binary</samp> (required), <samp>binary-arch</samp> (required), <samp>binary-indep</samp> (required)</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The <samp>binary</samp> target must be all that is necessary for the user to
build the binary package(s) produced from this source package. It is split
into two parts: <code>binary-arch</code> builds the binary packages which are
specific to a particular architecture, and <samp>binary-indep</samp> builds
those which are not.
</p>
<p>
<samp>binary</samp> may be (and commonly is) a target with no commands which
simply depends on <samp>binary-arch</samp> and <samp>binary-indep</samp>.
</p>
<p>
Both <samp>binary-*</samp> targets should depend on the <samp>build</samp>
target, or on the appropriate <samp>build-arch</samp> or
<samp>build-indep</samp> target, if provided, so that the package is built if
it has not been already. It should then create the relevant binary package(s),
using <code>dpkg-gencontrol</code> to make their control files and
<code>dpkg-deb</code> to build them and place them in the parent of the top
level directory.
</p>
<p>
Both the <samp>binary-arch</samp> and <samp>binary-indep</samp> targets
<em>must</em> exist. If one of them has nothing to do (which will always be
the case if the source generates only a single binary package, whether
architecture-dependent or not), it must still exist and must always succeed.
</p>
<p>
The <samp>binary</samp> targets must be invoked as root.[<a href="#f25"
name="fr25">25</a>]
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>clean</samp> (required)</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This must undo any effects that the <samp>build</samp> and <samp>binary</samp>
targets may have had, except that it should leave alone any output files
created in the parent directory by a run of a <samp>binary</samp> target.
</p>
<p>
If a <samp>build</samp> file is touched at the end of the <samp>build</samp>
target, as suggested above, it should be removed as the first action that
<samp>clean</samp> performs, so that running <samp>build</samp> again after an
interrupted <samp>clean</samp> doesn't think that everything is already done.
</p>
<p>
The <samp>clean</samp> target may need to be invoked as root if
<samp>binary</samp> has been invoked since the last <samp>clean</samp>, or if
<samp>build</samp> has been invoked as root (since <samp>build</samp> may
create directories, for example).
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>get-orig-source</samp> (optional)</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This target fetches the most recent version of the original source package from
a canonical archive site (via FTP or WWW, for example), does any necessary
rearrangement to turn it into the original source tar file format described
below, and leaves it in the current directory.
</p>
<p>
This target may be invoked in any directory, and should take care to clean up
any temporary files it may have left.
</p>
<p>
This target is optional, but providing it if possible is a good idea.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>patch</samp> (optional)</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This target performs whatever additional actions are required to make the
source ready for editing (unpacking additional upstream archives, applying
patches, etc.). It is recommended to be implemented for any package where
<samp>dpkg-source -x</samp> does not result in source ready for additional
modification. See <a href="#s-readmesource">Source package handling:
<code>debian/README.source</code>, Section 4.14</a>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<p>
The <samp>build</samp>, <samp>binary</samp> and <samp>clean</samp> targets must
be invoked with the current directory being the package's top-level directory.
</p>
<p>
Additional targets may exist in <code>debian/rules</code>, either as published
or undocumented interfaces or for the package's internal use.
</p>
<p>
The architectures we build on and build for are determined by <code>make</code>
variables using the utility <code>dpkg-architecture</code>. You can determine
the Debian architecture and the GNU style architecture specification string for
the build architecture as well as for the host architecture. The build
architecture is the architecture on which <code>debian/rules</code> is run and
the package build is performed. The host architecture is the architecture on
which the resulting package will be installed and run. These are normally the
same, but may be different in the case of cross-compilation (building packages
for one architecture on machines of a different architecture).
</p>
<p>
Here is a list of supported <code>make</code> variables:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<samp>DEB_*_ARCH</samp> (the Debian architecture)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<samp>DEB_*_ARCH_CPU</samp> (the Debian CPU name)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<samp>DEB_*_ARCH_OS</samp> (the Debian System name)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<samp>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</samp> (the GNU style architecture specification string)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<samp>DEB_*_GNU_CPU</samp> (the CPU part of <samp>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</samp>)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<samp>DEB_*_GNU_SYSTEM</samp> (the System part of <samp>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</samp>)
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
where <samp>*</samp> is either <samp>BUILD</samp> for specification of the
build architecture or <samp>HOST</samp> for specification of the host
architecture.
</p>
<p>
Backward compatibility can be provided in the rules file by setting the needed
variables to suitable default values; please refer to the documentation of
<code>dpkg-architecture</code> for details.
</p>
<p>
It is important to understand that the <samp>DEB_*_ARCH</samp> string only
determines which Debian architecture we are building on or for. It should not
be used to get the CPU or system information; the <samp>DEB_*_ARCH_CPU</samp>
and <samp>DEB_*_ARCH_OS</samp> variables should be used for that. GNU style
variables should generally only be used with upstream build systems.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-debianrules-options">4.9.1 <code>debian/rules</code> and <samp>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</samp></h3>
<p>
Supporting the standardized environment variable <samp>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</samp>
is recommended. This variable can contain several flags to change how a
package is compiled and built. Each flag must be in the form <var>flag</var>
or <var>flag</var>=<var>options</var>. If multiple flags are given, they must
be separated by whitespace.[<a href="#f26" name="fr26">26</a>] <var>flag</var>
must start with a lowercase letter (<samp>a-z</samp>) and consist only of
lowercase letters, numbers (<samp>0-9</samp>), and the characters
<samp>-</samp> and <samp>_</samp> (hyphen and underscore). <var>options</var>
must not contain whitespace. The same tag should not be given multiple times
with conflicting values. Package maintainers may assume that
<samp>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</samp> will not contain conflicting tags.
</p>
<p>
The meaning of the following tags has been standardized:
</p>
<dl>
<dt>nocheck</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This tag says to not run any build-time test suite provided by the package.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>noopt</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The presence of this tag means that the package should be compiled with a
minimum of optimization. For C programs, it is best to add <samp>-O0</samp> to
<samp>CFLAGS</samp> (although this is usually the default). Some programs
might fail to build or run at this level of optimization; it may be necessary
to use <samp>-O1</samp>, for example.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>nostrip</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This tag means that the debugging symbols should not be stripped from the
binary during installation, so that debugging information may be included in
the package.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>parallel=n</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This tag means that the package should be built using up to <samp>n</samp>
parallel processes if the package build system supports this.[<a href="#f27"
name="fr27">27</a>] If the package build system does not support parallel
builds, this string must be ignored. If the package build system only supports
a lower level of concurrency than <var>n</var>, the package should be built
using as many parallel processes as the package build system supports. It is
up to the package maintainer to decide whether the package build times are long
enough and the package build system is robust enough to make supporting
parallel builds worthwhile.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<p>
Unknown flags must be ignored by <code>debian/rules</code>.
</p>
<p>
The following makefile snippet is an example of how one may implement the build
options; you will probably have to massage this example in order to make it
work for your package.
</p>
<pre>
CFLAGS = -Wall -g
INSTALL = install
INSTALL_FILE = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 644
INSTALL_PROGRAM = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 755
INSTALL_SCRIPT = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 755
INSTALL_DIR = $(INSTALL) -p -d -o root -g root -m 755
ifneq (,$(filter noopt,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
CFLAGS += -O0
else
CFLAGS += -O2
endif
ifeq (,$(filter nostrip,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
INSTALL_PROGRAM += -s
endif
ifneq (,$(filter parallel=%,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
NUMJOBS = $(patsubst parallel=%,%,$(filter parallel=%,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
MAKEFLAGS += -j$(NUMJOBS)
endif
build:
# ...
ifeq (,$(filter nocheck,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
# Code to run the package test suite.
endif
</pre>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-substvars">4.10 Variable substitutions: <code>debian/substvars</code></h2>
<p>
When <code>dpkg-gencontrol</code> generates <a
href="#s-binarycontrolfiles">binary package control files</a>
(<code>DEBIAN/control</code>), it performs variable substitutions on its output
just before writing it. Variable substitutions have the form
<samp>${<var>variable</var>}</samp>. The optional file
<code>debian/substvars</code> contains variable substitutions to be used;
variables can also be set directly from <code>debian/rules</code> using the
<samp>-V</samp> option to the source packaging commands, and certain predefined
variables are also available.
</p>
<p>
The <code>debian/substvars</code> file is usually generated and modified
dynamically by <code>debian/rules</code> targets, in which case it must be
removed by the <samp>clean</samp> target.
</p>
<p>
See <code>deb-substvars(5)</code> for full details about source variable
substitutions, including the format of <code>debian/substvars</code>.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-debianwatch">4.11 Optional upstream source location: <code>debian/watch</code></h2>
<p>
This is an optional, recommended configuration file for the <samp>uscan</samp>
utility which defines how to automatically scan ftp or http sites for newly
available updates of the package. This is used Debian QA tools to help with
quality control and maintenance of the distribution as a whole.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-debianfiles">4.12 Generated files list: <code>debian/files</code></h2>
<p>
This file is not a permanent part of the source tree; it is used while building
packages to record which files are being generated.
<code>dpkg-genchanges</code> uses it when it generates a <code>.changes</code>
file.
</p>
<p>
It should not exist in a shipped source package, and so it (and any backup
files or temporary files such as <code>files.new</code>[<a href="#f28"
name="fr28">28</a>]) should be removed by the <samp>clean</samp> target. It
may also be wise to ensure a fresh start by emptying or removing it at the
start of the <samp>binary</samp> target.
</p>
<p>
When <code>dpkg-gencontrol</code> is run for a binary package, it adds an entry
to <code>debian/files</code> for the <code>.deb</code> file that will be
created when <samp>dpkg-deb --build</samp> is run for that binary package. So
for most packages all that needs to be done with this file is to delete it in
the <samp>clean</samp> target.
</p>
<p>
If a package upload includes files besides the source package and any binary
packages whose control files were made with <code>dpkg-gencontrol</code> then
they should be placed in the parent of the package's top-level directory and
<code>dpkg-distaddfile</code> should be called to add the file to the list in
<code>debian/files</code>.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-embeddedfiles">4.13 Convenience copies of code</h2>
<p>
Some software packages include in their distribution convenience copies of code
from other software packages, generally so that users compiling from source
don't have to download multiple packages. Debian packages should not make use
of these convenience copies unless the included package is explicitly intended
to be used in this way.[<a href="#f29" name="fr29">29</a>] If the included code
is already in the Debian archive in the form of a library, the Debian packaging
should ensure that binary packages reference the libraries already in Debian
and the convenience copy is not used. If the included code is not already in
Debian, it should be packaged separately as a prerequisite if possible. [<a
href="#f30" name="fr30">30</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-readmesource">4.14 Source package handling: <code>debian/README.source</code></h2>
<p>
If running <code>dpkg-source -x</code> on a source package doesn't produce the
source of the package, ready for editing, and allow one to make changes and run
<code>dpkg-buildpackage</code> to produce a modified package without taking any
additional steps, creating a <code>debian/README.source</code> documentation
file is recommended. This file should explain how to do all of the following:
</p>
<ol type="1" start="1" >
<li>
<p>
Generate the fully patched source, in a form ready for editing, that would be
built to create Debian packages. Doing this with a <samp>patch</samp> target
in <code>debian/rules</code> is recommended; see <a href="#s-debianrules">Main
building script: <code>debian/rules</code>, Section 4.9</a>.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="2" >
<li>
<p>
Modify the source and save those modifications so that they will be applied
when building the package.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="3" >
<li>
<p>
Remove source modifications that are currently being applied when building the
package.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="4" >
<li>
<p>
Optionally, document what steps are necessary to upgrade the Debian source
package to a new upstream version, if applicable.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<p>
This explanation should include specific commands and mention any additional
required Debian packages. It should not assume familiarity with any specific
Debian packaging system or patch management tools.
</p>
<p>
This explanation may refer to a documentation file installed by one of the
package's build dependencies provided that the referenced documentation clearly
explains these tasks and is not a general reference manual.
</p>
<p>
<code>debian/README.source</code> may also include any other information that
would be helpful to someone modifying the source package. Even if the package
doesn't fit the above description, maintainers are encouraged to document in a
<code>debian/README.source</code> file any source package with a particularly
complex or unintuitive source layout or build system (for example, a package
that builds the same source multiple times to generate different binary
packages).
</p>
<p><a name="ch-controlfields"></a></p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#ch-source">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">1</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">2</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">3</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">4</a> ]
[ 5 ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">7</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">9</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">10</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">11</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">12</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br>Chapter 5 - Control files and their fields
</h1>
<p>
The package management system manipulates data represented in a common format,
known as <em>control data</em>, stored in <em>control files</em>. Control
files are used for source packages, binary packages and the
<code>.changes</code> files which control the installation of uploaded files[<a
href="#f31" name="fr31">31</a>].
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-controlsyntax">5.1 Syntax of control files</h2>
<p>
A control file consists of one or more paragraphs of fields[<a href="#f32"
name="fr32">32</a>]. The paragraphs are separated by empty lines. Parsers may
accept lines consisting solely of spaces and tabs as paragraph separators, but
control files should use empty lines. Some control files allow only one
paragraph; others allow several, in which case each paragraph usually refers to
a different package. (For example, in source packages, the first paragraph
refers to the source package, and later paragraphs refer to binary packages
generated from the source.) The ordering of the paragraphs in control files is
significant.
</p>
<p>
Each paragraph consists of a series of data fields. Each field consists of the
field name followed by a colon and then the data/value associated with that
field. The field name is composed of US-ASCII characters excluding control
characters, space, and colon (i.e., characters in the ranges 33-57 and 59-126,
inclusive). Field names must not begin with the comment character,
<samp>#</samp>, nor with the hyphen character, <samp>-</samp>.
</p>
<p>
The field ends at the end of the line or at the end of the last continuation
line (see below). Horizontal whitespace (spaces and tabs) may occur
immediately before or after the value and is ignored there; it is conventional
to put a single space after the colon. For example, a field might be:
</p>
<pre>
Package: libc6
</pre>
<p>
the field name is <samp>Package</samp> and the field value <samp>libc6</samp>.
</p>
<p>
Empty field values are only permitted in source package control files
(<code>debian/control</code>). Such fields are ignored.
</p>
<p>
A paragraph must not contain more than one instance of a particular field name.
</p>
<p>
There are three types of fields:
</p>
<dl>
<dt>simple</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The field, including its value, must be a single line. Folding of the field is
not permitted. This is the default field type if the definition of the field
does not specify a different type.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>folded</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The value of a folded field is a logical line that may span several lines. The
lines after the first are called continuation lines and must start with a space
or a tab. Whitespace, including any newlines, is not significant in the field
values of folded fields.[<a href="#f33" name="fr33">33</a>]
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>multiline</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The value of a multiline field may comprise multiple continuation lines. The
first line of the value, the part on the same line as the field name, often has
special significance or may have to be empty. Other lines are added following
the same syntax as the continuation lines of the folded fields. Whitespace,
including newlines, is significant in the values of multiline fields.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<p>
Whitespace must not appear inside names (of packages, architectures, files or
anything else) or version numbers, or between the characters of multi-character
version relationships.
</p>
<p>
The presence and purpose of a field, and the syntax of its value may differ
between types of control files.
</p>
<p>
Field names are not case-sensitive, but it is usual to capitalize the field
names using mixed case as shown below. Field values are case-sensitive unless
the description of the field says otherwise.
</p>
<p>
Paragraph separators (empty lines) and lines consisting only of spaces and tabs
are not allowed within field values or between fields. Empty lines in field
values are usually escaped by representing them by a space followed by a dot.
</p>
<p>
Lines starting with # without any preceding whitespace are comments lines that
are only permitted in source package control files
(<code>debian/control</code>). These comment lines are ignored, even between
two continuation lines. They do not end logical lines.
</p>
<p>
All control files must be encoded in UTF-8.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-sourcecontrolfiles">5.2 Source package control files -- <code>debian/control</code></h2>
<p>
The <code>debian/control</code> file contains the most vital (and
version-independent) information about the source package and about the binary
packages it creates.
</p>
<p>
The first paragraph of the control file contains information about the source
package in general. The subsequent sets each describe a binary package that
the source tree builds.
</p>
<p>
The fields in the general paragraph (the first one, for the source package)
are:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Source"><samp>Source</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Maintainer"><samp>Maintainer</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Uploaders"><samp>Uploaders</samp></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Section"><samp>Section</samp></a> (recommended)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Priority"><samp>Priority</samp></a> (recommended)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-sourcebinarydeps"><samp>Build-Depends</samp> et al</a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Standards-Version"><samp>Standards-Version</samp></a>
(recommended)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Homepage"><samp>Homepage</samp></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-VCS-fields"><samp>Vcs-Browser</samp>, <samp>Vcs-Git</samp>, et
al.</a>
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
The fields in the binary package paragraphs are:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Package"><samp>Package</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Architecture"><samp>Architecture</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Section"><samp>Section</samp></a> (recommended)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Priority"><samp>Priority</samp></a> (recommended)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Essential"><samp>Essential</samp></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-binarydeps"><samp>Depends</samp> et al</a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Description"><samp>Description</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Homepage"><samp>Homepage</samp></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-built-using"><samp>Built-Using</samp></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Package-Type"><samp>Package-Type</samp></a>
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
The syntax and semantics of the fields are described below.
</p>
<p>
These fields are used by <code>dpkg-gencontrol</code> to generate control files
for binary packages (see below), by <code>dpkg-genchanges</code> to generate
the <code>.changes</code> file to accompany the upload, and by
<code>dpkg-source</code> when it creates the <code>.dsc</code> source control
file as part of a source archive. Some fields are folded in
<code>debian/control</code>, but not in any other control file. These tools
are responsible for removing the line breaks from such fields when using fields
from <code>debian/control</code> to generate other control files. They are
also responsible for discarding empty fields.
</p>
<p>
The fields here may contain variable references - their values will be
substituted by <code>dpkg-gencontrol</code>, <code>dpkg-genchanges</code> or
<code>dpkg-source</code> when they generate output control files. See <a
href="#s-substvars">Variable substitutions: <code>debian/substvars</code>,
Section 4.10</a> for details.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-binarycontrolfiles">5.3 Binary package control files -- <code>DEBIAN/control</code></h2>
<p>
The <code>DEBIAN/control</code> file contains the most vital (and
version-dependent) information about a binary package. It consists of a single
paragraph.
</p>
<p>
The fields in this file are:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Package"><samp>Package</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Source"><samp>Source</samp></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Version"><samp>Version</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Section"><samp>Section</samp></a> (recommended)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Priority"><samp>Priority</samp></a> (recommended)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Architecture"><samp>Architecture</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Essential"><samp>Essential</samp></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-binarydeps"><samp>Depends</samp> et al</a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Installed-Size"><samp>Installed-Size</samp></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Maintainer"><samp>Maintainer</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Description"><samp>Description</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Homepage"><samp>Homepage</samp></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-built-using"><samp>Built-Using</samp></a>
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-debiansourcecontrolfiles">5.4 Debian source control files -- <samp>.dsc</samp></h2>
<p>
This file consists of a single paragraph, possibly surrounded by a PGP
signature. The fields of that paragraph are listed below. Their syntax is
described above, in <a href="#s-controlsyntax">Syntax of control files, Section
5.1</a>.
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Format"><samp>Format</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Source"><samp>Source</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Binary"><samp>Binary</samp></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Architecture"><samp>Architecture</samp></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Version"><samp>Version</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Maintainer"><samp>Maintainer</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Uploaders"><samp>Uploaders</samp></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Homepage"><samp>Homepage</samp></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-VCS-fields"><samp>Vcs-Browser</samp>, <samp>Vcs-Git</samp>, et
al.</a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Dgit"><samp>Dgit</samp></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Standards-Version"><samp>Standards-Version</samp></a>
(recommended)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-sourcebinarydeps"><samp>Build-Depends</samp> et al</a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Package-List"><samp>Package-List</samp></a> (recommended)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Checksums"><samp>Checksums-Sha1</samp> and
<samp>Checksums-Sha256</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Files"><samp>Files</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
The Debian source control file is generated by <code>dpkg-source</code> when it
builds the source archive, from other files in the source package, described
above. When unpacking, it is checked against the files and directories in the
other parts of the source package.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-debianchangesfiles">5.5 Debian changes files -- <code>.changes</code></h2>
<p>
The <code>.changes</code> files are used by the Debian archive maintenance
software to process updates to packages. They consist of a single paragraph,
possibly surrounded by a PGP signature. That paragraph contains information
from the <code>debian/control</code> file and other data about the source
package gathered via <code>debian/changelog</code> and
<code>debian/rules</code>.
</p>
<p>
<code>.changes</code> files have a format version that is incremented whenever
the documented fields or their meaning change. This document describes format
1.8.
</p>
<p>
The fields in this file are:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Format"><samp>Format</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Date"><samp>Date</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Source"><samp>Source</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Binary"><samp>Binary</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Architecture"><samp>Architecture</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Version"><samp>Version</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Distribution"><samp>Distribution</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Urgency"><samp>Urgency</samp></a> (recommended)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Maintainer"><samp>Maintainer</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Changed-By"><samp>Changed-By</samp></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Description"><samp>Description</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Closes"><samp>Closes</samp></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Changes"><samp>Changes</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Checksums"><samp>Checksums-Sha1</samp> and
<samp>Checksums-Sha256</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#s-f-Files"><samp>Files</samp></a> (mandatory)
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-controlfieldslist">5.6 List of fields</h2>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Source">5.6.1 <samp>Source</samp></h3>
<p>
This field identifies the source package name.
</p>
<p>
In <code>debian/control</code> or a <code>.dsc</code> file, this field must
contain only the name of the source package.
</p>
<p>
In a binary package control file or a <code>.changes</code> file, the source
package name may be followed by a version number in parentheses[<a href="#f34"
name="fr34">34</a>]. This version number may be omitted (and is, by
<code>dpkg-gencontrol</code>) if it has the same value as the
<samp>Version</samp> field of the binary package in question. The field itself
may be omitted from a binary package control file when the source package has
the same name and version as the binary package.
</p>
<p>
Package names (both source and binary, see <a
href="#s-f-Package"><samp>Package</samp>, Section 5.6.7</a>) must consist only
of lower case letters (<samp>a-z</samp>), digits (<samp>0-9</samp>), plus
(<samp>+</samp>) and minus (<samp>-</samp>) signs, and periods
(<samp>.</samp>). They must be at least two characters long and must start
with an alphanumeric character.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Maintainer">5.6.2 <samp>Maintainer</samp></h3>
<p>
The package maintainer's name and email address. The name must come first,
then the email address inside angle brackets <samp><></samp> (in RFC822
format).
</p>
<p>
If the maintainer's name contains a full stop then the whole field will not
work directly as an email address due to a misfeature in the syntax specified
in RFC822; a program using this field as an address must check for this and
correct the problem if necessary (for example by putting the name in round
brackets and moving it to the end, and bringing the email address forward).
</p>
<p>
See <a href="#s-maintainer">The maintainer of a package, Section 3.3</a> for
additional requirements and information about package maintainers.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Uploaders">5.6.3 <samp>Uploaders</samp></h3>
<p>
List of the names and email addresses of co-maintainers of the package, if any.
If the package has other maintainers besides the one named in the <a
href="#s-f-Maintainer">Maintainer field</a>, their names and email addresses
should be listed here. The format of each entry is the same as that of the
Maintainer field, and multiple entries must be comma separated.
</p>
<p>
This is normally an optional field, but if the <samp>Maintainer</samp> control
field names a group of people and a shared email address, the
<samp>Uploaders</samp> field must be present and must contain at least one
human with their personal email address.
</p>
<p>
The Uploaders field in <code>debian/control</code> can be folded.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Changed-By">5.6.4 <samp>Changed-By</samp></h3>
<p>
The name and email address of the person who prepared this version of the
package, usually a maintainer. The syntax is the same as for the <a
href="#s-f-Maintainer">Maintainer field</a>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Section">5.6.5 <samp>Section</samp></h3>
<p>
This field specifies an application area into which the package has been
classified. See <a href="#s-subsections">Sections, Section 2.4</a>.
</p>
<p>
When it appears in the <code>debian/control</code> file, it gives the value for
the subfield of the same name in the <samp>Files</samp> field of the
<code>.changes</code> file. It also gives the default for the same field in
the binary packages.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Priority">5.6.6 <samp>Priority</samp></h3>
<p>
This field represents how important it is that the user have the package
installed. See <a href="#s-priorities">Priorities, Section 2.5</a>.
</p>
<p>
When it appears in the <code>debian/control</code> file, it gives the value for
the subfield of the same name in the <samp>Files</samp> field of the
<code>.changes</code> file. It also gives the default for the same field in
the binary packages.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Package">5.6.7 <samp>Package</samp></h3>
<p>
The name of the binary package.
</p>
<p>
Binary package names must follow the same syntax and restrictions as source
package names. See <a href="#s-f-Source"><samp>Source</samp>, Section
5.6.1</a> for the details.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Architecture">5.6.8 <samp>Architecture</samp></h3>
<p>
Depending on context and the control file used, the <samp>Architecture</samp>
field can include the following sets of values:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
A unique single word identifying a Debian machine architecture as described in
<a href="#s-arch-spec">Architecture specification strings, Section 11.1</a>.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
An architecture wildcard identifying a set of Debian machine architectures, see
<a href="#s-arch-wildcard-spec">Architecture wildcards, Section 11.1.1</a>.
<samp>any</samp> matches all Debian machine architectures and is the most
frequently used.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<samp>all</samp>, which indicates an architecture-independent package.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<samp>source</samp>, which indicates a source package.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
In the main <code>debian/control</code> file in the source package, this field
may contain the special value <samp>all</samp>, the special architecture
wildcard <samp>any</samp>, or a list of specific and wildcard architectures
separated by spaces. If <samp>all</samp> or <samp>any</samp> appears, that
value must be the entire contents of the field. Most packages will use either
<samp>all</samp> or <samp>any</samp>.
</p>
<p>
Specifying a specific list of architectures indicates that the source will
build an architecture-dependent package only on architectures included in the
list. Specifying a list of architecture wildcards indicates that the source
will build an architecture-dependent package on only those architectures that
match any of the specified architecture wildcards. Specifying a list of
architectures or architecture wildcards other than <samp>any</samp> is for the
minority of cases where a program is not portable or is not useful on some
architectures. Where possible, the program should be made portable instead.
</p>
<p>
In the Debian source control file <code>.dsc</code>, this field contains a list
of architectures and architecture wildcards separated by spaces. When the list
contains the architecture wildcard <samp>any</samp>, the only other value
allowed in the list is <samp>all</samp>.
</p>
<p>
The list may include (or consist solely of) the special value <samp>all</samp>.
In other words, in <code>.dsc</code> files unlike the
<code>debian/control</code>, <samp>all</samp> may occur in combination with
specific architectures. The <samp>Architecture</samp> field in the Debian
source control file <code>.dsc</code> is generally constructed from the
<samp>Architecture</samp> fields in the <code>debian/control</code> in the
source package.
</p>
<p>
Specifying only <samp>any</samp> indicates that the source package isn't
dependent on any particular architecture and should compile fine on any one.
The produced binary package(s) will be specific to whatever the current build
architecture is.
</p>
<p>
Specifying only <samp>all</samp> indicates that the source package will only
build architecture-independent packages.
</p>
<p>
Specifying <samp>any all</samp> indicates that the source package isn't
dependent on any particular architecture. The set of produced binary packages
will include at least one architecture-dependant package and one
architecture-independent package.
</p>
<p>
Specifying a list of architectures or architecture wildcards indicates that the
source will build an architecture-dependent package, and will only work
correctly on the listed or matching architectures. If the source package also
builds at least one architecture-independent package, <samp>all</samp> will
also be included in the list.
</p>
<p>
In a <code>.changes</code> file, the <samp>Architecture</samp> field lists the
architecture(s) of the package(s) currently being uploaded. This will be a
list; if the source for the package is also being uploaded, the special entry
<samp>source</samp> is also present. <samp>all</samp> will be present if any
architecture-independent packages are being uploaded. Architecture wildcards
such as <samp>any</samp> must never occur in the <samp>Architecture</samp>
field in the <code>.changes</code> file.
</p>
<p>
See <a href="#s-debianrules">Main building script: <code>debian/rules</code>,
Section 4.9</a> for information on how to get the architecture for the build
process.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Essential">5.6.9 <samp>Essential</samp></h3>
<p>
This is a boolean field which may occur only in the control file of a binary
package or in a per-package fields paragraph of a source package control file.
</p>
<p>
If set to <samp>yes</samp> then the package management system will refuse to
remove the package (upgrading and replacing it is still possible). The other
possible value is <samp>no</samp>, which is the same as not having the field at
all.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s5.6.10">5.6.10 Package interrelationship fields: <samp>Depends</samp>, <samp>Pre-Depends</samp>, <samp>Recommends</samp>, <samp>Suggests</samp>, <samp>Breaks</samp>, <samp>Conflicts</samp>, <samp>Provides</samp>, <samp>Replaces</samp>, <samp>Enhances</samp></h3>
<p>
These fields describe the package's relationships with other packages. Their
syntax and semantics are described in <a href="#ch-relationships">Declaring
relationships between packages, Chapter 7</a>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Standards-Version">5.6.11 <samp>Standards-Version</samp></h3>
<p>
The most recent version of the standards (the policy manual and associated
texts) with which the package complies.
</p>
<p>
The version number has four components: major and minor version number and
major and minor patch level. When the standards change in a way that requires
every package to change the major number will be changed. Significant changes
that will require work in many packages will be signaled by a change to the
minor number. The major patch level will be changed for any change to the
meaning of the standards, however small; the minor patch level will be changed
when only cosmetic, typographical or other edits are made which neither change
the meaning of the document nor affect the contents of packages.
</p>
<p>
Thus only the first three components of the policy version are significant in
the <em>Standards-Version</em> control field, and so either these three
components or all four components may be specified.[<a href="#f35"
name="fr35">35</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Version">5.6.12 <samp>Version</samp></h3>
<p>
The version number of a package. The format is:
[<var>epoch</var><samp>:</samp>]<var>upstream_version</var>[<samp>-</samp><var>debian_revision</var>]
</p>
<p>
The three components here are:
</p>
<dl>
<dt><var>epoch</var></dt>
<dd>
<p>
This is a single (generally small) unsigned integer. It may be omitted, in
which case zero is assumed. If it is omitted then the
<var>upstream_version</var> may not contain any colons.
</p>
<p>
It is provided to allow mistakes in the version numbers of older versions of a
package, and also a package's previous version numbering schemes, to be left
behind.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><var>upstream_version</var></dt>
<dd>
<p>
This is the main part of the version number. It is usually the version number
of the original ("upstream") package from which the <code>.deb</code>
file has been made, if this is applicable. Usually this will be in the same
format as that specified by the upstream author(s); however, it may need to be
reformatted to fit into the package management system's format and comparison
scheme.
</p>
<p>
The comparison behavior of the package management system with respect to the
<var>upstream_version</var> is described below. The
<var>upstream_version</var> portion of the version number is mandatory.
</p>
<p>
The <var>upstream_version</var> may contain only alphanumerics[<a href="#f36"
name="fr36">36</a>] and the characters <samp>.</samp> <samp>+</samp>
<samp>-</samp> <samp>:</samp> <samp>~</samp> (full stop, plus, hyphen, colon,
tilde) and should start with a digit. If there is no
<var>debian_revision</var> then hyphens are not allowed; if there is no
<var>epoch</var> then colons are not allowed.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><var>debian_revision</var></dt>
<dd>
<p>
This part of the version number specifies the version of the Debian package
based on the upstream version. It may contain only alphanumerics and the
characters <samp>+</samp> <samp>.</samp> <samp>~</samp> (plus, full stop,
tilde) and is compared in the same way as the <var>upstream_version</var> is.
</p>
<p>
It is optional; if it isn't present then the <var>upstream_version</var> may
not contain a hyphen. This format represents the case where a piece of
software was written specifically to be a Debian package, where the Debian
package source must always be identical to the pristine source and therefore no
revision indication is required.
</p>
<p>
It is conventional to restart the <var>debian_revision</var> at <samp>1</samp>
each time the <var>upstream_version</var> is increased.
</p>
<p>
The package management system will break the version number apart at the last
hyphen in the string (if there is one) to determine the
<var>upstream_version</var> and <var>debian_revision</var>. The absence of a
<var>debian_revision</var> is equivalent to a <var>debian_revision</var> of
<samp>0</samp>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<p>
When comparing two version numbers, first the <var>epoch</var> of each are
compared, then the <var>upstream_version</var> if <var>epoch</var> is equal,
and then <var>debian_revision</var> if <var>upstream_version</var> is also
equal. <var>epoch</var> is compared numerically. The
<var>upstream_version</var> and <var>debian_revision</var> parts are compared
by the package management system using the following algorithm:
</p>
<p>
The strings are compared from left to right.
</p>
<p>
First the initial part of each string consisting entirely of non-digit
characters is determined. These two parts (one of which may be empty) are
compared lexically. If a difference is found it is returned. The lexical
comparison is a comparison of ASCII values modified so that all the letters
sort earlier than all the non-letters and so that a tilde sorts before
anything, even the end of a part. For example, the following parts are in
sorted order from earliest to latest: <samp>~~</samp>, <samp>~~a</samp>,
<samp>~</samp>, the empty part, <samp>a</samp>.[<a href="#f37"
name="fr37">37</a>]
</p>
<p>
Then the initial part of the remainder of each string which consists entirely
of digit characters is determined. The numerical values of these two parts are
compared, and any difference found is returned as the result of the comparison.
For these purposes an empty string (which can only occur at the end of one or
both version strings being compared) counts as zero.
</p>
<p>
These two steps (comparing and removing initial non-digit strings and initial
digit strings) are repeated until a difference is found or both strings are
exhausted.
</p>
<p>
Note that the purpose of epochs is to allow us to leave behind mistakes in
version numbering, and to cope with situations where the version numbering
scheme changes. It is <em>not</em> intended to cope with version numbers
containing strings of letters which the package management system cannot
interpret (such as <samp>ALPHA</samp> or <samp>pre-</samp>), or with silly
orderings.[<a href="#f38" name="fr38">38</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Description">5.6.13 <samp>Description</samp></h3>
<p>
In a source or binary control file, the <samp>Description</samp> field contains
a description of the binary package, consisting of two parts, the synopsis or
the short description, and the long description. It is a multiline field with
the following format:
</p>
<pre>
Description: <single line synopsis>
<extended description over several lines>
</pre>
<p>
The lines in the extended description can have these formats:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
Those starting with a single space are part of a paragraph. Successive lines
of this form will be word-wrapped when displayed. The leading space will
usually be stripped off. The line must contain at least one non-whitespace
character.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
Those starting with two or more spaces. These will be displayed verbatim. If
the display cannot be panned horizontally, the displaying program will line
wrap them "hard" (i.e., without taking account of word breaks). If
it can they will be allowed to trail off to the right. None, one or two
initial spaces may be deleted, but the number of spaces deleted from each line
will be the same (so that you can have indenting work correctly, for example).
The line must contain at least one non-whitespace character.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
Those containing a single space followed by a single full stop character.
These are rendered as blank lines. This is the <em>only</em> way to get a
blank line[<a href="#f39" name="fr39">39</a>].
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
Those containing a space, a full stop and some more characters. These are for
future expansion. Do not use them.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
Do not use tab characters. Their effect is not predictable.
</p>
<p>
See <a href="#s-descriptions">The description of a package, Section 3.4</a> for
further information on this.
</p>
<p>
In a <code>.changes</code> file, the <samp>Description</samp> field contains a
summary of the descriptions for the packages being uploaded. For this case,
the first line of the field value (the part on the same line as
<samp>Description:</samp>) is always empty. It is a multiline field, with one
line per package. Each line is indented by one space and contains the name of
a binary package, a space, a hyphen (<samp>-</samp>), a space, and the short
description line from that package.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Distribution">5.6.14 <samp>Distribution</samp></h3>
<p>
In a <code>.changes</code> file or parsed changelog output this contains the
(space-separated) name(s) of the distribution(s) where this version of the
package should be installed. Valid distributions are determined by the archive
maintainers.[<a href="#f40" name="fr40">40</a>] The Debian archive software
only supports listing a single distribution. Migration of packages to other
distributions is handled outside of the upload process.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Date">5.6.15 <samp>Date</samp></h3>
<p>
This field includes the date the package was built or last edited. It must be
in the same format as the <var>date</var> in a <code>debian/changelog</code>
entry.
</p>
<p>
The value of this field is usually extracted from the
<code>debian/changelog</code> file - see <a href="#s-dpkgchangelog">Debian
changelog: <code>debian/changelog</code>, Section 4.4</a>).
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Format">5.6.16 <samp>Format</samp></h3>
<p>
In <a href="#s-debianchangesfiles"><code>.changes</code></a> files, this field
declares the format version of that file. The syntax of the field value is the
same as that of a <a href="#s-f-Version">package version number</a> except that
no epoch or Debian revision is allowed. The format described in this document
is <samp>1.8</samp>.
</p>
<p>
In <a href="#s-debiansourcecontrolfiles"><code>.dsc</code> Debian source
control</a> files, this field declares the format of the source package. The
field value is used by programs acting on a source package to interpret the
list of files in the source package and determine how to unpack it. The syntax
of the field value is a numeric major revision, a period, a numeric minor
revision, and then an optional subtype after whitespace, which if specified is
an alphanumeric word in parentheses. The subtype is optional in the syntax but
may be mandatory for particular source format revisions. [<a href="#f41"
name="fr41">41</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Urgency">5.6.17 <samp>Urgency</samp></h3>
<p>
This is a description of how important it is to upgrade to this version from
previous ones. It consists of a single keyword taking one of the values
<samp>low</samp>, <samp>medium</samp>, <samp>high</samp>,
<samp>emergency</samp>, or <samp>critical</samp>[<a href="#f42"
name="fr42">42</a>] (not case-sensitive) followed by an optional commentary
(separated by a space) which is usually in parentheses. For example:
</p>
<pre>
Urgency: low (HIGH for users of diversions)
</pre>
<p>
The value of this field is usually extracted from the
<code>debian/changelog</code> file - see <a href="#s-dpkgchangelog">Debian
changelog: <code>debian/changelog</code>, Section 4.4</a>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Changes">5.6.18 <samp>Changes</samp></h3>
<p>
This multiline field contains the human-readable changes data, describing the
differences between the last version and the current one.
</p>
<p>
The first line of the field value (the part on the same line as
<samp>Changes:</samp>) is always empty. The content of the field is expressed
as continuation lines, with each line indented by at least one space. Blank
lines must be represented by a line consisting only of a space and a full stop
(<samp>.</samp>).
</p>
<p>
The value of this field is usually extracted from the
<code>debian/changelog</code> file - see <a href="#s-dpkgchangelog">Debian
changelog: <code>debian/changelog</code>, Section 4.4</a>).
</p>
<p>
Each version's change information should be preceded by a "title"
line giving at least the version, distribution(s) and urgency, in a
human-readable way.
</p>
<p>
If data from several versions is being returned the entry for the most recent
version should be returned first, and entries should be separated by the
representation of a blank line (the "title" line may also be followed
by the representation of a blank line).
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Binary">5.6.19 <samp>Binary</samp></h3>
<p>
This folded field is a list of binary packages. Its syntax and meaning varies
depending on the control file in which it appears.
</p>
<p>
When it appears in the <code>.dsc</code> file, it lists binary packages which a
source package can produce, separated by commas[<a href="#f43"
name="fr43">43</a>]. The source package does not necessarily produce all of
these binary packages for every architecture. The source control file doesn't
contain details of which architectures are appropriate for which of the binary
packages.
</p>
<p>
When it appears in a <code>.changes</code> file, it lists the names of the
binary packages being uploaded, separated by whitespace (not commas).
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Installed-Size">5.6.20 <samp>Installed-Size</samp></h3>
<p>
This field appears in the control files of binary packages, and in the
<code>Packages</code> files. It gives an estimate of the total amount of disk
space required to install the named package. Actual installed size may vary
based on block size, file system properties, or actions taken by package
maintainer scripts.
</p>
<p>
The disk space is given as the integer value of the estimated installed size in
bytes, divided by 1024 and rounded up.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Files">5.6.21 <samp>Files</samp></h3>
<p>
This field contains a list of files with information about each one. The exact
information and syntax varies with the context.
</p>
<p>
In all cases, Files is a multiline field. The first line of the field value
(the part on the same line as <samp>Files:</samp>) is always empty. The
content of the field is expressed as continuation lines, one line per file.
Each line must be indented by one space and contain a number of sub-fields,
separated by spaces, as described below.
</p>
<p>
In the <code>.dsc</code> file, each line contains the MD5 checksum, size and
filename of the tar file and (if applicable) diff file which make up the
remainder of the source package[<a href="#f44" name="fr44">44</a>]. For
example:
</p>
<pre>
Files:
c6f698f19f2a2aa07dbb9bbda90a2754 571925 example_1.2.orig.tar.gz
938512f08422f3509ff36f125f5873ba 6220 example_1.2-1.diff.gz
</pre>
<p>
The exact forms of the filenames are described in <a
href="#s-pkg-sourcearchives">Source packages as archives, Section C.3</a>.
</p>
<p>
In the <code>.changes</code> file this contains one line per file being
uploaded. Each line contains the MD5 checksum, size, section and priority and
the filename. For example:
</p>
<pre>
Files:
4c31ab7bfc40d3cf49d7811987390357 1428 text extra example_1.2-1.dsc
c6f698f19f2a2aa07dbb9bbda90a2754 571925 text extra example_1.2.orig.tar.gz
938512f08422f3509ff36f125f5873ba 6220 text extra example_1.2-1.diff.gz
7c98fe853b3bbb47a00e5cd129b6cb56 703542 text extra example_1.2-1_i386.deb
</pre>
<p>
The <a href="#s-f-Section">section</a> and <a href="#s-f-Priority">priority</a>
are the values of the corresponding fields in the main source control file. If
no section or priority is specified then <samp>-</samp> should be used, though
section and priority values must be specified for new packages to be installed
properly.
</p>
<p>
The special value <samp>byhand</samp> for the section in a
<samp>.changes</samp> file indicates that the file in question is not an
ordinary package file and must be installed by hand by the distribution
maintainers. If the section is <samp>byhand</samp> the priority should be
<samp>-</samp>.
</p>
<p>
If a new Debian revision of a package is being shipped and no new original
source archive is being distributed the <samp>.dsc</samp> must still contain
the <samp>Files</samp> field entry for the original source archive
<code><var>package</var>_<var>upstream-version</var>.orig.tar.gz</code>, but
the <code>.changes</code> file should leave it out. In this case the original
source archive on the distribution site must match exactly, byte-for-byte, the
original source archive which was used to generate the <code>.dsc</code> file
and diff which are being uploaded.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Closes">5.6.22 <samp>Closes</samp></h3>
<p>
A space-separated list of bug report numbers that the upload governed by the
.changes file closes.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Homepage">5.6.23 <samp>Homepage</samp></h3>
<p>
The URL of the web site for this package, preferably (when applicable) the site
from which the original source can be obtained and any additional upstream
documentation or information may be found. The content of this field is a
simple URL without any surrounding characters such as <samp><></samp>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Checksums">5.6.24 <samp>Checksums-Sha1</samp> and <samp>Checksums-Sha256</samp></h3>
<p>
These multiline fields contain a list of files with a checksum and size for
each one. Both <samp>Checksums-Sha1</samp> and <samp>Checksums-Sha256</samp>
have the same syntax and differ only in the checksum algorithm used: SHA-1 for
<samp>Checksums-Sha1</samp> and SHA-256 for <samp>Checksums-Sha256</samp>.
</p>
<p>
<samp>Checksums-Sha1</samp> and <samp>Checksums-Sha256</samp> are multiline
fields. The first line of the field value (the part on the same line as
<samp>Checksums-Sha1:</samp> or <samp>Checksums-Sha256:</samp>) is always
empty. The content of the field is expressed as continuation lines, one line
per file. Each line consists of the checksum, a space, the file size, a space,
and the file name. For example (from a <code>.changes</code> file):
</p>
<pre>
Checksums-Sha1:
1f418afaa01464e63cc1ee8a66a05f0848bd155c 1276 example_1.0-1.dsc
a0ed1456fad61116f868b1855530dbe948e20f06 171602 example_1.0.orig.tar.gz
5e86ecf0671e113b63388dac81dd8d00e00ef298 6137 example_1.0-1.debian.tar.gz
71a0ff7da0faaf608481195f9cf30974b142c183 548402 example_1.0-1_i386.deb
Checksums-Sha256:
ac9d57254f7e835bed299926fd51bf6f534597cc3fcc52db01c4bffedae81272 1276 example_1.0-1.dsc
0d123be7f51e61c4bf15e5c492b484054be7e90f3081608a5517007bfb1fd128 171602 example_1.0.orig.tar.gz
f54ae966a5f580571ae7d9ef5e1df0bd42d63e27cb505b27957351a495bc6288 6137 example_1.0-1.debian.tar.gz
3bec05c03974fdecd11d020fc2e8250de8404867a8a2ce865160c250eb723664 548402 example_1.0-1_i386.deb
</pre>
<p>
In the <code>.dsc</code> file, these fields list all files that make up the
source package. In the <code>.changes</code> file, these fields list all files
being uploaded. The list of files in these fields must match the list of files
in the <samp>Files</samp> field.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s5.6.25">5.6.25 <samp>DM-Upload-Allowed</samp></h3>
<p>
Obsolete, see <a href="#s-f-DM-Upload-Allowed">below</a>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-VCS-fields">5.6.26 Version Control System (VCS) fields</h3>
<p>
Debian source packages are increasingly developed using VCSs. The purpose of
the following fields is to indicate a publicly accessible repository where the
Debian source package is developed.
</p>
<dl>
<dt><samp>Vcs-Browser</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
URL of a web interface for browsing the repository.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>Vcs-Arch</samp>, <samp>Vcs-Bzr</samp> (Bazaar), <samp>Vcs-Cvs</samp>, <samp>Vcs-Darcs</samp>, <samp>Vcs-Git</samp>, <samp>Vcs-Hg</samp> (Mercurial), <samp>Vcs-Mtn</samp> (Monotone), <samp>Vcs-Svn</samp> (Subversion)</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The field name identifies the VCS. The field's value uses the version control
system's conventional syntax for describing repository locations and should be
sufficient to locate the repository used for packaging. Ideally, it also
locates the branch used for development of new versions of the Debian package.
</p>
<p>
In the case of Git, the value consists of a URL, optionally followed by the
word <samp>-b</samp> and the name of a branch in the indicated repository,
following the syntax of the <samp>git clone</samp> command. If no branch is
specified, the packaging should be on the default branch.
</p>
<p>
More than one different VCS may be specified for the same package.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Package-List">5.6.27 <samp>Package-List</samp></h3>
<p>
Multiline field listing all the packages that can be built from the source
package, considering every architecture. The first line of the field value is
empty. Each one of the next lines describes one binary package, by listing its
name, type, section and priority separated by spaces. Fifth and subsequent
space-separated items may be present and parsers must allow them. See the <a
href="#s-f-Package-Type">Package-Type</a> field for a list of package types.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Package-Type">5.6.28 <samp>Package-Type</samp></h3>
<p>
Simple field containing a word indicating the type of package: <samp>deb</samp>
for binary packages and <samp>udeb</samp> for micro binary packages. Other
types not defined here may be indicated. In source package control files, the
<samp>Package-Type</samp> field should be omitted instead of giving it a value
of <samp>deb</samp>, as this value is assumed for paragraphs lacking this
field.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-Dgit">5.6.29 <samp>Dgit</samp></h3>
<p>
Folded field containing a single git commit hash, presented in full, followed
optionally by whitespace and other data to be defined in future extensions.
</p>
<p>
Declares that the source package corresponds exactly to a referenced commit in
a Git repository available at the canonical location called
<em>dgit-repos</em>, used by <code>dgit</code>, a bidirectional gateway between
the Debian archive and Git. The commit is reachable from at least one
reference whose name matches <samp>refs/dgit/*</samp>. See the manual page of
<code>dgit</code> for further details.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s5.7">5.7 User-defined fields</h2>
<p>
Additional user-defined fields may be added to the source package control file.
Such fields will be ignored, and not copied to (for example) binary or Debian
source control files or upload control files.
</p>
<p>
If you wish to add additional unsupported fields to these output files you
should use the mechanism described here.
</p>
<p>
Fields in the main source control information file with names starting
<samp>X</samp>, followed by one or more of the letters <samp>BCS</samp> and a
hyphen <samp>-</samp>, will be copied to the output files. Only the part of
the field name after the hyphen will be used in the output file. Where the
letter <samp>B</samp> is used the field will appear in binary package control
files, where the letter <samp>S</samp> is used in Debian source control files
and where <samp>C</samp> is used in upload control (<samp>.changes</samp>)
files.
</p>
<p>
For example, if the main source information control file contains the field
</p>
<pre>
XBS-Comment: I stand between the candle and the star.
</pre>
<p>
then the binary and Debian source control files will contain the field
</p>
<pre>
Comment: I stand between the candle and the star.
</pre>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-obsolete-control-data-fields">5.8 Obsolete fields</h2>
<p>
The following fields have been obsoleted and may be found in packages
conforming with previous versions of the Policy.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-f-DM-Upload-Allowed">5.8.1 <samp>DM-Upload-Allowed</samp></h3>
<p>
Indicates that Debian Maintainers may upload this package to the Debian
archive. The only valid value is <samp>yes</samp>. This field was used to
regulate uploads by Debian Maintainers, See the General Resolution <code><a
href="http://www.debian.org/vote/2007/vote_003">Endorse the concept of Debian
Maintainers</a></code> for more details.
</p>
<p><a name="ch-maintainerscripts"></a></p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">1</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">2</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">3</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">4</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">5</a> ]
[ 6 ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">7</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">9</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">10</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">11</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">12</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br>Chapter 6 - Package maintainer scripts and installation procedure
</h1>
<hr>
<h2 id="s6.1">6.1 Introduction to package maintainer scripts</h2>
<p>
It is possible to supply scripts as part of a package which the package
management system will run for you when your package is installed, upgraded or
removed.
</p>
<p>
These scripts are the control information files <code>preinst</code>,
<code>postinst</code>, <code>prerm</code> and <code>postrm</code>. They must
be proper executable files; if they are scripts (which is recommended), they
must start with the usual <samp>#!</samp> convention. They should be readable
and executable by anyone, and must not be world-writable.
</p>
<p>
The package management system looks at the exit status from these scripts. It
is important that they exit with a non-zero status if there is an error, so
that the package management system can stop its processing. For shell scripts
this means that you <em>almost always</em> need to use <samp>set -e</samp>
(this is usually true when writing shell scripts, in fact). It is also
important, of course, that they exit with a zero status if everything went
well.
</p>
<p>
Additionally, packages interacting with users using <code>debconf</code> in the
<code>postinst</code> script should install a <code>config</code> script as a
control information file. See <a href="#s-maintscriptprompt">Prompting in
maintainer scripts, Section 3.9.1</a> for details.
</p>
<p>
When a package is upgraded a combination of the scripts from the old and new
packages is called during the upgrade procedure. If your scripts are going to
be at all complicated you need to be aware of this, and may need to check the
arguments to your scripts.
</p>
<p>
Broadly speaking the <code>preinst</code> is called before (a particular
version of) a package is unpacked, and the <code>postinst</code> afterwards;
the <code>prerm</code> before (a version of) a package is removed and the
<code>postrm</code> afterwards.
</p>
<p>
Programs called from maintainer scripts should not normally have a path
prepended to them. Before installation is started, the package management
system checks to see if the programs <code>ldconfig</code>,
<code>start-stop-daemon</code>, and <code>update-rc.d</code> can be found via
the <samp>PATH</samp> environment variable. Those programs, and any other
program that one would expect to be in the <samp>PATH</samp>, should thus be
invoked without an absolute pathname. Maintainer scripts should also not reset
the <samp>PATH</samp>, though they might choose to modify it by prepending or
appending package-specific directories. These considerations really apply to
all shell scripts.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-idempotency">6.2 Maintainer scripts idempotency</h2>
<p>
It is necessary for the error recovery procedures that the scripts be
idempotent. This means that if it is run successfully, and then it is called
again, it doesn't bomb out or cause any harm, but just ensures that everything
is the way it ought to be. If the first call failed, or aborted half way
through for some reason, the second call should merely do the things that were
left undone the first time, if any, and exit with a success status if
everything is OK.[<a href="#f45" name="fr45">45</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-controllingterminal">6.3 Controlling terminal for maintainer scripts</h2>
<p>
Maintainer scripts are not guaranteed to run with a controlling terminal and
may not be able to interact with the user. They must be able to fall back to
noninteractive behavior if no controlling terminal is available. Maintainer
scripts that prompt via a program conforming to the Debian Configuration
Management Specification (see <a href="#s-maintscriptprompt">Prompting in
maintainer scripts, Section 3.9.1</a>) may assume that program will handle
falling back to noninteractive behavior.
</p>
<p>
For high-priority prompts without a reasonable default answer, maintainer
scripts may abort if there is no controlling terminal. However, this situation
should be avoided if at all possible, since it prevents automated or unattended
installs. In most cases, users will consider this to be a bug in the package.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-exitstatus">6.4 Exit status</h2>
<p>
Each script must return a zero exit status for success, or a nonzero one for
failure, since the package management system looks for the exit status of these
scripts and determines what action to take next based on that datum.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-mscriptsinstact">6.5 Summary of ways maintainer scripts are called</h2>
<p>
What follows is a summary of all the ways in which maintainer scripts may be
called along with what facilities those scripts may rely on being available at
that time. Script names preceded by <var>new-</var> are the scripts from the
new version of a package being installed, upgraded to, or downgraded to.
Script names preceded by <var>old-</var> are the scripts from the old version
of a package that is being upgraded from or downgraded from.
</p>
<p>
The <code>preinst</code> script may be called in the following ways:
</p>
<dl>
<dt><var>new-preinst</var> <samp>install</samp></dt>
<dt><var>new-preinst</var> <samp>install</samp> <var>old-version</var></dt>
<dt><var>new-preinst</var> <samp>upgrade</samp> <var>old-version</var></dt>
<dd>
<p>
The package will not yet be unpacked, so the <code>preinst</code> script cannot
rely on any files included in its package. Only essential packages and
pre-dependencies (<samp>Pre-Depends</samp>) may be assumed to be available.
Pre-dependencies will have been configured at least once, but at the time the
<code>preinst</code> is called they may only be in an "Unpacked" or
"Half-Configured" state if a previous version of the pre-dependency
was completely configured and has not been removed since then.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><var>old-preinst</var> <samp>abort-upgrade</samp> <var>new-version</var></dt>
<dd>
<p>
Called during error handling of an upgrade that failed after unpacking the new
package because the <samp>postrm upgrade</samp> action failed. The unpacked
files may be partly from the new version or partly missing, so the script
cannot rely on files included in the package. Package dependencies may not be
available. Pre-dependencies will be at least "Unpacked" following
the same rules as above, except they may be only "Half-Installed" if
an upgrade of the pre-dependency failed.[<a href="#f46" name="fr46">46</a>]
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<p>
The <code>postinst</code> script may be called in the following ways:
</p>
<dl>
<dt><var>postinst</var> <samp>configure</samp> <var>most-recently-configured-version</var></dt>
<dd>
<p>
The files contained in the package will be unpacked. All package dependencies
will at least be "Unpacked". If there are no circular dependencies
involved, all package dependencies will be configured. For behavior in the
case of circular dependencies, see the discussion in <a
href="#s-binarydeps">Binary Dependencies - <samp>Depends</samp>,
<samp>Recommends</samp>, <samp>Suggests</samp>, <samp>Enhances</samp>,
<samp>Pre-Depends</samp>, Section 7.2</a>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><var>old-postinst</var> <samp>abort-upgrade</samp> <var>new-version</var></dt>
<dt><var>conflictor's-postinst</var> <samp>abort-remove</samp> <samp>in-favour</samp> <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var></dt>
<dt><var>postinst</var> <samp>abort-remove</samp></dt>
<dt><var>deconfigured's-postinst</var> <samp>abort-deconfigure</samp> <samp>in-favour</samp> <var>failed-install-package</var> <var>version</var> [<samp>removing</samp> <var>conflicting-package</var> <var>version</var>]</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The files contained in the package will be unpacked. All package dependencies
will at least be "Half-Installed" and will have previously been
configured and not removed. However, dependencies may not be configured or
even fully unpacked in some error situations.[<a href="#f47"
name="fr47">47</a>] The <code>postinst</code> should still attempt any actions
for which its dependencies are required, since they will normally be available,
but consider the correct error handling approach if those actions fail.
Aborting the <code>postinst</code> action if commands or facilities from the
package dependencies are not available is often the best approach.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<p>
The <code>prerm</code> script may be called in the following ways:
</p>
<dl>
<dt><var>prerm</var> <samp>remove</samp></dt>
<dt><var>old-prerm</var> <samp>upgrade</samp><var>new-version</var></dt>
<dt><var>conflictor's-prerm</var> <samp>remove</samp> <samp>in-favour</samp> <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var></dt>
<dt><var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> <samp>deconfigure</samp> <samp>in-favour</samp> <var>package-being-installed</var> <var>version</var> [<samp>removing</samp> <var>conflicting-package</var> <var>version</var>]</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The package whose <code>prerm</code> is being called will be at least
"Half-Installed". All package dependencies will at least be
"Half-Installed" and will have previously been configured and not
removed. If there was no error, all dependencies will at least be
"Unpacked", but these actions may be called in various error states
where dependencies are only "Half-Installed" due to a partial
upgrade.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><var>new-prerm</var> <samp>failed-upgrade</samp> <var>old-version</var></dt>
<dd>
<p>
Called during error handling when <samp>prerm upgrade</samp> fails. The new
package will not yet be unpacked, and all the same constraints as for
<samp>preinst upgrade</samp> apply.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<p>
The <code>postrm</code> script may be called in the following ways:
</p>
<dl>
<dt><var>postrm</var> <samp>remove</samp></dt>
<dt><var>postrm</var> <samp>purge</samp></dt>
<dt><var>old-postrm</var> <samp>upgrade</samp> <var>new-version</var></dt>
<dt><var>disappearer's-postrm</var> <samp>disappear</samp> <var>overwriter</var> <var>overwriter-version</var></dt>
<dd>
<p>
The <code>postrm</code> script is called after the package's files have been
removed or replaced. The package whose <code>postrm</code> is being called may
have previously been deconfigured and only be "Unpacked", at which
point subsequent package changes do not consider its dependencies. Therefore,
all <code>postrm</code> actions may only rely on essential packages and must
gracefully skip any actions that require the package's dependencies if those
dependencies are unavailable.[<a href="#f48" name="fr48">48</a>]
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><var>new-postrm</var> <samp>failed-upgrade</samp> <var>old-version</var></dt>
<dd>
<p>
Called when the old <samp>postrm upgrade</samp> action fails. The new package
will be unpacked, but only essential packages and pre-dependencies can be
relied on. Pre-dependencies will either be configured or will be
"Unpacked" or "Half-Configured" but previously had been
configured and was never removed.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><var>new-postrm</var> <samp>abort-install</samp></dt>
<dt><var>new-postrm</var> <samp>abort-install</samp> <var>old-version</var></dt>
<dt><var>new-postrm</var> <samp>abort-upgrade</samp> <var>old-version</var></dt>
<dd>
<p>
Called before unpacking the new package as part of the error handling of
<code>preinst</code> failures. May assume the same state as
<code>preinst</code> can assume.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-unpackphase">6.6 Details of unpack phase of installation or upgrade</h2>
<p>
The procedure on installation/upgrade/overwrite/disappear (i.e., when running
<samp>dpkg --unpack</samp>, or the unpack stage of <samp>dpkg --install</samp>)
is as follows. In each case, if a major error occurs (unless listed below) the
actions are, in general, run backwards - this means that the maintainer scripts
are run with different arguments in reverse order. These are the "error
unwind" calls listed below.
</p>
<ol type="1" start="1" >
<li>
<ol type="1" start="1" >
<li>
<p>
If a version of the package is already "Installed", call
</p>
<pre>
<var>old-prerm</var> upgrade <var>new-version</var>
</pre>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="2" >
<li>
<p>
If the script runs but exits with a non-zero exit status, <code>dpkg</code>
will attempt:
</p>
<pre>
<var>new-prerm</var> failed-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
</pre>
<p>
If this works, the upgrade continues. If this does not work, the error unwind:
</p>
<pre>
<var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
</pre>
<p>
If this works, then the old-version is "Installed", if not, the old
version is in a "Half-Configured" state.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="2" >
<li>
<p>
If a "conflicting" package is being removed at the same time, or if
any package will be broken (due to <samp>Breaks</samp>):
</p>
<ol type="1" start="1" >
<li>
<p>
If <samp>--auto-deconfigure</samp> is specified, call, for each package to be
deconfigured due to <samp>Breaks</samp>:
</p>
<pre>
<var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> deconfigure \
in-favour <var>package-being-installed</var> <var>version</var>
</pre>
<p>
Error unwind:
</p>
<pre>
<var>deconfigured's-postinst</var> abort-deconfigure \
in-favour <var>package-being-installed-but-failed</var> <var>version</var>
</pre>
<p>
The deconfigured packages are marked as requiring configuration, so that if
<samp>--install</samp> is used they will be configured again if possible.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="2" >
<li>
<p>
If any packages depended on a conflicting package being removed and
<samp>--auto-deconfigure</samp> is specified, call, for each such package:
</p>
<pre>
<var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> deconfigure \
in-favour <var>package-being-installed</var> <var>version</var> \
removing <var>conflicting-package</var> <var>version</var>
</pre>
<p>
Error unwind:
</p>
<pre>
<var>deconfigured's-postinst</var> abort-deconfigure \
in-favour <var>package-being-installed-but-failed</var> <var>version</var> \
removing <var>conflicting-package</var> <var>version</var>
</pre>
<p>
The deconfigured packages are marked as requiring configuration, so that if
<samp>--install</samp> is used they will be configured again if possible.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="3" >
<li>
<p>
To prepare for removal of each conflicting package, call:
</p>
<pre>
<var>conflictor's-prerm</var> remove \
in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
</pre>
<p>
Error unwind:
</p>
<pre>
<var>conflictor's-postinst</var> abort-remove \
in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
</pre>
</li>
</ol>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="3" >
<li>
<ol type="1" start="1" >
<li>
<p>
If the package is being upgraded, call:
</p>
<pre>
<var>new-preinst</var> upgrade <var>old-version</var>
</pre>
<p>
If this fails, we call:
</p>
<pre>
<var>new-postrm</var> abort-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
</pre>
<ol type="1" start="1" >
<li>
<p>
If that works, then
</p>
<pre>
<var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
</pre>
<p>
is called. If this works, then the old version is in an "Installed"
state, or else it is left in an "Unpacked" state.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="2" >
<li>
<p>
If it fails, then the old version is left in an "Half-Installed"
state.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="2" >
<li>
<p>
Otherwise, if the package had some configuration files from a previous version
installed (i.e., it is in the "Config-Files" state):
</p>
<pre>
<var>new-preinst</var> install <var>old-version</var>
</pre>
<p>
Error unwind:
</p>
<pre>
<var>new-postrm</var> abort-install <var>old-version</var>
</pre>
<p>
If this fails, the package is left in a "Half-Installed" state, which
requires a reinstall. If it works, the packages is left in a
"Config-Files" state.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="3" >
<li>
<p>
Otherwise (i.e., the package was completely purged):
</p>
<pre>
<var>new-preinst</var> install
</pre>
<p>
Error unwind:
</p>
<pre>
<var>new-postrm</var> abort-install
</pre>
<p>
If the error-unwind fails, the package is in a "Half-Installed"
phase, and requires a reinstall. If the error unwind works, the package is in
the "Not-Installed" state.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="4" >
<li>
<p>
The new package's files are unpacked, overwriting any that may be on the system
already, for example any from the old version of the same package or from
another package. Backups of the old files are kept temporarily, and if
anything goes wrong the package management system will attempt to put them back
as part of the error unwind.
</p>
<p>
It is an error for a package to contain files which are on the system in
another package, unless <samp>Replaces</samp> is used (see <a
href="#s-replaces">Overwriting files and replacing packages -
<samp>Replaces</samp>, Section 7.6</a>).
</p>
<p>
It is a more serious error for a package to contain a plain file or other kind
of non-directory where another package has a directory (again, unless
<samp>Replaces</samp> is used). This error can be overridden if desired using
<samp>--force-overwrite-dir</samp>, but this is not advisable.
</p>
<p>
Packages which overwrite each other's files produce behavior which, though
deterministic, is hard for the system administrator to understand. It can
easily lead to "missing" programs if, for example, a package is
unpacked which overwrites a file from another package, and is then removed
again.[<a href="#f49" name="fr49">49</a>]
</p>
<p>
A directory will never be replaced by a symbolic link to a directory or vice
versa; instead, the existing state (symlink or not) will be left alone and
<code>dpkg</code> will follow the symlink if there is one.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="5" >
<li>
<ol type="1" start="1" >
<li>
<p>
If the package is being upgraded, call
</p>
<pre>
<var>old-postrm</var> upgrade <var>new-version</var>
</pre>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="2" >
<li>
<p>
If this fails, <code>dpkg</code> will attempt:
</p>
<pre>
<var>new-postrm</var> failed-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
</pre>
<p>
If this works, installation continues. If not, Error unwind:
</p>
<pre>
<var>old-preinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
</pre>
<p>
If this fails, the old version is left in a "Half-Installed" state.
If it works, dpkg now calls:
</p>
<pre>
<var>new-postrm</var> abort-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
</pre>
<p>
If this fails, the old version is left in a "Half-Installed" state.
If it works, dpkg now calls:
</p>
<pre>
<var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
</pre>
<p>
If this fails, the old version is in an "Unpacked" state.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<p>
This is the point of no return - if <code>dpkg</code> gets this far, it won't
back off past this point if an error occurs. This will leave the package in a
fairly bad state, which will require a successful re-installation to clear up,
but it's when <code>dpkg</code> starts doing things that are irreversible.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="6" >
<li>
<p>
Any files which were in the old version of the package but not in the new are
removed.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="7" >
<li>
<p>
The new file list replaces the old.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="8" >
<li>
<p>
The new maintainer scripts replace the old.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="9" >
<li>
<p>
Any packages all of whose files have been overwritten during the installation,
and which aren't required for dependencies, are considered to have been
removed. For each such package
</p>
<ol type="1" start="1" >
<li>
<p>
<code>dpkg</code> calls:
</p>
<pre>
<var>disappearer's-postrm</var> disappear \
<var>overwriter</var> <var>overwriter-version</var>
</pre>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="2" >
<li>
<p>
The package's maintainer scripts are removed.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="3" >
<li>
<p>
It is noted in the status database as being in a sane state, namely
"Not-Installed" (any conffiles it may have are ignored, rather than
being removed by <code>dpkg</code>). Note that disappearing packages do not
have their prerm called, because <code>dpkg</code> doesn't know in advance that
the package is going to vanish.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="10" >
<li>
<p>
Any files in the package we're unpacking that are also listed in the file lists
of other packages are removed from those lists. (This will lobotomize the file
list of the "conflicting" package if there is one.)
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="11" >
<li>
<p>
The backup files made during installation, above, are deleted.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="12" >
<li>
<p>
The new package's status is now sane, and recorded as "Unpacked".
</p>
<p>
Here is another point of no return - if the conflicting package's removal fails
we do not unwind the rest of the installation; the conflicting package is left
in a half-removed limbo.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="13" >
<li>
<p>
If there was a conflicting package we go and do the removal actions (described
below), starting with the removal of the conflicting package's files (any that
are also in the package being unpacked have already been removed from the
conflicting package's file list, and so do not get removed now).
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-configdetails">6.7 Details of configuration</h2>
<p>
When we configure a package (this happens with <samp>dpkg --install</samp> and
<samp>dpkg --configure</samp>), we first update any <samp>conffile</samp>s and
then call:
</p>
<pre>
<var>postinst</var> configure <var>most-recently-configured-version</var>
</pre>
<p>
No attempt is made to unwind after errors during configuration. If the
configuration fails, the package is in a "Half-Configured" state, and
an error message is generated.
</p>
<p>
If there is no most recently configured version <code>dpkg</code> will pass a
null argument. [<a href="#f50" name="fr50">50</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-removedetails">6.8 Details of removal and/or configuration purging</h2>
<ol type="1" start="1" >
<li>
<pre>
<var>prerm</var> remove
</pre>
<p>
If prerm fails during replacement due to conflict
</p>
<pre>
<var>conflictor's-postinst</var> abort-remove \
in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
</pre>
<p>
Or else we call:
</p>
<pre>
<var>postinst</var> abort-remove
</pre>
<p>
If this fails, the package is in a "Half-Configured" state, or else
it remains "Installed".
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="2" >
<li>
<p>
The package's files are removed (except <samp>conffile</samp>s).
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="3" >
<li>
<pre>
<var>postrm</var> remove
</pre>
<p>
If it fails, there's no error unwind, and the package is in an
"Half-Installed" state.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="4" >
<li>
<p>
All the maintainer scripts except the <code>postrm</code> are removed.
</p>
<p>
If we aren't purging the package we stop here. Note that packages which have
no <code>postrm</code> and no <samp>conffile</samp>s are automatically purged
when removed, as there is no difference except for the <code>dpkg</code>
status.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="5" >
<li>
<p>
The <samp>conffile</samp>s and any backup files (<samp>~</samp>-files,
<samp>#*#</samp> files, <samp>%</samp>-files, <samp>.dpkg-{old,new,tmp}</samp>,
etc.) are removed.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="6" >
<li>
<pre>
<var>postrm</var> purge
</pre>
<p>
If this fails, the package remains in a "Config-Files" state.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="7" >
<li>
<p>
The package's file list is removed.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<p><a name="ch-relationships"></a></p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">1</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">2</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">3</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">4</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">5</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6</a> ]
[ 7 ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">9</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">10</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">11</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">12</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br>Chapter 7 - Declaring relationships between packages
</h1>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-depsyntax">7.1 Syntax of relationship fields</h2>
<p>
These fields all have a uniform syntax. They are a list of package names
separated by commas.
</p>
<p>
In the <samp>Depends</samp>, <samp>Recommends</samp>, <samp>Suggests</samp>,
<samp>Pre-Depends</samp>, <samp>Build-Depends</samp> and
<samp>Build-Depends-Indep</samp> control fields of the package, which declare
dependencies on other packages, the package names listed may also include lists
of alternative package names, separated by vertical bar (pipe) symbols
<samp>|</samp>. In such a case, that part of the dependency can be satisfied
by any one of the alternative packages.
</p>
<p>
All of the fields except for <samp>Provides</samp> may restrict their
applicability to particular versions of each named package. This is done in
parentheses after each individual package name; the parentheses should contain
a relation from the list below followed by a version number, in the format
described in <a href="#s-f-Version"><samp>Version</samp>, Section 5.6.12</a>.
</p>
<p>
The relations allowed are <samp><<</samp>, <samp><=</samp>,
<samp>=</samp>, <samp>>=</samp> and <samp>>></samp> for strictly
earlier, earlier or equal, exactly equal, later or equal and strictly later,
respectively. The deprecated forms <samp><</samp> and <samp>></samp>
were confusingly used to mean earlier/later or equal, rather than strictly
earlier/later, and must not appear in new packages (though <code>dpkg</code>
still supports them with a warning).
</p>
<p>
Whitespace may appear at any point in the version specification subject to the
rules in <a href="#s-controlsyntax">Syntax of control files, Section 5.1</a>,
and must appear where it's necessary to disambiguate; it is not otherwise
significant. All of the relationship fields can only be folded in source
package control files. For consistency and in case of future changes to
<code>dpkg</code> it is recommended that a single space be used after a version
relationship and before a version number; it is also conventional to put a
single space after each comma, on either side of each vertical bar, and before
each open parenthesis. When opening a continuation line in a relationship
field, it is conventional to do so after a comma and before the space following
that comma.
</p>
<p>
For example, a list of dependencies might appear as:
</p>
<pre>
Package: mutt
Version: 1.3.17-1
Depends: libc6 (>= 2.2.1), exim | mail-transport-agent
</pre>
<p>
Relationships may be restricted to a certain set of architectures. This is
indicated in brackets after each individual package name and the optional
version specification. The brackets enclose a non-empty list of Debian
architecture names in the format described in <a
href="#s-arch-spec">Architecture specification strings, Section 11.1</a>,
separated by whitespace. Exclamation marks may be prepended to each of the
names. (It is not permitted for some names to be prepended with exclamation
marks while others aren't.)
</p>
<p>
For build relationship fields (<samp>Build-Depends</samp>,
<samp>Build-Depends-Indep</samp>, <samp>Build-Conflicts</samp> and
<samp>Build-Conflicts-Indep</samp>), if the current Debian host architecture is
not in this list and there are no exclamation marks in the list, or it is in
the list with a prepended exclamation mark, the package name and the associated
version specification are ignored completely for the purposes of defining the
relationships.
</p>
<p>
For example:
</p>
<pre>
Source: glibc
Build-Depends-Indep: texinfo
Build-Depends: kernel-headers-2.2.10 [!hurd-i386],
hurd-dev [hurd-i386], gnumach-dev [hurd-i386]
</pre>
<p>
requires <samp>kernel-headers-2.2.10</samp> on all architectures other than
hurd-i386 and requires <samp>hurd-dev</samp> and <samp>gnumach-dev</samp> only
on hurd-i386.
</p>
<p>
For binary relationship fields and the <samp>Built-Using</samp> field, the
architecture restriction syntax is only supported in the source package control
file <code>debian/control</code>. When the corresponding binary package
control file is generated, the relationship will either be omitted or included
without the architecture restriction based on the architecture of the binary
package. This means that architecture restrictions must not be used in binary
relationship fields for architecture-independent packages (<samp>Architecture:
all</samp>).
</p>
<p>
For example:
</p>
<pre>
Depends: foo [i386], bar [amd64]
</pre>
<p>
becomes <samp>Depends: foo</samp> when the package is built on the
<samp>i386</samp> architecture, <samp>Depends: bar</samp> when the package is
built on the <samp>amd64</samp> architecture, and omitted entirely in binary
packages built on all other architectures.
</p>
<p>
If the architecture-restricted dependency is part of a set of alternatives
using <samp>|</samp>, that alternative is ignored completely on architectures
that do not match the restriction. For example:
</p>
<pre>
Build-Depends: foo [!i386] | bar [!amd64]
</pre>
<p>
is equivalent to <samp>bar</samp> on the i386 architecture, to <samp>foo</samp>
on the amd64 architecture, and to <samp>foo | bar</samp> on all other
architectures.
</p>
<p>
Relationships may also be restricted to a certain set of architectures using
architecture wildcards in the format described in <a
href="#s-arch-wildcard-spec">Architecture wildcards, Section 11.1.1</a>. The
syntax for declaring such restrictions is the same as declaring restrictions
using a certain set of architectures without architecture wildcards. For
example:
</p>
<pre>
Build-Depends: foo [linux-any], bar [any-i386], baz [!linux-any]
</pre>
<p>
is equivalent to <samp>foo</samp> on architectures using the Linux kernel and
any cpu, <samp>bar</samp> on architectures using any kernel and an i386 cpu,
and <samp>baz</samp> on any architecture using a kernel other than Linux.
</p>
<p>
Note that the binary package relationship fields such as <samp>Depends</samp>
appear in one of the binary package sections of the control file, whereas the
build-time relationships such as <samp>Build-Depends</samp> appear in the
source package section of the control file (which is the first section).
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-binarydeps">7.2 Binary Dependencies - <samp>Depends</samp>, <samp>Recommends</samp>, <samp>Suggests</samp>, <samp>Enhances</samp>, <samp>Pre-Depends</samp></h2>
<p>
Packages can declare in their control file that they have certain relationships
to other packages - for example, that they may not be installed at the same
time as certain other packages, and/or that they depend on the presence of
others.
</p>
<p>
This is done using the <samp>Depends</samp>, <samp>Pre-Depends</samp>,
<samp>Recommends</samp>, <samp>Suggests</samp>, <samp>Enhances</samp>,
<samp>Breaks</samp> and <samp>Conflicts</samp> control fields.
<samp>Breaks</samp> is described in <a href="#s-breaks">Packages which break
other packages - <samp>Breaks</samp>, Section 7.3</a>, and
<samp>Conflicts</samp> is described in <a href="#s-conflicts">Conflicting
binary packages - <samp>Conflicts</samp>, Section 7.4</a>. The rest are
described below.
</p>
<p>
These seven fields are used to declare a dependency relationship by one package
on another. Except for <samp>Enhances</samp> and <samp>Breaks</samp>, they
appear in the depending (binary) package's control file.
(<samp>Enhances</samp> appears in the recommending package's control file, and
<samp>Breaks</samp> appears in the version of depended-on package which causes
the named package to break).
</p>
<p>
A <samp>Depends</samp> field takes effect <em>only</em> when a package is to be
configured. It does not prevent a package being on the system in an
unconfigured state while its dependencies are unsatisfied, and it is possible
to replace a package whose dependencies are satisfied and which is properly
installed with a different version whose dependencies are not and cannot be
satisfied; when this is done the depending package will be left unconfigured
(since attempts to configure it will give errors) and will not function
properly. If it is necessary, a <samp>Pre-Depends</samp> field can be used,
which has a partial effect even when a package is being unpacked, as explained
in detail below. (The other three dependency fields, <samp>Recommends</samp>,
<samp>Suggests</samp> and <samp>Enhances</samp>, are only used by the various
front-ends to <code>dpkg</code> such as <code>apt-get</code>,
<code>aptitude</code>, and <code>dselect</code>.)
</p>
<p>
Since <samp>Depends</samp> only places requirements on the order in which
packages are configured, packages in an installation run are usually all
unpacked first and all configured later. [<a href="#f51" name="fr51">51</a>]
</p>
<p>
If there is a circular dependency among packages being installed or removed,
installation or removal order honoring the dependency order is impossible,
requiring the dependency loop be broken at some point and the dependency
requirements violated for at least one package. Packages involved in circular
dependencies may not be able to rely on their dependencies being configured
before they themselves are configured, depending on which side of the break of
the circular dependency loop they happen to be on. If one of the packages in
the loop has no <code>postinst</code> script, then the cycle will be broken at
that package; this ensures that all <code>postinst</code> scripts are run with
their dependencies properly configured if this is possible. Otherwise the
breaking point is arbitrary. Packages should therefore avoid circular
dependencies where possible, particularly if they have <code>postinst</code>
scripts.
</p>
<p>
The meaning of the five dependency fields is as follows:
</p>
<dl>
<dt><samp>Depends</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
This declares an absolute dependency. A package will not be configured unless
all of the packages listed in its <samp>Depends</samp> field have been
correctly configured (unless there is a circular dependency as described
above).
</p>
<p>
The <samp>Depends</samp> field should be used if the depended-on package is
required for the depending package to provide a significant amount of
functionality.
</p>
<p>
The <samp>Depends</samp> field should also be used if the <code>postinst</code>
or <code>prerm</code> scripts require the depended-on package to be unpacked or
configured in order to run. In the case of <samp>postinst configure</samp>,
the depended-on packages will be unpacked and configured first. (If both
packages are involved in a dependency loop, this might not work as expected;
see the explanation a few paragraphs back.) In the case of <code>prerm</code>
or other <code>postinst</code> actions, the package dependencies will normally
be at least unpacked, but they may be only "Half-Installed" if a
previous upgrade of the dependency failed.
</p>
<p>
Finally, the <samp>Depends</samp> field should be used if the depended-on
package is needed by the <code>postrm</code> script to fully clean up after the
package removal. There is no guarantee that package dependencies will be
available when <code>postrm</code> is run, but the depended-on package is more
likely to be available if the package declares a dependency (particularly in
the case of <samp>postrm remove</samp>). The <code>postrm</code> script must
gracefully skip actions that require a dependency if that dependency isn't
available.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>Recommends</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
This declares a strong, but not absolute, dependency.
</p>
<p>
The <samp>Recommends</samp> field should list packages that would be found
together with this one in all but unusual installations.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>Suggests</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
This is used to declare that one package may be more useful with one or more
others. Using this field tells the packaging system and the user that the
listed packages are related to this one and can perhaps enhance its usefulness,
but that installing this one without them is perfectly reasonable.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>Enhances</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
This field is similar to Suggests but works in the opposite direction. It is
used to declare that a package can enhance the functionality of another
package.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>Pre-Depends</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
This field is like <samp>Depends</samp>, except that it also forces
<code>dpkg</code> to complete installation of the packages named before even
starting the installation of the package which declares the pre-dependency, as
follows:
</p>
<p>
When a package declaring a pre-dependency is about to be <em>unpacked</em> the
pre-dependency can be satisfied if the depended-on package is either fully
configured, <em>or even if</em> the depended-on package(s) are only in the
"Unpacked" or the "Half-Configured" state, provided that
they have been configured correctly at some point in the past (and not removed
or partially removed since). In this case, both the previously-configured and
currently "Unpacked" or "Half-Configured" versions must
satisfy any version clause in the <samp>Pre-Depends</samp> field.
</p>
<p>
When the package declaring a pre-dependency is about to be <em>configured</em>,
the pre-dependency will be treated as a normal <samp>Depends</samp>. It will
be considered satisfied only if the depended-on package has been correctly
configured. However, unlike with <samp>Depends</samp>,
<samp>Pre-Depends</samp> does not permit circular dependencies to be broken.
If a circular dependency is encountered while attempting to honor
<samp>Pre-Depends</samp>, the installation will be aborted.
</p>
<p>
<samp>Pre-Depends</samp> are also required if the <code>preinst</code> script
depends on the named package. It is best to avoid this situation if possible.
</p>
<p>
<samp>Pre-Depends</samp> should be used sparingly, preferably only by packages
whose premature upgrade or installation would hamper the ability of the system
to continue with any upgrade that might be in progress.
</p>
<p>
You should not specify a <samp>Pre-Depends</samp> entry for a package before
this has been discussed on the <samp>debian-devel</samp> mailing list and a
consensus about doing that has been reached. See <a
href="#s-dependencies">Dependencies, Section 3.5</a>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<p>
When selecting which level of dependency to use you should consider how
important the depended-on package is to the functionality of the one declaring
the dependency. Some packages are composed of components of varying degrees of
importance. Such a package should list using <samp>Depends</samp> the
package(s) which are required by the more important components. The other
components' requirements may be mentioned as Suggestions or Recommendations, as
appropriate to the components' relative importance.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-breaks">7.3 Packages which break other packages - <samp>Breaks</samp></h2>
<p>
When one binary package declares that it breaks another, <code>dpkg</code> will
refuse to allow the package which declares <samp>Breaks</samp> to be unpacked
unless the broken package is deconfigured first, and it will refuse to allow
the broken package to be reconfigured.
</p>
<p>
A package will not be regarded as causing breakage merely because its
configuration files are still installed; it must be at least
"Half-Installed".
</p>
<p>
A special exception is made for packages which declare that they break their
own package name or a virtual package which they provide (see below): this does
not count as a real breakage.
</p>
<p>
Normally a <samp>Breaks</samp> entry will have an "earlier than"
version clause; such a <samp>Breaks</samp> is introduced in the version of an
(implicit or explicit) dependency which violates an assumption or reveals a bug
in earlier versions of the broken package, or which takes over a file from
earlier versions of the package named in <samp>Breaks</samp>. This use of
<samp>Breaks</samp> will inform higher-level package management tools that the
broken package must be upgraded before the new one.
</p>
<p>
If the breaking package also overwrites some files from the older package, it
should use <samp>Replaces</samp> to ensure this goes smoothly. See <a
href="#s-replaces">Overwriting files and replacing packages -
<samp>Replaces</samp>, Section 7.6</a> for a full discussion of taking over
files from other packages, including how to use <samp>Breaks</samp> in those
cases.
</p>
<p>
Many of the cases where <samp>Breaks</samp> should be used were previously
handled with <samp>Conflicts</samp> because <samp>Breaks</samp> did not yet
exist. Many <samp>Conflicts</samp> fields should now be <samp>Breaks</samp>.
See <a href="#s-conflicts">Conflicting binary packages -
<samp>Conflicts</samp>, Section 7.4</a> for more information about the
differences.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-conflicts">7.4 Conflicting binary packages - <samp>Conflicts</samp></h2>
<p>
When one binary package declares a conflict with another using a
<samp>Conflicts</samp> field, <code>dpkg</code> will refuse to allow them to be
unpacked on the system at the same time. This is a stronger restriction than
<samp>Breaks</samp>, which prevents the broken package from being configured
while the breaking package is in the "Unpacked" state but allows both
packages to be unpacked at the same time.
</p>
<p>
If one package is to be unpacked, the other must be removed first. If the
package being unpacked is marked as replacing (see <a
href="#s-replaces">Overwriting files and replacing packages -
<samp>Replaces</samp>, Section 7.6</a>, but note that <samp>Breaks</samp>
should normally be used in this case) the one on the system, or the one on the
system is marked as deselected, or both packages are marked
<samp>Essential</samp>, then <code>dpkg</code> will automatically remove the
package which is causing the conflict. Otherwise, it will halt the
installation of the new package with an error. This mechanism is specifically
designed to produce an error when the installed package is
<samp>Essential</samp>, but the new package is not.
</p>
<p>
A package will not cause a conflict merely because its configuration files are
still installed; it must be at least "Half-Installed".
</p>
<p>
A special exception is made for packages which declare a conflict with their
own package name, or with a virtual package which they provide (see below):
this does not prevent their installation, and allows a package to conflict with
others providing a replacement for it. You use this feature when you want the
package in question to be the only package providing some feature.
</p>
<p>
Normally, <samp>Breaks</samp> should be used instead of <samp>Conflicts</samp>
since <samp>Conflicts</samp> imposes a stronger restriction on the ordering of
package installation or upgrade and can make it more difficult for the package
manager to find a correct solution to an upgrade or installation problem.
<samp>Breaks</samp> should be used
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
when moving a file from one package to another (see <a
href="#s-replaces">Overwriting files and replacing packages -
<samp>Replaces</samp>, Section 7.6</a>),
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
when splitting a package (a special case of the previous one), or
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
when the breaking package exposes a bug in or interacts badly with particular
versions of the broken package.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
<samp>Conflicts</samp> should be used
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
when two packages provide the same file and will continue to do so,
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
in conjunction with <samp>Provides</samp> when only one package providing a
given virtual facility may be unpacked at a time (see <a
href="#s-virtual">Virtual packages - <samp>Provides</samp>, Section 7.5</a>),
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
in other cases where one must prevent simultaneous installation of two packages
for reasons that are ongoing (not fixed in a later version of one of the
packages) or that must prevent both packages from being unpacked at the same
time, not just configured.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
Be aware that adding <samp>Conflicts</samp> is normally not the best solution
when two packages provide the same files. Depending on the reason for that
conflict, using alternatives or renaming the files is often a better approach.
See, for example, <a href="#s-binaries">Binaries, Section 10.1</a>.
</p>
<p>
Neither <samp>Breaks</samp> nor <samp>Conflicts</samp> should be used unless
two packages cannot be installed at the same time or installing them both
causes one of them to be broken or unusable. Having similar functionality or
performing the same tasks as another package is not sufficient reason to
declare <samp>Breaks</samp> or <samp>Conflicts</samp> with that package.
</p>
<p>
A <samp>Conflicts</samp> entry may have an "earlier than" version
clause if the reason for the conflict is corrected in a later version of one of
the packages. However, normally the presence of an "earlier than"
version clause is a sign that <samp>Breaks</samp> should have been used
instead. An "earlier than" version clause in <samp>Conflicts</samp>
prevents <code>dpkg</code> from upgrading or installing the package which
declares such a conflict until the upgrade or removal of the conflicted-with
package has been completed, which is a strong restriction.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-virtual">7.5 Virtual packages - <samp>Provides</samp></h2>
<p>
As well as the names of actual ("concrete") packages, the package
relationship fields <samp>Depends</samp>, <samp>Recommends</samp>,
<samp>Suggests</samp>, <samp>Enhances</samp>, <samp>Pre-Depends</samp>,
<samp>Breaks</samp>, <samp>Conflicts</samp>, <samp>Build-Depends</samp>,
<samp>Build-Depends-Indep</samp>, <samp>Build-Conflicts</samp> and
<samp>Build-Conflicts-Indep</samp> may mention "virtual packages".
</p>
<p>
A <em>virtual package</em> is one which appears in the <samp>Provides</samp>
control field of another package. The effect is as if the package(s) which
provide a particular virtual package name had been listed by name everywhere
the virtual package name appears. (See also <a href="#s-virtual_pkg">Virtual
packages, Section 3.6</a>)
</p>
<p>
If there are both concrete and virtual packages of the same name, then the
dependency may be satisfied (or the conflict caused) by either the concrete
package with the name in question or any other concrete package which provides
the virtual package with the name in question. This is so that, for example,
supposing we have
</p>
<pre>
Package: foo
Depends: bar
</pre>
<p>
and someone else releases an enhanced version of the <samp>bar</samp> package
they can say:
</p>
<pre>
Package: bar-plus
Provides: bar
</pre>
<p>
and the <samp>bar-plus</samp> package will now also satisfy the dependency for
the <samp>foo</samp> package.
</p>
<p>
If a relationship field has a version number attached, only real packages will
be considered to see whether the relationship is satisfied (or the prohibition
violated, for a conflict or breakage). In other words, if a version number is
specified, this is a request to ignore all <samp>Provides</samp> for that
package name and consider only real packages. The package manager will assume
that a package providing that virtual package is not of the "right"
version. A <samp>Provides</samp> field may not contain version numbers, and
the version number of the concrete package which provides a particular virtual
package will not be considered when considering a dependency on or conflict
with the virtual package name.[<a href="#f52" name="fr52">52</a>]
</p>
<p>
To specify which of a set of real packages should be the default to satisfy a
particular dependency on a virtual package, list the real package as an
alternative before the virtual one.
</p>
<p>
If the virtual package represents a facility that can only be provided by one
real package at a time, such as the <code>mail-transport-agent</code> virtual
package that requires installation of a binary that would conflict with all
other providers of that virtual package (see <a
href="#s-mail-transport-agents">Mail transport, delivery and user agents,
Section 11.6</a>), all packages providing that virtual package should also
declare a conflict with it using <samp>Conflicts</samp>. This will ensure that
at most one provider of that virtual package is unpacked or installed at a
time.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-replaces">7.6 Overwriting files and replacing packages - <samp>Replaces</samp></h2>
<p>
Packages can declare in their control file that they should overwrite files in
certain other packages, or completely replace other packages. The
<samp>Replaces</samp> control field has these two distinct purposes.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s7.6.1">7.6.1 Overwriting files in other packages</h3>
<p>
It is usually an error for a package to contain files which are on the system
in another package. However, if the overwriting package declares that it
<samp>Replaces</samp> the one containing the file being overwritten, then
<code>dpkg</code> will replace the file from the old package with that from the
new. The file will no longer be listed as "owned" by the old package
and will be taken over by the new package. Normally, <samp>Breaks</samp>
should be used in conjunction with <samp>Replaces</samp>.[<a href="#f53"
name="fr53">53</a>]
</p>
<p>
For example, if a package <code>foo</code> is split into <code>foo</code> and
<code>foo-data</code> starting at version 1.2-3, <code>foo-data</code> would
have the fields
</p>
<pre>
Replaces: foo (<< 1.2-3)
Breaks: foo (<< 1.2-3)
</pre>
<p>
in its control file. The new version of the package <code>foo</code> would
normally have the field
</p>
<pre>
Depends: foo-data (>= 1.2-3)
</pre>
<p>
(or possibly <samp>Recommends</samp> or even <samp>Suggests</samp> if the files
moved into <code>foo-data</code> are not required for normal operation).
</p>
<p>
If a package is completely replaced in this way, so that <code>dpkg</code> does
not know of any files it still contains, it is considered to have
"disappeared". It will be marked as not wanted on the system
(selected for removal) and "Not-Installed". Any
<samp>conffile</samp>s details noted for the package will be ignored, as they
will have been taken over by the overwriting package. The package's
<code>postrm</code> script will be run with a special argument to allow the
package to do any final cleanup required. See <a
href="#s-mscriptsinstact">Summary of ways maintainer scripts are called,
Section 6.5</a>. [<a href="#f54" name="fr54">54</a>]
</p>
<p>
For this usage of <samp>Replaces</samp>, virtual packages (see <a
href="#s-virtual">Virtual packages - <samp>Provides</samp>, Section 7.5</a>)
are not considered when looking at a <samp>Replaces</samp> field. The packages
declared as being replaced must be mentioned by their real names.
</p>
<p>
This usage of <samp>Replaces</samp> only takes effect when both packages are at
least partially on the system at once. It is not relevant if the packages
conflict unless the conflict has been overridden.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s7.6.2">7.6.2 Replacing whole packages, forcing their removal</h3>
<p>
Second, <samp>Replaces</samp> allows the packaging system to resolve which
package should be removed when there is a conflict (see <a
href="#s-conflicts">Conflicting binary packages - <samp>Conflicts</samp>,
Section 7.4</a>). This usage only takes effect when the two packages
<em>do</em> conflict, so that the two usages of this field do not interfere
with each other.
</p>
<p>
In this situation, the package declared as being replaced can be a virtual
package, so for example, all mail transport agents (MTAs) would have the
following fields in their control files:
</p>
<pre>
Provides: mail-transport-agent
Conflicts: mail-transport-agent
Replaces: mail-transport-agent
</pre>
<p>
ensuring that only one MTA can be unpacked at any one time. See <a
href="#s-virtual">Virtual packages - <samp>Provides</samp>, Section 7.5</a> for
more information about this example.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-sourcebinarydeps">7.7 Relationships between source and binary packages - <samp>Build-Depends</samp>, <samp>Build-Depends-Indep</samp>, <samp>Build-Conflicts</samp>, <samp>Build-Conflicts-Indep</samp></h2>
<p>
Source packages that require certain binary packages to be installed or absent
at the time of building the package can declare relationships to those binary
packages.
</p>
<p>
This is done using the <samp>Build-Depends</samp>,
<samp>Build-Depends-Indep</samp>, <samp>Build-Conflicts</samp> and
<samp>Build-Conflicts-Indep</samp> control fields.
</p>
<p>
Build-dependencies on "build-essential" binary packages can be
omitted. Please see <a href="#s-pkg-relations">Package relationships, Section
4.2</a> for more information.
</p>
<p>
The dependencies and conflicts they define must be satisfied (as defined
earlier for binary packages) in order to invoke the targets in
<samp>debian/rules</samp>, as follows:[<a href="#f55" name="fr55">55</a>]
</p>
<dl>
<dt><samp>clean</samp>, <samp>build-arch</samp>, and <samp>binary-arch</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
Only the <samp>Build-Depends</samp> and <samp>Build-Conflicts</samp> fields
must be satisfied when these targets are invoked.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>build</samp>, <samp>build-indep</samp>, <samp>binary</samp>, and <samp>binary-indep</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
The <samp>Build-Depends</samp>, <samp>Build-Conflicts</samp>,
<samp>Build-Depends-Indep</samp>, and <samp>Build-Conflicts-Indep</samp> fields
must be satisfied when these targets are invoked.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-built-using">7.8 Additional source packages used to build the binary - <samp>Built-Using</samp></h2>
<p>
Some binary packages incorporate parts of other packages when built but do not
have to depend on those packages. Examples include linking with static
libraries or incorporating source code from another package during the build.
In this case, the source packages of those other packages are a required part
of the complete source (the binary package is not reproducible without them).
</p>
<p>
A <samp>Built-Using</samp> field must list the corresponding source package for
any such binary package incorporated during the build [<a href="#f56"
name="fr56">56</a>], including an "exactly equal" ("=")
version relation on the version that was used to build that binary package[<a
href="#f57" name="fr57">57</a>].
</p>
<p>
A package using the source code from the gcc-4.6-source binary package built
from the gcc-4.6 source package would have this field in its control file:
</p>
<pre>
Built-Using: gcc-4.6 (= 4.6.0-11)
</pre>
<p>
A package including binaries from grub2 and loadlin would have this field in
its control file:
</p>
<pre>
Built-Using: grub2 (= 1.99-9), loadlin (= 1.6e-1)
</pre>
<p><a name="ch-sharedlibs"></a></p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">1</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">2</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">3</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">4</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">5</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">7</a> ]
[ 8 ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">9</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">10</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">11</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">12</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br>Chapter 8 - Shared libraries
</h1>
<hr>
<p>
Packages containing shared libraries must be constructed with a little care to
make sure that the shared library is always available. This is especially
important for packages whose shared libraries are vitally important, such as
the C library (currently <samp>libc6</samp>).
</p>
<p>
This section deals only with public shared libraries: shared libraries that are
placed in directories searched by the dynamic linker by default or which are
intended to be linked against normally and possibly used by other, independent
packages. Shared libraries that are internal to a particular package or that
are only loaded as dynamic modules are not covered by this section and are not
subject to its requirements.
</p>
<p>
A shared library is identified by the <samp>SONAME</samp> attribute stored in
its dynamic section. When a binary is linked against a shared library, the
<samp>SONAME</samp> of the shared library is recorded in the binary's
<samp>NEEDED</samp> section so that the dynamic linker knows that library must
be loaded at runtime. The shared library file's full name (which usually
contains additional version information not needed in the <samp>SONAME</samp>)
is therefore normally not referenced directly. Instead, the shared library is
loaded by its <samp>SONAME</samp>, which exists on the file system as a symlink
pointing to the full name of the shared library. This symlink must be provided
by the package. <a href="#s-sharedlibs-runtime">Run-time shared libraries,
Section 8.1</a> describes how to do this. [<a href="#f58" name="fr58">58</a>]
</p>
<p>
When linking a binary or another shared library against a shared library, the
<samp>SONAME</samp> for that shared library is not yet known. Instead, the
shared library is found by looking for a file matching the library name with
<samp>.so</samp> appended. This file exists on the file system as a symlink
pointing to the shared library.
</p>
<p>
Shared libraries are normally split into several binary packages. The
<samp>SONAME</samp> symlink is installed by the runtime shared library package,
and the bare <samp>.so</samp> symlink is installed in the development package
since it's only used when linking binaries or shared libraries. However, there
are some exceptions for unusual shared libraries or for shared libraries that
are also loaded as dynamic modules by other programs.
</p>
<p>
This section is primarily concerned with how the separation of shared libraries
into multiple packages should be done and how dependencies on and between
shared library binary packages are managed in Debian. <a
href="#s-libraries">Libraries, Section 10.2</a> should be read in conjunction
with this section and contains additional rules for the files contained in the
shared library packages.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-sharedlibs-runtime">8.1 Run-time shared libraries</h2>
<p>
The run-time shared library must be placed in a package whose name changes
whenever the <samp>SONAME</samp> of the shared library changes. This allows
several versions of the shared library to be installed at the same time,
allowing installation of the new version of the shared library without
immediately breaking binaries that depend on the old version. Normally, the
run-time shared library and its <samp>SONAME</samp> symlink should be placed in
a package named <code><var>libraryname</var><var>soversion</var></code>, where
<var>soversion</var> is the version number in the <samp>SONAME</samp> of the
shared library. Alternatively, if it would be confusing to directly append
<var>soversion</var> to <var>libraryname</var> (if, for example,
<var>libraryname</var> itself ends in a number), you should use
<code><var>libraryname</var>-<var>soversion</var></code> instead.
</p>
<p>
To determine the <var>soversion</var>, look at the <samp>SONAME</samp> of the
library, stored in the ELF <samp>SONAME</samp> attribute. It is usually of the
form <samp><var>name</var>.so.<var>major-version</var></samp> (for example,
<samp>libz.so.1</samp>). The version part is the part which comes after
<samp>.so.</samp>, so in that example it is <samp>1</samp>. The soname may
instead be of the form
<samp><var>name</var>-<var>major-version</var>.so</samp>, such as
<samp>libdb-5.1.so</samp>, in which case the name would be <samp>libdb</samp>
and the version would be <samp>5.1</samp>.
</p>
<p>
If you have several shared libraries built from the same source tree, you may
lump them all together into a single shared library package provided that all
of their <samp>SONAME</samp>s will always change together. Be aware that this
is not normally the case, and if the <samp>SONAME</samp>s do not change
together, upgrading such a merged shared library package will be unnecessarily
difficult because of file conflicts with the old version of the package. When
in doubt, always split shared library packages so that each binary package
installs a single shared library.
</p>
<p>
Every time the shared library ABI changes in a way that may break binaries
linked against older versions of the shared library, the <samp>SONAME</samp> of
the library and the corresponding name for the binary package containing the
runtime shared library should change. Normally, this means the
<samp>SONAME</samp> should change any time an interface is removed from the
shared library or the signature of an interface (the number of parameters or
the types of parameters that it takes, for example) is changed. This practice
is vital to allowing clean upgrades from older versions of the package and
clean transitions between the old ABI and new ABI without having to upgrade
every affected package simultaneously.
</p>
<p>
The <samp>SONAME</samp> and binary package name need not, and indeed normally
should not, change if new interfaces are added but none are removed or changed,
since this will not break binaries linked against the old shared library.
Correct versioning of dependencies on the newer shared library by binaries that
use the new interfaces is handled via the <a
href="#s-sharedlibs-depends"><samp>symbols</samp> or <samp>shlibs</samp>
system</a>.
</p>
<p>
The package should install the shared libraries under their normal names. For
example, the <code>libgdbm3</code> package should install
<code>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</code> as <code>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so.3.0.0</code>. The
files should not be renamed or re-linked by any <code>prerm</code> or
<code>postrm</code> scripts; <code>dpkg</code> will take care of renaming
things safely without affecting running programs, and attempts to interfere
with this are likely to lead to problems.
</p>
<p>
Shared libraries should not be installed executable, since the dynamic linker
does not require this and trying to execute a shared library usually results in
a core dump.
</p>
<p>
The run-time library package should include the symbolic link for the
<samp>SONAME</samp> that <code>ldconfig</code> would create for the shared
libraries. For example, the <code>libgdbm3</code> package should include a
symbolic link from <code>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so.3</code> to
<code>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</code>. This is needed so that the dynamic linker (for
example <code>ld.so</code> or <code>ld-linux.so.*</code>) can find the library
between the time that <code>dpkg</code> installs it and the time that
<code>ldconfig</code> is run in the <code>postinst</code> script.[<a
href="#f59" name="fr59">59</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-ldconfig">8.1.1 <samp>ldconfig</samp></h3>
<p>
Any package installing shared libraries in one of the default library
directories of the dynamic linker (which are currently <code>/usr/lib</code>
and <code>/lib</code>) or a directory that is listed in
<code>/etc/ld.so.conf</code>[<a href="#f60" name="fr60">60</a>] must use
<code>ldconfig</code> to update the shared library system.
</p>
<p>
The package maintainer scripts must only call <code>ldconfig</code> under these
circumstances:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
When the <code>postinst</code> script is run with a first argument of
<samp>configure</samp>, the script must call <code>ldconfig</code>, and may
optionally invoke <code>ldconfig</code> at other times.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
When the <code>postrm</code> script is run with a first argument of
<samp>remove</samp>, the script should call <code>ldconfig</code>.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
[<a href="#f61" name="fr61">61</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-sharedlibs-support-files">8.2 Shared library support files</h2>
<p>
If your package contains files whose names do not change with each change in
the library shared object version, you must not put them in the shared library
package. Otherwise, several versions of the shared library cannot be installed
at the same time without filename clashes, making upgrades and transitions
unnecessarily difficult.
</p>
<p>
It is recommended that supporting files and run-time support programs that do
not need to be invoked manually by users, but are nevertheless required for the
package to function, be placed (if they are binary) in a subdirectory of
<code>/usr/lib</code>, preferably under
<code>/usr/lib/</code><var>package-name</var>. If the program or file is
architecture independent, the recommendation is for it to be placed in a
subdirectory of <code>/usr/share</code> instead, preferably under
<code>/usr/share/</code><var>package-name</var>. Following the
<var>package-name</var> naming convention ensures that the file names change
when the shared object version changes.
</p>
<p>
Run-time support programs that use the shared library but are not required for
the library to function or files used by the shared library that can be used by
any version of the shared library package should instead be put in a separate
package. This package might typically be named
<code><var>libraryname</var>-tools</code>; note the absence of the
<var>soversion</var> in the package name.
</p>
<p>
Files and support programs only useful when compiling software against the
library should be included in the development package for the library.[<a
href="#f62" name="fr62">62</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-sharedlibs-static">8.3 Static libraries</h2>
<p>
The static library (<code><var>libraryname.a</var></code>) is usually provided
in addition to the shared version. It is placed into the development package
(see below).
</p>
<p>
In some cases, it is acceptable for a library to be available in static form
only; these cases include:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
libraries for languages whose shared library support is immature or unstable
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
libraries whose interfaces are in flux or under development (commonly the case
when the library's major version number is zero, or where the ABI breaks across
patchlevels)
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
libraries which are explicitly intended to be available only in static form by
their upstream author(s)
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-sharedlibs-dev">8.4 Development files</h2>
<p>
If there are development files associated with a shared library, the source
package needs to generate a binary development package named
<code><var>libraryname</var><var>soversion</var>-dev</code>, or if you prefer
only to support one development version at a time,
<code><var>libraryname</var>-dev</code>. Installing the development package
must result in installation of all the development files necessary for
compiling programs against that shared library.[<a href="#f63"
name="fr63">63</a>]
</p>
<p>
In case several development versions of a library exist, you may need to use
<code>dpkg</code>'s Conflicts mechanism (see <a href="#s-conflicts">Conflicting
binary packages - <samp>Conflicts</samp>, Section 7.4</a>) to ensure that the
user only installs one development version at a time (as different development
versions are likely to have the same header files in them, which would cause a
filename clash if both were unpacked).
</p>
<p>
The development package should contain a symlink for the associated shared
library without a version number. For example, the <code>libgdbm-dev</code>
package should include a symlink from <code>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so</code> to
<code>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</code>. This symlink is needed by the linker
(<code>ld</code>) when compiling packages, as it will only look for
<code>libgdbm.so</code> when compiling dynamically.
</p>
<p>
If the package provides Ada Library Information (<code>*.ali</code>) files for
use with GNAT, these files must be installed read-only (mode 0444) so that GNAT
will not attempt to recompile them. This overrides the normal file mode
requirements given in <a href="#s-permissions-owners">Permissions and owners,
Section 10.9</a>.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-sharedlibs-intradeps">8.5 Dependencies between the packages of the same library</h2>
<p>
Typically the development version should have an exact version dependency on
the runtime library, to make sure that compilation and linking happens
correctly. The <samp>${binary:Version}</samp> substitution variable can be
useful for this purpose. [<a href="#f64" name="fr64">64</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-sharedlibs-depends">8.6 Dependencies between the library and other packages</h2>
<p>
If a package contains a binary or library which links to a shared library, we
must ensure that, when the package is installed on the system, all of the
libraries needed are also installed. These dependencies must be added to the
binary package when it is built, since they may change based on which version
of a shared library the binary or library was linked with even if there are no
changes to the source of the binary (for example, symbol versions change,
macros become functions or vice versa, or the binary package may determine at
compile-time whether new library interfaces are available and can be called).
To allow these dependencies to be constructed, shared libraries must provide
either a <code>symbols</code> file or a <code>shlibs</code> file. These
provide information on the package dependencies required to ensure the presence
of interfaces provided by this library. Any package with binaries or libraries
linking to a shared library must use these files to determine the required
dependencies when it is built. Other packages which use a shared library (for
example using <samp>dlopen()</samp>) should compute appropriate dependencies
using these files at build time as well.
</p>
<p>
The two mechanisms differ in the degree of detail that they provide. A
<code>symbols</code> file documents, for each symbol exported by a library, the
minimal version of the package any binary using this symbol will need. This is
typically the version of the package in which the symbol was introduced. This
information permits detailed analysis of the symbols used by a particular
package and construction of an accurate dependency, but it requires the package
maintainer to track more information about the shared library.
</p>
<p>
A <code>shlibs</code> file, in contrast, only documents the last time the
library ABI changed in any way. It only provides information about the library
as a whole, not individual symbols. When a package is built using a shared
library with only a <code>shlibs</code> file, the generated dependency will
require a version of the shared library equal to or newer than the version of
the last ABI change. This generates unnecessarily restrictive dependencies
compared to <code>symbols</code> files if none of the symbols used by the
package have changed. This, in turn, may make upgrades needlessly complex and
unnecessarily restrict use of the package on systems with older versions of the
shared libraries.
</p>
<p>
<code>shlibs</code> files also only support a limited range of library SONAMEs,
making it difficult to use <code>shlibs</code> files in some unusual corner
cases.[<a href="#f65" name="fr65">65</a>]
</p>
<p>
<code>symbols</code> files are therefore recommended for most shared library
packages since they provide more accurate dependencies. For most C libraries,
the additional detail required by <code>symbols</code> files is not too
difficult to maintain. However, maintaining exhaustive symbols information for
a C++ library can be quite onerous, so <code>shlibs</code> files may be more
appropriate for most C++ libraries. Libraries with a corresponding udeb must
also provide a <code>shlibs</code> file, since the udeb infrastructure does not
use <code>symbols</code> files.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-dpkg-shlibdeps">8.6.1 Generating dependencies on shared libraries</h3>
<p>
When a package that contains any shared libraries or compiled binaries is
built, it must run <code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> on each shared library and
compiled binary to determine the libraries used and hence the dependencies
needed by the package.[<a href="#f66" name="fr66">66</a>] To do this, put a
call to <code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> into your <code>debian/rules</code> file in
the source package. List all of the compiled binaries, libraries, or loadable
modules in your package.[<a href="#f67" name="fr67">67</a>]
<code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> will use the <code>symbols</code> or
<code>shlibs</code> files installed by the shared libraries to generate
dependency information. The package must then provide a substitution variable
into which the discovered dependency information can be placed.
</p>
<p>
If you are creating a udeb for use in the Debian Installer, you will need to
specify that <code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> should use the dependency line of type
<samp>udeb</samp> by adding the <samp>-tudeb</samp> option[<a href="#f68"
name="fr68">68</a>]. If there is no dependency line of type <samp>udeb</samp>
in the <code>shlibs</code> file, <code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> will fall back to
the regular dependency line.
</p>
<p>
<code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> puts the dependency information into the
<code>debian/substvars</code> file by default, which is then used by
<code>dpkg-gencontrol</code>. You will need to place a
<samp>${shlibs:Depends}</samp> variable in the <samp>Depends</samp> field in
the control file of every binary package built by this source package that
contains compiled binaries, libraries, or loadable modules. If you have
multiple binary packages, you will need to call <code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> on
each one which contains compiled libraries or binaries. For example, you could
use the <samp>-T</samp> option to the <samp>dpkg</samp> utilities to specify a
different <code>substvars</code> file for each binary package.[<a href="#f69"
name="fr69">69</a>]
</p>
<p>
For more details on <code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code>, see
<code>dpkg-shlibdeps(1)</code>.
</p>
<p>
We say that a binary <samp>foo</samp> <em>directly</em> uses a library
<samp>libbar</samp> if it is explicitly linked with that library (that is, the
library is listed in the ELF <samp>NEEDED</samp> attribute, caused by adding
<samp>-lbar</samp> to the link line when the binary is created). Other
libraries that are needed by <samp>libbar</samp> are linked <em>indirectly</em>
to <samp>foo</samp>, and the dynamic linker will load them automatically when
it loads <samp>libbar</samp>. A package should depend on the libraries it
directly uses, but not the libraries it only uses indirectly. The dependencies
for the libraries used directly will automatically pull in the indirectly-used
libraries. <code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> will handle this logic automatically,
but package maintainers need to be aware of this distinction between directly
and indirectly using a library if they have to override its results for some
reason. [<a href="#f70" name="fr70">70</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-sharedlibs-updates">8.6.2 Shared library ABI changes</h3>
<p>
Maintaining a shared library package using either <code>symbols</code> or
<code>shlibs</code> files requires being aware of the exposed ABI of the shared
library and any changes to it. Both <code>symbols</code> and
<code>shlibs</code> files record every change to the ABI of the shared library;
<code>symbols</code> files do so per public symbol, whereas <code>shlibs</code>
files record only the last change for the entire library.
</p>
<p>
There are two types of ABI changes: ones that are backward-compatible and ones
that are not. An ABI change is backward-compatible if any reasonable program
or library that was linked with the previous version of the shared library will
still work correctly with the new version of the shared library.[<a href="#f71"
name="fr71">71</a>] Adding new symbols to the shared library is a
backward-compatible change. Removing symbols from the shared library is not.
Changing the behavior of a symbol may or may not be backward-compatible
depending on the change; for example, changing a function to accept a new enum
constant not previously used by the library is generally backward-compatible,
but changing the members of a struct that is passed into library functions is
generally not unless the library takes special precautions to accept old
versions of the data structure.
</p>
<p>
ABI changes that are not backward-compatible normally require changing the
<samp>SONAME</samp> of the library and therefore the shared library package
name, which forces rebuilding all packages using that shared library to update
their dependencies and allow them to use the new version of the shared library.
For more information, see <a href="#s-sharedlibs-runtime">Run-time shared
libraries, Section 8.1</a>. The remainder of this section will deal with
backward-compatible changes.
</p>
<p>
Backward-compatible changes require either updating or recording the
<var>minimal-version</var> for that symbol in <code>symbols</code> files or
updating the version in the <var>dependencies</var> in <code>shlibs</code>
files. For more information on how to do this in the two formats, see <a
href="#s-symbols">The <code>symbols</code> File Format, Section 8.6.3.2</a> and
<a href="#s-shlibs">The <code>shlibs</code> File Format, Section 8.6.4.2</a>.
Below are general rules that apply to both files.
</p>
<p>
The easy case is when a public symbol is added. Simply add the version at
which the symbol was introduced (for <code>symbols</code> files) or update the
dependency version (for <code>shlibs</code>) files. But special care should be
taken to update dependency versions when the behavior of a public symbol
changes. This is easy to neglect, since there is no automated method of
determining such changes, but failing to update versions in this case may
result in binary packages with too-weak dependencies that will fail at runtime,
possibly in ways that can cause security vulnerabilities. If the package
maintainer believes that a symbol behavior change may have occurred but isn't
sure, it's safer to update the version rather than leave it unmodified. This
may result in unnecessarily strict dependencies, but it ensures that packages
whose dependencies are satisfied will work properly.
</p>
<p>
A common example of when a change to the dependency version is required is a
function that takes an enum or struct argument that controls what the function
does. For example:
</p>
<pre>
enum library_op { OP_FOO, OP_BAR };
int library_do_operation(enum library_op);
</pre>
<p>
If a new operation, <samp>OP_BAZ</samp>, is added, the
<var>minimal-version</var> of <samp>library_do_operation</samp> (for
<code>symbols</code> files) or the version in the dependency for the shared
library (for <code>shlibs</code> files) must be increased to the version at
which <samp>OP_BAZ</samp> was introduced. Otherwise, a binary built against
the new version of the library (having detected at compile-time that the
library supports <samp>OP_BAZ</samp>) may be installed with a shared library
that doesn't support <samp>OP_BAZ</samp> and will fail at runtime when it tries
to pass <samp>OP_BAZ</samp> into this function.
</p>
<p>
Dependency versions in either <code>symbols</code> or <code>shlibs</code> files
normally should not contain the Debian revision of the package, since the
library behavior is normally fixed for a particular upstream version and any
Debian packaging of that upstream version will have the same behavior. In the
rare case that the library behavior was changed in a particular Debian
revision, appending <samp>~</samp> to the end of the version that includes the
Debian revision is recommended, since this allows backports of the shared
library package using the normal backport versioning convention to satisfy the
dependency.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-sharedlibs-symbols">8.6.3 The <samp>symbols</samp> system</h3>
<p>
In the following sections, we will first describe where the various
<code>symbols</code> files are to be found, then the <code>symbols</code> file
format, and finally how to create <code>symbols</code> files if your package
contains a shared library.
</p>
<hr>
<h4 id="s-symbols-paths">8.6.3.1 The <code>symbols</code> files present on the system</h4>
<p>
<code>symbols</code> files for a shared library are normally provided by the
shared library package as a control file, but there are several override paths
that are checked first in case that information is wrong or missing. The
following list gives them in the order in which they are read by
<code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> The first one that contains the required
information is used.
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<code>debian/*/DEBIAN/symbols</code>
</p>
<p>
During the package build, if the package itself contains shared libraries with
<code>symbols</code> files, they will be generated in these staging directories
by <code>dpkg-gensymbols</code> (see <a href="#s-providing-symbols">Providing a
<code>symbols</code> file, Section 8.6.3.3</a>). <code>symbols</code> files
found in the build tree take precedence over <code>symbols</code> files from
other binary packages.
</p>
<p>
These files must exist before <code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> is run or the
dependencies of binaries and libraries from a source package on other libraries
from that same source package will not be correct. In practice, this means
that <code>dpkg-gensymbols</code> must be run before
<code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> during the package build.[<a href="#f72"
name="fr72">72</a>]
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<code>/etc/dpkg/symbols/<var>package</var>.symbols.<var>arch</var></code> and
<code>/etc/dpkg/symbols/<var>package</var>.symbols</code>
</p>
<p>
Per-system overrides of shared library dependencies. These files normally do
not exist. They are maintained by the local system administrator and must not
be created by any Debian package.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<code>symbols</code> control files for packages installed on the system
</p>
<p>
The <code>symbols</code> control files for all the packages currently installed
on the system are searched last. This will be the most common source of shared
library dependency information. These are normally found in
<code>/var/lib/dpkg/info/*.symbols</code>, but packages should not rely on this
and instead should use <samp>dpkg-query --control-path <var>package</var>
symbols</samp> if for some reason these files need to be examined.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
Be aware that if a <code>debian/shlibs.local</code> exists in the source
package, it will override any <code>symbols</code> files. This is the only
case where a <code>shlibs</code> is used despite <code>symbols</code> files
being present. See <a href="#s-shlibs-paths">The <code>shlibs</code> files
present on the system, Section 8.6.4.1</a> and <a
href="#s-sharedlibs-shlibdeps">The <samp>shlibs</samp> system, Section
8.6.4</a> for more information.
</p>
<hr>
<h4 id="s-symbols">8.6.3.2 The <code>symbols</code> File Format</h4>
<p>
The following documents the format of the <code>symbols</code> control file as
included in binary packages. These files are built from template
<code>symbols</code> files in the source package by
<code>dpkg-gensymbols</code>. The template files support a richer syntax that
allows <code>dpkg-gensymbols</code> to do some of the tedious work involved in
maintaining <code>symbols</code> files, such as handling C++ symbols or
optional symbols that may not exist on particular architectures. When writing
<code>symbols</code> files for a shared library package, refer to
<code>dpkg-gensymbols(1)</code> for the richer syntax.
</p>
<p>
A <code>symbols</code> may contain one or more entries, one for each shared
library contained in the package corresponding to that <code>symbols</code>.
Each entry has the following format:
</p>
<pre>
<var>library-soname</var> <var>main-dependency-template</var>
[| <var>alternative-dependency-template</var>]
[...]
[* <var>field-name</var>: <var>field-value</var>]
[...]
<var>symbol</var> <var>minimal-version</var>[ <var>id-of-dependency-template</var> ]
</pre>
<p>
To explain this format, we'll use the the <samp>zlib1g</samp> package as an
example, which (at the time of writing) installs the shared library
<code>/usr/lib/libz.so.1.2.3.4</code>. Mandatory lines will be described
first, followed by optional lines.
</p>
<p>
<var>library-soname</var> must contain exactly the value of the ELF
<samp>SONAME</samp> attribute of the shared library. In our example, this is
<samp>libz.so.1</samp>.[<a href="#f73" name="fr73">73</a>]
</p>
<p>
<var>main-dependency-template</var> has the same syntax as a dependency field
in a binary package control file, except that the string <samp>#MINVER#</samp>
is replaced by a version restriction like <samp>(>=
<var>version</var>)</samp> or by nothing if an unversioned dependency is deemed
sufficient. The version restriction will be based on which symbols from the
shared library are referenced and the version at which they were introduced
(see below). In nearly all cases, <var>main-dependency-template</var> will be
<samp><var>package</var> #MINVER#</samp>, where <var>package</var> is the name
of the binary package containing the shared library. This adds a simple,
possibly-versioned dependency on the shared library package. In some rare
cases, such as when multiple packages provide the same shared library ABI, the
dependency template may need to be more complex.
</p>
<p>
In our example, the first line of the <samp>zlib1g</samp> <code>symbols</code>
file would be:
</p>
<pre>
libz.so.1 zlib1g #MINVER#
</pre>
<p>
Each public symbol exported by the shared library must have a corresponding
symbol line, indented by one space. <var>symbol</var> is the exported symbol
(which, for C++, means the mangled symbol) followed by <samp>@</samp> and the
symbol version, or the string <samp>Base</samp> if there is no symbol version.
<var>minimal-version</var> is the most recent version of the shared library
that changed the behavior of that symbol, whether by adding it, changing its
function signature (the parameters, their types, or the return type), or
changing its behavior in a way that is visible to a caller.
<var>id-of-dependency-template</var> is an optional field that references an
<var>alternative-dependency-template</var>; see below for a full description.
</p>
<p>
For example, <samp>libz.so.1</samp> contains the symbols <samp>compress</samp>
and <samp>compressBound</samp>. <samp>compress</samp> has no symbol version
and last changed its behavior in upstream version <samp>1:1.1.4</samp>.
<samp>compressBound</samp> has the symbol version <samp>ZLIB_1.2.0</samp>, was
introduced in upstream version <samp>1:1.2.0</samp>, and has not changed its
behavior. Its <code>symbols</code> file therefore contains the lines:
</p>
<pre>
compress@Base 1:1.1.4
compressBound@ZLIB_1.2.0 1:1.2.0
</pre>
<p>
Packages using only <samp>compress</samp> would then get a dependency on
<samp>zlib1g (>= 1:1.1.4)</samp>, but packages using
<samp>compressBound</samp> would get a dependency on <samp>zlib1g (>=
1:1.2.0)</samp>.
</p>
<p>
One or more <var>alternative-dependency-template</var> lines may be provided.
These are used in cases where some symbols in the shared library should use one
dependency template while others should use a different template. The
alternative dependency templates are used only if a symbol line contains the
<var>id-of-dependency-template</var> field. The first alternative dependency
template is numbered 1, the second 2, and so forth.[<a href="#f74"
name="fr74">74</a>]
</p>
<p>
Finally, the entry for the library may contain one or more metadata fields.
Currently, the only supported <var>field-name</var> is
<samp>Build-Depends-Package</samp>, whose value lists the <a
href="#s-sharedlibs-dev">library development package</a> on which packages
using this shared library declare a build dependency. If this field is
present, <code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> uses it to ensure that the resulting
binary package dependency on the shared library is at least as strict as the
source package dependency on the shared library development package.[<a
href="#f75" name="fr75">75</a>] For our example, the <samp>zlib1g</samp>
<code>symbols</code> file would contain:
</p>
<pre>
* Build-Depends-Package: zlib1g-dev
</pre>
<p>
Also see <code>deb-symbols(5)</code>.
</p>
<hr>
<h4 id="s-providing-symbols">8.6.3.3 Providing a <code>symbols</code> file</h4>
<p>
If your package provides a shared library, you should arrange to include a
<code>symbols</code> control file following the format described above in that
package. You must include either a <code>symbols</code> control file or a
<code>shlibs</code> control file.
</p>
<p>
Normally, this is done by creating a <code>symbols</code> in the source package
named <code>debian/<var>package</var>.symbols</code> or
<code>debian/symbols</code>, possibly with <code>.<var>arch</var></code>
appended if the symbols information varies by architecture. This file may use
the extended syntax documented in <code>dpkg-gensymbols(1)</code>. Then, call
<code>dpkg-gensymbols</code> as part of the package build process. It will
create <code>symbols</code> files in the package staging area based on the
binaries and libraries in the package staging area and the <code>symbols</code>
files in the source package.[<a href="#f76" name="fr76">76</a>]
</p>
<p>
Packages that provide <code>symbols</code> files must keep them up-to-date to
ensure correct dependencies in packages that use the shared libraries. This
means updating the <code>symbols</code> file whenever a new public symbol is
added, changing the <var>minimal-version</var> field whenever a symbol changes
behavior or signature in a backward-compatible way (see <a
href="#s-sharedlibs-updates">Shared library ABI changes, Section 8.6.2</a>),
and changing the <var>library-soname</var> and
<var>main-dependency-template</var>, and probably all of the
<var>minimal-version</var> fields, when the library changes
<samp>SONAME</samp>. Removing a public symbol from the <code>symbols</code>
file because it's no longer provided by the library normally requires changing
the <samp>SONAME</samp> of the library. See <a
href="#s-sharedlibs-runtime">Run-time shared libraries, Section 8.1</a> for
more information on <samp>SONAME</samp>s.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-sharedlibs-shlibdeps">8.6.4 The <samp>shlibs</samp> system</h3>
<p>
The <samp>shlibs</samp> system is a simpler alternative to the
<samp>symbols</samp> system for declaring dependencies for shared libraries.
It may be more appropriate for C++ libraries and other cases where tracking
individual symbols is too difficult. It predated the <samp>symbols</samp>
system and is therefore frequently seen in older packages. It is also required
for udebs, which do not support <samp>symbols</samp>.
</p>
<p>
In the following sections, we will first describe where the various
<code>shlibs</code> files are to be found, then how to use
<code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code>, and finally the <code>shlibs</code> file format
and how to create them.
</p>
<hr>
<h4 id="s-shlibs-paths">8.6.4.1 The <code>shlibs</code> files present on the system</h4>
<p>
There are several places where <samp>shlibs</samp> files are found. The
following list gives them in the order in which they are read by
<code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code>. (The first one which gives the required
information is used.)
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<code>debian/shlibs.local</code>
</p>
<p>
This lists overrides for this package. This file should normally not be used,
but may be needed temporarily in unusual situations to work around bugs in
other packages, or in unusual cases where the normally declared dependency
information in the installed <code>shlibs</code> file for a library cannot be
used. This file overrides information obtained from any other source.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<code>/etc/dpkg/shlibs.override</code>
</p>
<p>
This lists global overrides. This list is normally empty. It is maintained by
the local system administrator.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<code>DEBIAN/shlibs</code> files in the "build directory"
</p>
<p>
These files are generated as part of the package build process and staged for
inclusion as control files in the binary packages being built. They provide
details of any shared libraries included in the same package.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<code>shlibs</code> control files for packages installed on the system
</p>
<p>
The <code>shlibs</code> control files for all the packages currently installed
on the system. These are normally found in
<code>/var/lib/dpkg/info/*.shlibs</code>, but packages should not rely on this
and instead should use <samp>dpkg-query --control-path <var>package</var>
shlibs</samp> if for some reason these files need to be examined.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<code>/etc/dpkg/shlibs.default</code>
</p>
<p>
This file lists any shared libraries whose packages have failed to provide
correct <code>shlibs</code> files. It was used when the <code>shlibs</code>
setup was first introduced, but it is now normally empty. It is maintained by
the <samp>dpkg</samp> maintainer.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
If a <code>symbols</code> file for a shared library package is available,
<code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> will always use it in preference to a
<code>shlibs</code>, with the exception of <code>debian/shlibs.local</code>.
The latter overrides any other <code>shlibs</code> or <code>symbols</code>
files.
</p>
<hr>
<h4 id="s-shlibs">8.6.4.2 The <code>shlibs</code> File Format</h4>
<p>
Each <code>shlibs</code> file has the same format. Lines beginning with
<samp>#</samp> are considered to be comments and are ignored. Each line is of
the form:
</p>
<pre>
[<var>type</var>: ]<var>library-name</var> <var>soname-version</var> <var>dependencies ...</var>
</pre>
<p>
We will explain this by reference to the example of the <samp>zlib1g</samp>
package, which (at the time of writing) installs the shared library
<code>/usr/lib/libz.so.1.2.3.4</code>.
</p>
<p>
<var>type</var> is an optional element that indicates the type of package for
which the line is valid. The only type currently in use is <samp>udeb</samp>.
The colon and space after the type are required.
</p>
<p>
<var>library-name</var> is the name of the shared library, in this case
<samp>libz</samp>. (This must match the name part of the soname, see below.)
</p>
<p>
<var>soname-version</var> is the version part of the ELF <samp>SONAME</samp>
attribute of the library, determined the same way that the <var>soversion</var>
component of the recommended shared library package name is determined. See <a
href="#s-sharedlibs-runtime">Run-time shared libraries, Section 8.1</a> for the
details.
</p>
<p>
<var>dependencies</var> has the same syntax as a dependency field in a binary
package control file. It should give details of which packages are required to
satisfy a binary built against the version of the library contained in the
package. See <a href="#s-depsyntax">Syntax of relationship fields, Section
7.1</a> for details on the syntax, and <a href="#s-sharedlibs-updates">Shared
library ABI changes, Section 8.6.2</a> for details on how to maintain the
dependency version constraint.
</p>
<p>
In our example, if the last change to the <samp>zlib1g</samp> package that
could change behavior for a client of that library was in version
<samp>1:1.2.3.3.dfsg-1</samp>, then the <samp>shlibs</samp> entry for this
library could say:
</p>
<pre>
libz 1 zlib1g (>= 1:1.2.3.3.dfsg)
</pre>
<p>
This version restriction must be new enough that any binary built against the
current version of the library will work with any version of the shared library
that satisfies that dependency.
</p>
<p>
As zlib1g also provides a udeb containing the shared library, there would also
be a second line:
</p>
<pre>
udeb: libz 1 zlib1g-udeb (>= 1:1.2.3.3.dfsg)
</pre>
<hr>
<h4 id="s8.6.4.3">8.6.4.3 Providing a <code>shlibs</code> file</h4>
<p>
To provide a <code>shlibs</code> file for a shared library binary package,
create a <code>shlibs</code> file following the format described above and
place it in the <code>DEBIAN</code> directory for that package during the
build. It will then be included as a control file for that package[<a
href="#f77" name="fr77">77</a>].
</p>
<p>
Since <code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> reads the <code>DEBIAN/shlibs</code> files in
all of the binary packages being built from this source package, all of the
<code>DEBIAN/shlibs</code> files should be installed before
<code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> is called on any of the binary packages.
</p>
<p><a name="ch-opersys"></a></p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">1</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">2</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">3</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">4</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">5</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">7</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8</a> ]
[ 9 ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">10</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">11</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">12</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br>Chapter 9 - The Operating System
</h1>
<hr>
<h2 id="s9.1">9.1 File system hierarchy</h2>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-fhs">9.1.1 File System Structure</h3>
<p>
The location of all files and directories must comply with the Filesystem
Hierarchy Standard (FHS), version 2.3, with the exceptions noted below, and
except where doing so would violate other terms of Debian Policy. The
following exceptions to the FHS apply:
</p>
<ol type="1" start="1" >
<li>
<p>
The FHS requirement that architecture-independent application-specific static
files be located in <code>/usr/share</code> is relaxed to a suggestion. In
particular, a subdirectory of <code>/usr/lib</code> may be used by a package
(or a collection of packages) to hold a mixture of architecture-independent and
architecture-dependent files. However, when a directory is entirely composed
of architecture-independent files, it should be located in
<code>/usr/share</code>.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="2" >
<li>
<p>
The optional rules related to user specific configuration files for
applications are stored in the user's home directory are relaxed. It is
recommended that such files start with the '<samp>.</samp>' character (a
"dot file"), and if an application needs to create more than one dot
file then the preferred placement is in a subdirectory with a name starting
with a '.' character, (a "dot directory"). In this case it is
recommended the configuration files not start with the '.' character.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="3" >
<li>
<p>
The requirement for amd64 to use <code>/lib64</code> for 64 bit binaries is
removed.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="4" >
<li>
<p>
The requirement for object files, internal binaries, and libraries, including
<code>libc.so.*</code>, to be located directly under <code>/lib{,32}</code> and
<code>/usr/lib{,32}</code> is amended, permitting files to instead be installed
to <code>/lib/<var>triplet</var></code> and
<code>/usr/lib/<var>triplet</var></code>, where <samp><var>triplet</var></samp>
is the value returned by <samp>dpkg-architecture -qDEB_HOST_MULTIARCH</samp>
for the architecture of the package. Packages may <em>not</em> install files
to any <var>triplet</var> path other than the one matching the architecture of
that package; for instance, an <samp>Architecture: amd64</samp> package
containing 32-bit x86 libraries may not install these libraries to
<code>/usr/lib/i386-linux-gnu</code>. [<a href="#f78" name="fr78">78</a>]
</p>
<p>
The requirement for C and C++ headers files to be accessible through the search
path <code>/usr/include/</code> is amended, permitting files to be accessible
through the search path <code>/usr/include/<var>triplet</var></code> where
<samp><var>triplet</var></samp> is as above. [<a href="#f79"
name="fr79">79</a>]
</p>
<p>
Applications may also use a single subdirectory under
<code>/usr/lib/<var>triplet</var></code>.
</p>
<p>
The execution time linker/loader, ld*, must still be made available in the
existing location under /lib or /lib64 since this is part of the ELF ABI for
the architecture.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="5" >
<li>
<p>
The requirement that <code>/usr/local/share/man</code> be
"synonymous" with <code>/usr/local/man</code> is relaxed to a
recommendation
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="6" >
<li>
<p>
The requirement that windowmanagers with a single configuration file call it
<code>system.*wmrc</code> is removed, as is the restriction that the window
manager subdirectory be named identically to the window manager name itself.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="7" >
<li>
<p>
The requirement that boot manager configuration files live in
<code>/etc</code>, or at least are symlinked there, is relaxed to a
recommendation.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="8" >
<li>
<p>
The additional directory <code>/run</code> in the root file system is allowed.
<code>/run</code> replaces <code>/var/run</code>, and the subdirectory
<code>/run/lock</code> replaces <code>/var/lock</code>, with the
<code>/var</code> directories replaced by symlinks for backwards compatibility.
<code>/run</code> and <code>/run/lock</code> must follow all of the
requirements in the FHS for <code>/var/run</code> and <code>/var/lock</code>,
respectively, such as file naming conventions, file format requirements, or the
requirement that files be cleared during the boot process. Files and
directories residing in <code>/run</code> should be stored on a temporary file
system.
</p>
<p>
Packages must not assume the <code>/run</code> directory exists or is usable
without a dependency on <samp>initscripts (>= 2.88dsf-13.3)</samp> until the
stable release of Debian supports <code>/run</code>.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="9" >
<li>
<p>
The <code>/sys</code> directory in the root filesystem is additionally allowed.
[<a href="#f80" name="fr80">80</a>]
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="10" >
<li>
<p>
The <code>/var/www</code> directory is additionally allowed.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="11" >
<li>
<p>
The requirement for <code>/usr/local/lib<qual></code> to exist if
<code>/lib<qual></code> or <code>/usr/lib<qual></code> exists
(where <code>lib<qual></code> is a variant of <code>lib</code> such as
<code>lib32</code> or <code>lib64</code>) is removed.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="12" >
<li>
<p>
On GNU/Hurd systems, the following additional directories are allowed in the
root filesystem: <code>/hurd</code> and <code>/servers</code>.[<a href="#f81"
name="fr81">81</a>]
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<p>
The version of this document referred here can be found in the
<samp>debian-policy</samp> package or on <code><a
href="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/fhs/">FHS (Debian
copy)</a></code> alongside this manual (or, if you have the
<code>debian-policy</code> installed, you can try <code><a
href="file:///usr/share/doc/debian-policy/fhs/">FHS (local copy)</a></code>).
The latest version, which may be a more recent version, may be found on
<code><a href="http://www.pathname.com/fhs/">FHS (upstream)</a></code>.
Specific questions about following the standard may be asked on the
<samp>debian-devel</samp> mailing list, or referred to the FHS mailing list
(see the <code><a href="http://www.pathname.com/fhs/">FHS web site</a></code>
for more information).
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s9.1.2">9.1.2 Site-specific programs</h3>
<p>
As mandated by the FHS, packages must not place any files in
<code>/usr/local</code>, either by putting them in the file system archive to
be unpacked by <code>dpkg</code> or by manipulating them in their maintainer
scripts.
</p>
<p>
However, the package may create empty directories below <code>/usr/local</code>
so that the system administrator knows where to place site-specific files.
These are not directories <em>in</em> <code>/usr/local</code>, but are children
of directories in <code>/usr/local</code>. These directories
(<code>/usr/local/*/dir/</code>) should be removed on package removal if they
are empty.
</p>
<p>
Note that this applies only to directories <em>below</em>
<code>/usr/local</code>, not <em>in</em> <code>/usr/local</code>. Packages
must not create sub-directories in the directory <code>/usr/local</code>
itself, except those listed in FHS, section 4.5. However, you may create
directories below them as you wish. You must not remove any of the directories
listed in 4.5, even if you created them.
</p>
<p>
Since <code>/usr/local</code> can be mounted read-only from a remote server,
these directories must be created and removed by the <code>postinst</code> and
<code>prerm</code> maintainer scripts and not be included in the
<code>.deb</code> archive. These scripts must not fail if either of these
operations fail.
</p>
<p>
For example, the <samp>emacsen-common</samp> package could contain something
like
</p>
<pre>
if [ ! -e /usr/local/share/emacs ]; then
if mkdir /usr/local/share/emacs 2>/dev/null; then
if chown root:staff /usr/local/share/emacs; then
chmod 2775 /usr/local/share/emacs || true
fi
fi
fi
</pre>
<p>
in its <code>postinst</code> script, and
</p>
<pre>
rmdir /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp 2>/dev/null || true
rmdir /usr/local/share/emacs 2>/dev/null || true
</pre>
<p>
in the <code>prerm</code> script. (Note that this form is used to ensure that
if the script is interrupted, the directory <code>/usr/local/share/emacs</code>
will still be removed.)
</p>
<p>
If you do create a directory in <code>/usr/local</code> for local additions to
a package, you should ensure that settings in <code>/usr/local</code> take
precedence over the equivalents in <code>/usr</code>.
</p>
<p>
However, because <code>/usr/local</code> and its contents are for exclusive use
of the local administrator, a package must not rely on the presence or absence
of files or directories in <code>/usr/local</code> for normal operation.
</p>
<p>
The <code>/usr/local</code> directory itself and all the subdirectories created
by the package should (by default) have permissions 2775 (group-writable and
set-group-id) and be owned by <samp>root:staff</samp>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s9.1.3">9.1.3 The system-wide mail directory</h3>
<p>
The system-wide mail directory is <code>/var/mail</code>. This directory is
part of the base system and should not be owned by any particular mail agents.
The use of the old location <code>/var/spool/mail</code> is deprecated, even
though the spool may still be physically located there.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-fhs-run">9.1.4 <code>/run</code> and <code>/run/lock</code></h3>
<p>
The directory <code>/run</code> is cleared at boot, normally by being a mount
point for a temporary file system. Packages therefore must not assume that any
files or directories under <code>/run</code> other than <code>/run/lock</code>
exist unless the package has arranged to create those files or directories
since the last reboot. Normally, this is done by the package via an init
script. See <a href="#s-writing-init">Writing the scripts, Section 9.3.2</a>
for more information.
</p>
<p>
Packages must not include files or directories under <code>/run</code>, or
under the older <code>/var/run</code> and <code>/var/lock</code> paths. The
latter paths will normally be symlinks or other redirections to
<code>/run</code> for backwards compatibility.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s9.2">9.2 Users and groups</h2>
<hr>
<h3 id="s9.2.1">9.2.1 Introduction</h3>
<p>
The Debian system can be configured to use either plain or shadow passwords.
</p>
<p>
Some user ids (UIDs) and group ids (GIDs) are reserved globally for use by
certain packages. Because some packages need to include files which are owned
by these users or groups, or need the ids compiled into binaries, these ids
must be used on any Debian system only for the purpose for which they are
allocated. This is a serious restriction, and we should avoid getting in the
way of local administration policies. In particular, many sites allocate users
and/or local system groups starting at 100.
</p>
<p>
Apart from this we should have dynamically allocated ids, which should by
default be arranged in some sensible order, but the behavior should be
configurable.
</p>
<p>
Packages other than <samp>base-passwd</samp> must not modify
<code>/etc/passwd</code>, <code>/etc/shadow</code>, <code>/etc/group</code> or
<code>/etc/gshadow</code>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s9.2.2">9.2.2 UID and GID classes</h3>
<p>
The UID and GID numbers are divided into classes as follows:
</p>
<dl>
<dt>0-99:</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Globally allocated by the Debian project, the same on every Debian system.
These ids will appear in the <code>passwd</code> and <code>group</code> files
of all Debian systems, new ids in this range being added automatically as the
<samp>base-passwd</samp> package is updated.
</p>
<p>
Packages which need a single statically allocated uid or gid should use one of
these; their maintainers should ask the <samp>base-passwd</samp> maintainer for
ids.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>100-999:</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Dynamically allocated system users and groups. Packages which need a user or
group, but can have this user or group allocated dynamically and differently on
each system, should use <samp>adduser --system</samp> to create the group
and/or user. <code>adduser</code> will check for the existence of the user or
group, and if necessary choose an unused id based on the ranges specified in
<code>adduser.conf</code>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>1000-59999:</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Dynamically allocated user accounts. By default <code>adduser</code> will
choose UIDs and GIDs for user accounts in this range, though
<code>adduser.conf</code> may be used to modify this behavior.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>60000-64999:</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Globally allocated by the Debian project, but only created on demand. The ids
are allocated centrally and statically, but the actual accounts are only
created on users' systems on demand.
</p>
<p>
These ids are for packages which are obscure or which require many
statically-allocated ids. These packages should check for and create the
accounts in <code>/etc/passwd</code> or <code>/etc/group</code> (using
<code>adduser</code> if it has this facility) if necessary. Packages which are
likely to require further allocations should have a "hole" left after
them in the allocation, to give them room to grow.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>65000-65533:</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Reserved.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>65534:</dt>
<dd>
<p>
User <samp>nobody</samp>. The corresponding gid refers to the group
<samp>nogroup</samp>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>65535:</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This value <em>must not</em> be used, because it was the error return sentinel
value when <samp>uid_t</samp> was 16 bits.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>65536-4294967293:</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Dynamically allocated user accounts. By default <code>adduser</code> will not
allocate UIDs and GIDs in this range, to ease compatibility with legacy systems
where <samp>uid_t</samp> is still 16 bits.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>4294967294:</dt>
<dd>
<p>
<samp>(uid_t)(-2) == (gid_t)(-2)</samp> <em>must not</em> be used, because it
is used as the anonymous, unauthenticated user by some NFS implementations.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>4294967295:</dt>
<dd>
<p>
<samp>(uid_t)(-1) == (gid_t)(-1)</samp> <em>must not</em> be used, because it
is the error return sentinel value.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-sysvinit">9.3 System run levels and <code>init.d</code> scripts</h2>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-/etc/init.d">9.3.1 Introduction</h3>
<p>
The <code>/etc/init.d</code> directory contains the scripts executed by
<code>init</code> at boot time and when the init state (or
"runlevel") is changed (see <code>init(8)</code>).
</p>
<p>
There are at least two different, yet functionally equivalent, ways of handling
these scripts. For the sake of simplicity, this document describes only the
symbolic link method. However, it must not be assumed by maintainer scripts
that this method is being used, and any automated manipulation of the various
runlevel behaviors by maintainer scripts must be performed using
<code>update-rc.d</code> as described below and not by manually installing or
removing symlinks. For information on the implementation details of the other
method, implemented in the <samp>file-rc</samp> package, please refer to the
documentation of that package.
</p>
<p>
These scripts are referenced by symbolic links in the
<code>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</code> directories. When changing runlevels,
<code>init</code> looks in the directory <code>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</code> for
the scripts it should execute, where <samp><var>n</var></samp> is the runlevel
that is being changed to, or <samp>S</samp> for the boot-up scripts.
</p>
<p>
The names of the links all have the form
<code>S<var>mm</var><var>script</var></code> or
<code>K<var>mm</var><var>script</var></code> where <var>mm</var> is a two-digit
number and <var>script</var> is the name of the script (this should be the same
as the name of the actual script in <code>/etc/init.d</code>).
</p>
<p>
When <code>init</code> changes runlevel first the targets of the links whose
names start with a <samp>K</samp> are executed, each with the single argument
<samp>stop</samp>, followed by the scripts prefixed with an <samp>S</samp>,
each with the single argument <samp>start</samp>. (The links are those in the
<code>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</code> directory corresponding to the new
runlevel.) The <samp>K</samp> links are responsible for killing services and
the <samp>S</samp> link for starting services upon entering the runlevel.
</p>
<p>
For example, if we are changing from runlevel 2 to runlevel 3, init will first
execute all of the <samp>K</samp> prefixed scripts it finds in
<code>/etc/rc3.d</code>, and then all of the <samp>S</samp> prefixed scripts in
that directory. The links starting with <samp>K</samp> will cause the
referred-to file to be executed with an argument of <samp>stop</samp>, and the
<samp>S</samp> links with an argument of <samp>start</samp>.
</p>
<p>
The two-digit number <var>mm</var> is used to determine the order in which to
run the scripts: low-numbered links have their scripts run first. For example,
the <samp>K20</samp> scripts will be executed before the <samp>K30</samp>
scripts. This is used when a certain service must be started before another.
For example, the name server <code>bind</code> might need to be started before
the news server <code>inn</code> so that <code>inn</code> can set up its access
lists. In this case, the script that starts <code>bind</code> would have a
lower number than the script that starts <code>inn</code> so that it runs
first:
</p>
<pre>
/etc/rc2.d/S17bind
/etc/rc2.d/S70inn
</pre>
<p>
The two runlevels 0 (halt) and 6 (reboot) are slightly different. In these
runlevels, the links with an <samp>S</samp> prefix are still called after those
with a <samp>K</samp> prefix, but they too are called with the single argument
<samp>stop</samp>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-writing-init">9.3.2 Writing the scripts</h3>
<p>
Packages that include daemons for system services should place scripts in
<code>/etc/init.d</code> to start or stop services at boot time or during a
change of runlevel. These scripts should be named
<code>/etc/init.d/<var>package</var></code>, and they should accept one
argument, saying what to do:
</p>
<dl>
<dt><samp>start</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
start the service,
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>stop</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
stop the service,
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>restart</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
stop and restart the service if it's already running, otherwise start the
service
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>reload</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
cause the configuration of the service to be reloaded without actually stopping
and restarting the service,
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>force-reload</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
cause the configuration to be reloaded if the service supports this, otherwise
restart the service.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<p>
The <samp>start</samp>, <samp>stop</samp>, <samp>restart</samp>, and
<samp>force-reload</samp> options should be supported by all scripts in
<code>/etc/init.d</code>, the <samp>reload</samp> option is optional.
</p>
<p>
The <code>init.d</code> scripts must ensure that they will behave sensibly
(i.e., returning success and not starting multiple copies of a service) if
invoked with <samp>start</samp> when the service is already running, or with
<samp>stop</samp> when it isn't, and that they don't kill unfortunately-named
user processes. The best way to achieve this is usually to use
<code>start-stop-daemon</code> with the <samp>--oknodo</samp> option.
</p>
<p>
Be careful of using <samp>set -e</samp> in <code>init.d</code> scripts.
Writing correct <code>init.d</code> scripts requires accepting various error
exit statuses when daemons are already running or already stopped without
aborting the <code>init.d</code> script, and common <code>init.d</code>
function libraries are not safe to call with <samp>set -e</samp> in effect[<a
href="#f82" name="fr82">82</a>]. For <samp>init.d</samp> scripts, it's often
easier to not use <samp>set -e</samp> and instead check the result of each
command separately.
</p>
<p>
If a service reloads its configuration automatically (as in the case of
<code>cron</code>, for example), the <samp>reload</samp> option of the
<code>init.d</code> script should behave as if the configuration has been
reloaded successfully.
</p>
<p>
The <code>/etc/init.d</code> scripts must be treated as configuration files,
either (if they are present in the package, that is, in the .deb file) by
marking them as <samp>conffile</samp>s, or, (if they do not exist in the .deb)
by managing them correctly in the maintainer scripts (see <a
href="#s-config-files">Configuration files, Section 10.7</a>). This is
important since we want to give the local system administrator the chance to
adapt the scripts to the local system, e.g., to disable a service without
de-installing the package, or to specify some special command line options when
starting a service, while making sure their changes aren't lost during the next
package upgrade.
</p>
<p>
These scripts should not fail obscurely when the configuration files remain but
the package has been removed, as configuration files remain on the system after
the package has been removed. Only when <code>dpkg</code> is executed with the
<samp>--purge</samp> option will configuration files be removed. In
particular, as the <code>/etc/init.d/<var>package</var></code> script itself is
usually a <samp>conffile</samp>, it will remain on the system if the package is
removed but not purged. Therefore, you should include a <samp>test</samp>
statement at the top of the script, like this:
</p>
<pre>
test -f <var>program-executed-later-in-script</var> || exit 0
</pre>
<p>
Often there are some variables in the <code>init.d</code> scripts whose values
control the behavior of the scripts, and which a system administrator is likely
to want to change. As the scripts themselves are frequently
<samp>conffile</samp>s, modifying them requires that the administrator merge in
their changes each time the package is upgraded and the <samp>conffile</samp>
changes. To ease the burden on the system administrator, such configurable
values should not be placed directly in the script. Instead, they should be
placed in a file in <code>/etc/default</code>, which typically will have the
same base name as the <code>init.d</code> script. This extra file should be
sourced by the script when the script runs. It must contain only variable
settings and comments in SUSv3 <code>sh</code> format. It may either be a
<samp>conffile</samp> or a configuration file maintained by the package
maintainer scripts. See <a href="#s-config-files">Configuration files, Section
10.7</a> for more details.
</p>
<p>
To ensure that vital configurable values are always available, the
<code>init.d</code> script should set default values for each of the shell
variables it uses, either before sourcing the <code>/etc/default/</code> file
or afterwards using something like the <samp>: ${VAR:=default}</samp> syntax.
Also, the <code>init.d</code> script must behave sensibly and not fail if the
<code>/etc/default</code> file is deleted.
</p>
<p>
Files and directories under <code>/run</code>, including ones referred to via
the compatibility paths <code>/var/run</code> and <code>/var/lock</code>, are
normally stored on a temporary filesystem and are normally not persistent
across a reboot. The <code>init.d</code> scripts must handle this correctly.
This will typically mean creating any required subdirectories dynamically when
the <code>init.d</code> script is run. See <a
href="#s-fhs-run"><code>/run</code> and <code>/run/lock</code>, Section
9.1.4</a> for more information.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s9.3.3">9.3.3 Interfacing with the initscript system</h3>
<p>
Maintainers should use the abstraction layer provided by the
<code>update-rc.d</code> and <code>invoke-rc.d</code> programs to deal with
initscripts in their packages' scripts such as <code>postinst</code>,
<code>prerm</code> and <code>postrm</code>.
</p>
<p>
Directly managing the /etc/rc?.d links and directly invoking the
<code>/etc/init.d/</code> initscripts should be done only by packages providing
the initscript subsystem (such as <code>sysv-rc</code> and
<code>file-rc</code>).
</p>
<hr>
<h4 id="s9.3.3.1">9.3.3.1 Managing the links</h4>
<p>
The program <code>update-rc.d</code> is provided for package maintainers to
arrange for the proper creation and removal of
<code>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</code> symbolic links, or their functional
equivalent if another method is being used. This may be used by maintainers in
their packages' <code>postinst</code> and <code>postrm</code> scripts.
</p>
<p>
You must not include any <code>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</code> symbolic links in
the actual archive or manually create or remove the symbolic links in
maintainer scripts; you must use the <code>update-rc.d</code> program instead.
(The former will fail if an alternative method of maintaining runlevel
information is being used.) You must not include the
<code>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</code> directories themselves in the archive
either. (Only the <samp>sysvinit</samp> package may do so.)
</p>
<p>
By default <code>update-rc.d</code> will start services in each of the
multi-user state runlevels (2, 3, 4, and 5) and stop them in the halt runlevel
(0), the single-user runlevel (1) and the reboot runlevel (6). The system
administrator will have the opportunity to customize runlevels by simply
adding, moving, or removing the symbolic links in
<code>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</code> if symbolic links are being used, or by
modifying <code>/etc/runlevel.conf</code> if the <samp>file-rc</samp> method is
being used.
</p>
<p>
To get the default behavior for your package, put in your <code>postinst</code>
script
</p>
<pre>
update-rc.d <var>package</var> defaults
</pre>
<p>
and in your <code>postrm</code>
</p>
<pre>
if [ "$1" = purge ]; then
update-rc.d <var>package</var> remove
fi
</pre>
<p>
. Note that if your package changes runlevels or priority, you may have to
remove and recreate the links, since otherwise the old links may persist.
Refer to the documentation of <code>update-rc.d</code>.
</p>
<p>
This will use a default sequence number of 20. If it does not matter when or
in which order the <code>init.d</code> script is run, use this default. If it
does, then you should talk to the maintainer of the <code>sysvinit</code>
package or post to <samp>debian-devel</samp>, and they will help you choose a
number.
</p>
<p>
For more information about using <samp>update-rc.d</samp>, please consult its
man page <code>update-rc.d(8)</code>.
</p>
<hr>
<h4 id="s9.3.3.2">9.3.3.2 Running initscripts</h4>
<p>
The program <code>invoke-rc.d</code> is provided to make it easier for package
maintainers to properly invoke an initscript, obeying runlevel and other
locally-defined constraints that might limit a package's right to start, stop
and otherwise manage services. This program may be used by maintainers in
their packages' scripts.
</p>
<p>
The package maintainer scripts must use <code>invoke-rc.d</code> to invoke the
<code>/etc/init.d/*</code> initscripts, instead of calling them directly.
</p>
<p>
By default, <code>invoke-rc.d</code> will pass any action requests (start,
stop, reload, restart...) to the <code>/etc/init.d</code> script, filtering out
requests to start or restart a service out of its intended runlevels.
</p>
<p>
Most packages will simply need to change:
</p>
<pre>
/etc/init.d/<package>
<action>
</pre>
<p>
in their <code>postinst</code> and <code>prerm</code> scripts to:
</p>
<pre>
if which invoke-rc.d >/dev/null 2>&1; then
invoke-rc.d <var>package</var> <action>
else
/etc/init.d/<var>package</var> <action>
fi
</pre>
<p>
A package should register its initscript services using
<code>update-rc.d</code> before it tries to invoke them using
<code>invoke-rc.d</code>. Invocation of unregistered services may fail.
</p>
<p>
For more information about using <code>invoke-rc.d</code>, please consult its
man page <code>invoke-rc.d(8)</code>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s9.3.4">9.3.4 Boot-time initialization</h3>
<p>
There used to be another directory, <code>/etc/rc.boot</code>, which contained
scripts which were run once per machine boot. This has been deprecated in
favour of links from <code>/etc/rcS.d</code> to files in
<code>/etc/init.d</code> as described in <a href="#s-/etc/init.d">Introduction,
Section 9.3.1</a>. Packages must not place files in <code>/etc/rc.boot</code>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s9.3.5">9.3.5 Example</h3>
<p>
An example on which you can base your <code>/etc/init.d</code> scripts is found
in <code>/etc/init.d/skeleton</code>.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s9.4">9.4 Console messages from <code>init.d</code> scripts</h2>
<p>
This section describes the formats to be used for messages written to standard
output by the <code>/etc/init.d</code> scripts. The intent is to improve the
consistency of Debian's startup and shutdown look and feel. For this reason,
please look very carefully at the details. We want the messages to have the
same format in terms of wording, spaces, punctuation and case of letters.
</p>
<p>
Here is a list of overall rules that should be used for messages generated by
<code>/etc/init.d</code> scripts.
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
The message should fit in one line (fewer than 80 characters), start with a
capital letter and end with a period (<samp>.</samp>) and line feed
(<samp>"\n"</samp>).
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
If the script is performing some time consuming task in the background (not
merely starting or stopping a program, for instance), an ellipsis (three dots:
<samp>...</samp>) should be output to the screen, with no leading or tailing
whitespace or line feeds.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
The messages should appear as if the computer is telling the user what it is
doing (politely :-), but should not mention "it" directly. For
example, instead of:
</p>
<pre>
I'm starting network daemons: nfsd mountd.
</pre>
<p>
the message should say
</p>
<pre>
Starting network daemons: nfsd mountd.
</pre>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
<samp>init.d</samp> script should use the following standard message formats
for the situations enumerated below.
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
When daemons are started
</p>
<p>
If the script starts one or more daemons, the output should look like this (a
single line, no leading spaces):
</p>
<pre>
Starting <var>description</var>: <var>daemon-1</var> ... <var>daemon-n</var>.
</pre>
<p>
The <var>description</var> should describe the subsystem the daemon or set of
daemons are part of, while <var>daemon-1</var> up to <var>daemon-n</var> denote
each daemon's name (typically the file name of the program).
</p>
<p>
For example, the output of <code>/etc/init.d/lpd</code> would look like:
</p>
<pre>
Starting printer spooler: lpd.
</pre>
<p>
This can be achieved by saying
</p>
<pre>
echo -n "Starting printer spooler: lpd"
start-stop-daemon --start --quiet --exec /usr/sbin/lpd
echo "."
</pre>
<p>
in the script. If there are more than one daemon to start, the output should
look like this:
</p>
<pre>
echo -n "Starting remote file system services:"
echo -n " nfsd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet nfsd
echo -n " mountd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet mountd
echo -n " ugidd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet ugidd
echo "."
</pre>
<p>
This makes it possible for the user to see what is happening and when the final
daemon has been started. Care should be taken in the placement of white
spaces: in the example above the system administrators can easily comment out a
line if they don't want to start a specific daemon, while the displayed message
still looks good.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
When a system parameter is being set
</p>
<p>
If you have to set up different system parameters during the system boot, you
should use this format:
</p>
<pre>
Setting <var>parameter</var> to "<var>value</var>".
</pre>
<p>
You can use a statement such as the following to get the quotes right:
</p>
<pre>
echo "Setting DNS domainname to \"$domainname\"."
</pre>
<p>
Note that the same symbol (<samp>"</samp>) is used for the left and right
quotation marks. A grave accent (<samp>`</samp>) is not a quote character;
neither is an apostrophe (<samp>'</samp>).
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
When a daemon is stopped or restarted
</p>
<p>
When you stop or restart a daemon, you should issue a message identical to the
startup message, except that <samp>Starting</samp> is replaced with
<samp>Stopping</samp> or <samp>Restarting</samp> respectively.
</p>
<p>
For example, stopping the printer daemon will look like this:
</p>
<pre>
Stopping printer spooler: lpd.
</pre>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
When something is executed
</p>
<p>
There are several examples where you have to run a program at system startup or
shutdown to perform a specific task, for example, setting the system's clock
using <code>netdate</code> or killing all processes when the system shuts down.
Your message should look like this:
</p>
<pre>
Doing something very useful...done.
</pre>
<p>
You should print the <samp>done.</samp> immediately after the job has been
completed, so that the user is informed why they have to wait. You can get
this behavior by saying
</p>
<pre>
echo -n "Doing something very useful..."
do_something
echo "done."
</pre>
<p>
in your script.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
When the configuration is reloaded
</p>
<p>
When a daemon is forced to reload its configuration files you should use the
following format:
</p>
<pre>
Reloading <var>description</var> configuration...done.
</pre>
<p>
where <var>description</var> is the same as in the daemon starting message.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-cron-jobs">9.5 Cron jobs</h2>
<p>
Packages must not modify the configuration file <code>/etc/crontab</code>, and
they must not modify the files in <code>/var/spool/cron/crontabs</code>.
</p>
<p>
If a package wants to install a job that has to be executed via cron, it should
place a file named as specified in <a href="#s-cron-files">Cron job file names,
Section 9.5.1</a> into one or more of the following directories:
</p>
<pre>
/etc/cron.hourly
/etc/cron.daily
/etc/cron.weekly
/etc/cron.monthly
</pre>
<p>
As these directory names imply, the files within them are executed on an
hourly, daily, weekly, or monthly basis, respectively. The exact times are
listed in <code>/etc/crontab</code>.
</p>
<p>
All files installed in any of these directories must be scripts (e.g., shell
scripts or Perl scripts) so that they can easily be modified by the local
system administrator. In addition, they must be treated as configuration
files.
</p>
<p>
If a certain job has to be executed at some other frequency or at a specific
time, the package should install a file in <code>/etc/cron.d</code> with a name
as specified in <a href="#s-cron-files">Cron job file names, Section 9.5.1</a>.
This file uses the same syntax as <code>/etc/crontab</code> and is processed by
<code>cron</code> automatically. The file must also be treated as a
configuration file. (Note that entries in the <code>/etc/cron.d</code>
directory are not handled by <code>anacron</code>. Thus, you should only use
this directory for jobs which may be skipped if the system is not running.)
</p>
<p>
Unlike <code>crontab</code> files described in the IEEE Std 1003.1-2008
(POSIX.1) available from <code><a
href="http://www.opengroup.org/onlinepubs/9699919799/">The Open
Group</a></code>, the files in <code>/etc/cron.d</code> and the file
<code>/etc/crontab</code> have seven fields; namely:
</p>
<ol type="1" start="1" >
<li>
<p>
Minute [0,59]
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="2" >
<li>
<p>
Hour [0,23]
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="3" >
<li>
<p>
Day of the month [1,31]
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="4" >
<li>
<p>
Month of the year [1,12]
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="5" >
<li>
<p>
Day of the week ([0,6] with 0=Sunday)
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="6" >
<li>
<p>
Username
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="7" >
<li>
<p>
Command to be run
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<p>
Ranges of numbers are allowed. Ranges are two numbers separated with a hyphen.
The specified range is inclusive. Lists are allowed. A list is a set of
numbers (or ranges) separated by commas. Step values can be used in
conjunction with ranges.
</p>
<p>
The scripts or <samp>crontab</samp> entries in these directories should check
if all necessary programs are installed before they try to execute them.
Otherwise, problems will arise when a package was removed but not purged since
configuration files are kept on the system in this situation.
</p>
<p>
Any <samp>cron</samp> daemon must provide <code>/usr/bin/crontab</code> and
support normal <samp>crontab</samp> entries as specified in POSIX. The daemon
must also support names for days and months, ranges, and step values. It has
to support <code>/etc/crontab</code>, and correctly execute the scripts in
<code>/etc/cron.d</code>. The daemon must also correctly execute scripts in
<code>/etc/cron.{hourly,daily,weekly,monthly}</code>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-cron-files">9.5.1 Cron job file names</h3>
<p>
The file name of a cron job file should normally match the name of the package
from which it comes.
</p>
<p>
If a package supplies multiple cron job files files in the same directory, the
file names should all start with the name of the package (possibly modified as
described below) followed by a hyphen (<samp>-</samp>) and a suitable suffix.
</p>
<p>
A cron job file name must not include any period or plus characters
(<samp>.</samp> or <samp>+</samp>) characters as this will cause cron to ignore
the file. Underscores (<samp>_</samp>) should be used instead of
<samp>.</samp> and <samp>+</samp> characters.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-menus">9.6 Menus</h2>
<p>
Packages shipping applications that comply with minimal requirements described
below for integration with desktop environments should register these
applications in the desktop menu, following the <em>FreeDesktop</em> standard,
using text files called <em>desktop entries</em>. Their format is described in
the <em>Desktop Entry Specification</em> at <code><a
href="http://standards.freedesktop.org/desktop-entry-spec/latest/">http://standards.freedesktop.org/desktop-entry-spec/latest/</a></code>
and complementary information can be found in the <em>Desktop Menu
Specification</em> at <code><a
href="http://standards.freedesktop.org/menu-spec/latest/">http://standards.freedesktop.org/menu-spec/latest/</a></code>.
</p>
<p>
The desktop entry files are installed by the packages in the directory
<code>/usr/share/applications</code> and the FreeDesktop menus are refreshed
using <em>dpkg triggers</em>. It is therefore not necessary to depend on
packages providing FreeDesktop menu systems.
</p>
<p>
Entries displayed in the FreeDesktop menu should conform to the following
minima for relevance and visual integration.
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
Unless hidden by default, the desktop entry must point to a PNG or SVG icon
with a transparent background, providing at least the 22×22 size, and
preferably up to 64×64. The icon should be neutral enough to integrate
well with the default icon themes. It is encouraged to ship the icon in the
default <em>hicolor</em> icon theme directories, or to use an existing icon
from the <em>hicolor</em> theme.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
If the menu entry is not useful in the general case as a standalone
application, the desktop entry should set the <samp>NoDisplay</samp> key to
<var>true</var>, so that it can be configured to be displayed only by those who
need it.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
In doubt, the package maintainer should coordinate with the maintainers of menu
implementations through the <em>debian-desktop</em> mailing list in order to
avoid problems with categories or bad interactions with other icons.
Especially for packages which are part of installation tasks, the contents of
the <samp>NotShowIn</samp>/<samp>OnlyShowIn</samp> keys should be validated by
the maintainers of the relevant environments.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
Since the FreeDesktop menu is a cross-distribution standard, the desktop
entries written for Debian should be forwarded upstream, where they will
benefit to other users and are more likely to receive extra contributions such
as translations.
</p>
<p>
Packages can, to be compatible with Debian additions to some window managers
that do not support the FreeDesktop standard, also provide a <em>Debian
menu</em> file, following the <em>Debian menu policy</em>, which can be found
in the <samp>menu-policy</samp> files in the <samp>debian-policy</samp>
package. It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at <samp><code><a
href="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/menu-policy/">/doc/packaging-manuals/menu-policy/</a></code></samp>.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-mime">9.7 Multimedia handlers</h2>
<p>
Media types (formerly known as MIME types, Multipurpose Internet Mail
Extensions, RFCs 2045-2049) is a mechanism for encoding files and data streams
and providing meta-information about them, in particular their type and format
(e.g. <samp>image/png</samp>, <samp>text/html</samp>, <samp>audio/ogg</samp>).
</p>
<p>
Registration of media type handlers allows programs like mail user agents and
web browsers to invoke these handlers to view, edit or display media types they
don't support directly.
</p>
<p>
There are two overlapping systems to associate media types to programs which
can handle them. The <em>mailcap</em> system is found on a large number of
Unix systems. The <em>FreeDesktop</em> system is aimed at Desktop
environments. In Debian, FreeDesktop entries are automatically translated in
mailcap entries, therefore packages already using desktop entries should not
use the mailcap system directly.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-media-types-freedesktop">9.7.1 Registration of media type handlers with desktop entries</h3>
<p>
Packages shipping an application able to view, edit or point to files of a
given media type, or open links with a given URI scheme, should list it in the
<samp>MimeType</samp> key of the application's <a href="#s-menus">desktop
entry</a>. For URI schemes, the relevant MIME types are
<samp>x-scheme-handler/*</samp> (e.g. <samp>x-scheme-handler/https</samp>).
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-mailcap">9.7.2 Registration of media type handlers with mailcap entries</h3>
<p>
Packages that are not using desktop entries for registration should install a
file in <code>mailcap(5)</code> format (RFC 1524) in the directory
<code>/usr/lib/mime/packages/</code>. The file name should be the binary
package's name.
</p>
<p>
The <code>mime-support</code> package provides the <code>update-mime</code>
program, which integrates these registrations in the <code>/etc/mailcap</code>
file, using dpkg triggers[<a href="#f83" name="fr83">83</a>].
</p>
<p>
Packages installing desktop entries should not install mailcap entries for the
same program, because the <code>mime-support</code> package already reads
desktop entries.
</p>
<p>
Packages using these facilities <em>should not</em> depend on, recommend, or
suggest <code>mime-support</code>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-file-media-type">9.7.3 Providing media types to files</h3>
<p>
The media type of a file is discovered by inspecting the file's extension or
its <code>magic(5)</code> pattern, and interrogating a database associating
them with media types.
</p>
<p>
To support new associations between media types and files, their characteristic
file extensions and magic patterns should be registered to the IANA (Internet
Assigned Numbers Authority). See <code><a
href="http://www.iana.org/assignments/media-types">http://www.iana.org/assignments/media-types</a></code>
and RFC 6838 for details. This information will then propagate to the systems
discovering file media types in Debian, provided by the
<code>shared-mime-info</code>, <code>mime-support</code> and <code>file</code>
packages. If registration and propagation can not be waited for, support can
be asked to the maintainers of the packages mentioned above.
</p>
<p>
For files that are produced and read by a single application, it is also
possible to declare this association to the <em>Shared MIME Info</em> system by
installing in the directory <code>/usr/share/mime/packages</code> a file in the
XML format specified at <code><a
href="http://standards.freedesktop.org/shared-mime-info-spec/latest/">http://standards.freedesktop.org/shared-mime-info-spec/latest/</a></code>.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s9.8">9.8 Keyboard configuration</h2>
<p>
To achieve a consistent keyboard configuration so that all applications
interpret a keyboard event the same way, all programs in the Debian
distribution must be configured to comply with the following guidelines.
</p>
<p>
The following keys must have the specified interpretations:
</p>
<dl>
<dt><samp><--</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
delete the character to the left of the cursor
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>Delete</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
delete the character to the right of the cursor
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>Control+H</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
emacs: the help prefix
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<p>
The interpretation of any keyboard events should be independent of the terminal
that is used, be it a virtual console, an X terminal emulator, an rlogin/telnet
session, etc.
</p>
<p>
The following list explains how the different programs should be set up to
achieve this:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<samp><--</samp> generates <samp>KB_BackSpace</samp> in X.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<samp>Delete</samp> generates <samp>KB_Delete</samp> in X.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
X translations are set up to make <samp>KB_Backspace</samp> generate ASCII DEL,
and to make <samp>KB_Delete</samp> generate <samp>ESC [ 3 ~</samp> (this is the
vt220 escape code for the "delete character" key). This must be done
by loading the X resources using <code>xrdb</code> on all local X displays, not
using the application defaults, so that the translation resources used
correspond to the <code>xmodmap</code> settings.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
The Linux console is configured to make <samp><--</samp> generate DEL, and
<samp>Delete</samp> generate <samp>ESC [ 3 ~</samp>.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
X applications are configured so that <samp><</samp> deletes left, and
<samp>Delete</samp> deletes right. Motif applications already work like this.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
Terminals should have <samp>stty erase ^?</samp> .
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
The <samp>xterm</samp> terminfo entry should have <samp>ESC [ 3 ~</samp> for
<samp>kdch1</samp>, just as for <samp>TERM=linux</samp> and
<samp>TERM=vt220</samp>.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
Emacs is programmed to map <samp>KB_Backspace</samp> or the <samp>stty
erase</samp> character to <samp>delete-backward-char</samp>, and
<samp>KB_Delete</samp> or <samp>kdch1</samp> to
<samp>delete-forward-char</samp>, and <samp>^H</samp> to <samp>help</samp> as
always.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
Other applications use the <samp>stty erase</samp> character and
<samp>kdch1</samp> for the two delete keys, with ASCII DEL being "delete
previous character" and <samp>kdch1</samp> being "delete character
under cursor".
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
This will solve the problem except for the following cases:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
Some terminals have a <samp><--</samp> key that cannot be made to produce
anything except <samp>^H</samp>. On these terminals Emacs help will be
unavailable on <samp>^H</samp> (assuming that the <samp>stty erase</samp>
character takes precedence in Emacs, and has been set correctly). <samp>M-x
help</samp> or <samp>F1</samp> (if available) can be used instead.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
Some operating systems use <samp>^H</samp> for <samp>stty erase</samp>.
However, modern telnet versions and all rlogin versions propagate
<samp>stty</samp> settings, and almost all UNIX versions honour <samp>stty
erase</samp>. Where the <samp>stty</samp> settings are not propagated
correctly, things can be made to work by using <samp>stty</samp> manually.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
Some systems (including previous Debian versions) use <code>xmodmap</code> to
arrange for both <samp><--</samp> and <samp>Delete</samp> to generate
<samp>KB_Delete</samp>. We can change the behavior of their X clients using
the same X resources that we use to do it for our own clients, or configure our
clients using their resources when things are the other way around. On
displays configured like this <samp>Delete</samp> will not work, but
<samp><--</samp> will.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
Some operating systems have different <samp>kdch1</samp> settings in their
<samp>terminfo</samp> database for <samp>xterm</samp> and others. On these
systems the <samp>Delete</samp> key will not work correctly when you log in
from a system conforming to our policy, but <samp><--</samp> will.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<hr>
<h2 id="s9.9">9.9 Environment variables</h2>
<p>
A program must not depend on environment variables to get reasonable defaults.
(That's because these environment variables would have to be set in a
system-wide configuration file like <code>/etc/profile</code>, which is not
supported by all shells.)
</p>
<p>
If a program usually depends on environment variables for its configuration,
the program should be changed to fall back to a reasonable default
configuration if these environment variables are not present. If this cannot
be done easily (e.g., if the source code of a non-free program is not
available), the program must be replaced by a small "wrapper" shell
script which sets the environment variables if they are not already defined,
and calls the original program.
</p>
<p>
Here is an example of a wrapper script for this purpose:
</p>
<pre>
#!/bin/sh
BAR=${BAR:-/var/lib/fubar}
export BAR
exec /usr/lib/foo/foo "$@"
</pre>
<p>
Furthermore, as <code>/etc/profile</code> is a configuration file of the
<code>base-files</code> package, other packages must not put any environment
variables or other commands into that file.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-doc-base">9.10 Registering Documents using doc-base</h2>
<p>
The <code>doc-base</code> package implements a flexible mechanism for handling
and presenting documentation. The recommended practice is for every Debian
package that provides online documentation (other than just manual pages) to
register these documents with <code>doc-base</code> by installing a
<code>doc-base</code> control file in <code>/usr/share/doc-base/</code>.
</p>
<p>
Please refer to the documentation that comes with the <code>doc-base</code>
package for information and details.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-alternateinit">9.11 Alternate init systems</h2>
<p>
A number of other init systems are available now in Debian that can be used in
place of <code>sysvinit</code>. Alternative init implementations must support
running SysV init scripts as described at <a href="#s-sysvinit">System run
levels and <code>init.d</code> scripts, Section 9.3</a> for compatibility.
</p>
<p>
Packages may integrate with these replacement init systems by providing
implementation-specific configuration information about how and when to start a
service or in what order to run certain tasks at boot time. However, any
package integrating with other init systems must also be backwards-compatible
with <code>sysvinit</code> by providing a SysV-style init script with the same
name as and equivalent functionality to any init-specific job, as this is the
only start-up configuration method guaranteed to be supported by all init
implementations. An exception to this rule is scripts or jobs provided by the
init implementation itself; such jobs may be required for an
implementation-specific equivalent of the <code>/etc/rcS.d/</code> scripts and
may not have a one-to-one correspondence with the init scripts.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-upstart">9.11.1 Event-based boot with upstart</h3>
<p>
Packages may integrate with the <code>upstart</code> event-based boot system by
installing job files in the <code>/etc/init</code> directory. SysV init
scripts for which an equivalent upstart job is available must query the output
of the command <code>initctl version</code> for the string <samp>upstart</samp>
and avoid running in favor of the native upstart job, using a test such as
this:
</p>
<pre>
if [ "$1" = start ] && which initctl >/dev/null && initctl version | grep -q upstart
then
exit 1
fi
</pre>
<p>
Because packages shipping upstart jobs may be installed on systems that are not
using upstart, maintainer scripts must still use the common
<code>update-rc.d</code> and <code>invoke-rc.d</code> interfaces for
configuring runlevels and for starting and stopping services. These maintainer
scripts must not call the upstart <code>start</code>, <code>restart</code>,
<code>reload</code>, or <code>stop</code> interfaces directly. Instead,
implementations of <code>invoke-rc.d</code> must detect when upstart is running
and when an upstart job with the same name as an init script is present, and
perform the requested action using the upstart job instead of the init script.
</p>
<p>
Dependency-based boot managers for SysV init scripts, such as
<code>startpar</code>, may avoid running a given init script entirely when an
equivalent upstart job is present, to avoid unnecessary forking of no-op init
scripts. In this case, the boot manager should integrate with upstart to
detect when the upstart job in question is started or stopped to know when the
dependency has been satisfied.
</p>
<p><a name="ch-files"></a></p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">1</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">2</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">3</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">4</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">5</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">7</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">9</a> ]
[ 10 ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">11</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">12</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br>Chapter 10 - Files
</h1>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-binaries">10.1 Binaries</h2>
<p>
Two different packages must not install programs with different functionality
but with the same filenames. (The case of two programs having the same
functionality but different implementations is handled via
"alternatives" or the "Conflicts" mechanism. See <a
href="#s-maintscripts">Maintainer Scripts, Section 3.9</a> and <a
href="#s-conflicts">Conflicting binary packages - <samp>Conflicts</samp>,
Section 7.4</a> respectively.) If this case happens, one of the programs must
be renamed. The maintainers should report this to the
<samp>debian-devel</samp> mailing list and try to find a consensus about which
program will have to be renamed. If a consensus cannot be reached,
<em>both</em> programs must be renamed.
</p>
<p>
Binary executables must not be statically linked with the GNU C library, since
this prevents the binary from benefiting from fixes and improvements to the C
library without being rebuilt and complicates security updates. This
requirement may be relaxed for binary executables whose intended purpose is to
diagnose and fix the system in situations where the GNU C library may not be
usable (such as system recovery shells or utilities like ldconfig) or for
binary executables where the security benefits of static linking outweigh the
drawbacks.
</p>
<p>
By default, when a package is being built, any binaries created should include
debugging information, as well as being compiled with optimization. You should
also turn on as many reasonable compilation warnings as possible; this makes
life easier for porters, who can then look at build logs for possible problems.
For the C programming language, this means the following compilation parameters
should be used:
</p>
<pre>
CC = gcc
CFLAGS = -O2 -g -Wall # sane warning options vary between programs
LDFLAGS = # none
INSTALL = install -s # (or use strip on the files in debian/tmp)
</pre>
<p>
Note that by default all installed binaries should be stripped, either by using
the <samp>-s</samp> flag to <code>install</code>, or by calling
<code>strip</code> on the binaries after they have been copied into
<code>debian/tmp</code> but before the tree is made into a package.
</p>
<p>
Although binaries in the build tree should be compiled with debugging
information by default, it can often be difficult to debug programs if they are
also subjected to compiler optimization. For this reason, it is recommended to
support the standardized environment variable <samp>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</samp>
(see <a href="#s-debianrules-options"><code>debian/rules</code> and
<samp>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</samp>, Section 4.9.1</a>). This variable can contain
several flags to change how a package is compiled and built.
</p>
<p>
It is up to the package maintainer to decide what compilation options are best
for the package. Certain binaries (such as computationally-intensive programs)
will function better with certain flags (<samp>-O3</samp>, for example); feel
free to use them. Please use good judgment here. Don't use flags for the sake
of it; only use them if there is good reason to do so. Feel free to override
the upstream author's ideas about which compilation options are best: they are
often inappropriate for our environment.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-libraries">10.2 Libraries</h2>
<p>
If the package is <strong>architecture: any</strong>, then the shared library
compilation and linking flags must have <samp>-fPIC</samp>, or the package
shall not build on some of the supported architectures[<a href="#f84"
name="fr84">84</a>]. Any exception to this rule must be discussed on the
mailing list <em>debian-devel@lists.debian.org</em>, and a rough consensus
obtained. The reasons for not compiling with <samp>-fPIC</samp> flag must be
recorded in the file <samp>README.Debian</samp>, and care must be taken to
either restrict the architecture or arrange for <samp>-fPIC</samp> to be used
on architectures where it is required.[<a href="#f85" name="fr85">85</a>]
</p>
<p>
As to the static libraries, the common case is not to have relocatable code,
since there is no benefit, unless in specific cases; therefore the static
version must not be compiled with the <samp>-fPIC</samp> flag. Any exception
to this rule should be discussed on the mailing list
<em>debian-devel@lists.debian.org</em>, and the reasons for compiling with the
<samp>-fPIC</samp> flag must be recorded in the file
<samp>README.Debian</samp>. [<a href="#f86" name="fr86">86</a>]
</p>
<p>
In other words, if both a shared and a static library is being built, each
source unit (<samp>*.c</samp>, for example, for C files) will need to be
compiled twice, for the normal case.
</p>
<p>
Libraries should be built with threading support and to be thread-safe if the
library supports this.
</p>
<p>
Although not enforced by the build tools, shared libraries must be linked
against all libraries that they use symbols from in the same way that binaries
are. This ensures the correct functioning of the <a
href="#s-sharedlibs-symbols">symbols</a> and <a
href="#s-sharedlibs-shlibdeps">shlibs</a> systems and guarantees that all
libraries can be safely opened with <samp>dlopen()</samp>. Packagers may wish
to use the gcc option <samp>-Wl,-z,defs</samp> when building a shared library.
Since this option enforces symbol resolution at build time, a missing library
reference will be caught early as a fatal build error.
</p>
<p>
All installed shared libraries should be stripped with
</p>
<pre>
strip --strip-unneeded <var>your-lib</var>
</pre>
<p>
(The option <samp>--strip-unneeded</samp> makes <code>strip</code> remove only
the symbols which aren't needed for relocation processing.) Shared libraries
can function perfectly well when stripped, since the symbols for dynamic
linking are in a separate part of the ELF object file.[<a href="#f87"
name="fr87">87</a>]
</p>
<p>
Note that under some circumstances it may be useful to install a shared library
unstripped, for example when building a separate package to support debugging.
</p>
<p>
Shared object files (often <code>.so</code> files) that are not public
libraries, that is, they are not meant to be linked to by third party
executables (binaries of other packages), should be installed in subdirectories
of the <code>/usr/lib</code> directory. Such files are exempt from the rules
that govern ordinary shared libraries, except that they must not be installed
executable and should be stripped.[<a href="#f88" name="fr88">88</a>]
</p>
<p>
Packages that use <code>libtool</code> to create and install their shared
libraries install a file containing additional metadata (ending in
<code>.la</code>) alongside the library. For public libraries intended for use
by other packages, these files normally should not be included in the Debian
package, since the information they include is not necessary to link with the
shared library on Debian and can add unnecessary additional dependencies to
other programs or libraries.[<a href="#f89" name="fr89">89</a>] If the
<code>.la</code> file is required for that library (if, for instance, it's
loaded via <samp>libltdl</samp> in a way that requires that meta-information),
the <samp>dependency_libs</samp> setting in the <code>.la</code> file should
normally be set to the empty string. If the shared library development package
has historically included the <code>.la</code>, it must be retained in the
development package (with <samp>dependency_libs</samp> emptied) until all
libraries that depend on it have removed or emptied
<samp>dependency_libs</samp> in their <code>.la</code> files to prevent linking
with those other libraries using <code>libtool</code> from failing.
</p>
<p>
If the <code>.la</code> must be included, it should be included in the
development (<samp>-dev</samp>) package, unless the library will be loaded by
<code>libtool</code>'s <samp>libltdl</samp> library. If it is intended for use
with <samp>libltdl</samp>, the <code>.la</code> files must go in the run-time
library package.
</p>
<p>
These requirements for handling of <code>.la</code> files do not apply to
loadable modules or libraries not installed in directories searched by default
by the dynamic linker. Packages installing loadable modules will frequently
need to install the <code>.la</code> files alongside the modules so that they
can be loaded by <samp>libltdl</samp>. <samp>dependency_libs</samp> does not
need to be modified for libraries or modules that are not installed in
directories searched by the dynamic linker by default and not intended for use
by other packages.
</p>
<p>
You must make sure that you use only released versions of shared libraries to
build your packages; otherwise other users will not be able to run your
binaries properly. Producing source packages that depend on unreleased
compilers is also usually a bad idea.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s10.3">10.3 Shared libraries</h2>
<p>
This section has moved to <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">Shared libraries, Chapter
8</a>.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-scripts">10.4 Scripts</h2>
<p>
All command scripts, including the package maintainer scripts inside the
package and used by <code>dpkg</code>, should have a <samp>#!</samp> line
naming the shell to be used to interpret them.
</p>
<p>
In the case of Perl scripts this should be <samp>#!/usr/bin/perl</samp>.
</p>
<p>
When scripts are installed into a directory in the system PATH, the script name
should not include an extension such as <samp>.sh</samp> or <samp>.pl</samp>
that denotes the scripting language currently used to implement it.
</p>
<p>
Shell scripts (<code>sh</code> and <code>bash</code>) other than
<code>init.d</code> scripts should almost certainly start with <samp>set
-e</samp> so that errors are detected. <code>init.d</code> scripts are
something of a special case, due to how frequently they need to call commands
that are allowed to fail, and it may instead be easier to check the exit status
of commands directly. See <a href="#s-writing-init">Writing the scripts,
Section 9.3.2</a> for more information about writing <code>init.d</code>
scripts.
</p>
<p>
Every script should use <samp>set -e</samp> or check the exit status of
<em>every</em> command.
</p>
<p>
Scripts may assume that <code>/bin/sh</code> implements the SUSv3 Shell Command
Language[<a href="#f90" name="fr90">90</a>] plus the following additional
features not mandated by SUSv3:[<a href="#f91" name="fr91">91</a>]
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<samp>echo -n</samp>, if implemented as a shell built-in, must not generate a
newline.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<samp>test</samp>, if implemented as a shell built-in, must support
<samp>-a</samp> and <samp>-o</samp> as binary logical operators.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<samp>local</samp> to create a scoped variable must be supported, including
listing multiple variables in a single local command and assigning a value to a
variable at the same time as localizing it. <samp>local</samp> may or may not
preserve the variable value from an outer scope if no assignment is present.
Uses such as:
</p>
<pre>
fname () {
local a b c=delta d
# ... use a, b, c, d ...
}
</pre>
<p>
must be supported and must set the value of <samp>c</samp> to
<samp>delta</samp>.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
The XSI extension to <code>kill</code> allowing <samp>kill
-<var>signal</var></samp>, where <var>signal</var> is either the name of a
signal or one of the numeric signals listed in the XSI extension (0, 1, 2, 3,
6, 9, 14, and 15), must be supported if <code>kill</code> is implemented as a
shell built-in.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
The XSI extension to <code>trap</code> allowing numeric signals must be
supported. In addition to the signal numbers listed in the extension, which
are the same as for <code>kill</code> above, 13 (SIGPIPE) must be allowed.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
If a shell script requires non-SUSv3 features from the shell interpreter other
than those listed above, the appropriate shell must be specified in the first
line of the script (e.g., <samp>#!/bin/bash</samp>) and the package must depend
on the package providing the shell (unless the shell package is marked
"Essential", as in the case of <code>bash</code>).
</p>
<p>
You may wish to restrict your script to SUSv3 features plus the above set when
possible so that it may use <code>/bin/sh</code> as its interpreter. Checking
your script with <code>checkbashisms</code> from the <code>devscripts</code>
package or running your script with an alternate shell such as
<code>posh</code> may help uncover violations of the above requirements. If in
doubt whether a script complies with these requirements, use
<code>/bin/bash</code>.
</p>
<p>
Perl scripts should check for errors when making any system calls, including
<samp>open</samp>, <samp>print</samp>, <samp>close</samp>, <samp>rename</samp>
and <samp>system</samp>.
</p>
<p>
<code>csh</code> and <code>tcsh</code> should be avoided as scripting
languages. See <em>Csh Programming Considered Harmful</em>, one of the
<samp>comp.unix.*</samp> FAQs, which can be found at <code><a
href="http://www.faqs.org/faqs/unix-faq/shell/csh-whynot/">http://www.faqs.org/faqs/unix-faq/shell/csh-whynot/</a></code>.
If an upstream package comes with <code>csh</code> scripts then you must make
sure that they start with <samp>#!/bin/csh</samp> and make your package depend
on the <code>c-shell</code> virtual package.
</p>
<p>
Any scripts which create files in world-writeable directories (e.g., in
<code>/tmp</code>) must use a mechanism which will fail atomically if a file
with the same name already exists.
</p>
<p>
The Debian base system provides the <code>tempfile</code> and
<code>mktemp</code> utilities for use by scripts for this purpose.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s10.5">10.5 Symbolic links</h2>
<p>
In general, symbolic links within a top-level directory should be relative, and
symbolic links pointing from one top-level directory to or into another should
be absolute. (A top-level directory is a sub-directory of the root directory
<code>/</code>.) For example, a symbolic link from <code>/usr/lib/foo</code> to
<code>/usr/share/bar</code> should be relative (<code>../share/bar</code>), but
a symbolic link from <code>/var/run</code> to <code>/run</code> should be
absolute.[<a href="#f92" name="fr92">92</a>] Symbolic links must not traverse
above the root directory.
</p>
<p>
In addition, symbolic links should be specified as short as possible, i.e.,
link targets like <code>foo/../bar</code> are deprecated.
</p>
<p>
Note that when creating a relative link using <code>ln</code> it is not
necessary for the target of the link to exist relative to the working directory
you're running <code>ln</code> from, nor is it necessary to change directory to
the directory where the link is to be made. Simply include the string that
should appear as the target of the link (this will be a pathname relative to
the directory in which the link resides) as the first argument to
<code>ln</code>.
</p>
<p>
For example, in your <code>Makefile</code> or <code>debian/rules</code>, you
can do things like:
</p>
<pre>
ln -fs gcc $(prefix)/bin/cc
ln -fs gcc debian/tmp/usr/bin/cc
ln -fs ../sbin/sendmail $(prefix)/bin/runq
ln -fs ../sbin/sendmail debian/tmp/usr/bin/runq
</pre>
<p>
A symbolic link pointing to a compressed file (in the sense that it is meant to
be uncompressed with <code>unzip</code> or <code>zless</code> etc.) should
always have the same file extension as the referenced file. (For example, if a
file <code>foo.gz</code> is referenced by a symbolic link, the filename of the
link has to end with "<code>.gz</code>" too, as in
<code>bar.gz</code>.)
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s10.6">10.6 Device files</h2>
<p>
Packages must not include device files or named pipes in the package file tree.
</p>
<p>
If a package needs any special device files that are not included in the base
system, it must call <code>MAKEDEV</code> in the <code>postinst</code> script,
after notifying the user[<a href="#f93" name="fr93">93</a>].
</p>
<p>
Packages must not remove any device files in the <code>postrm</code> or any
other script. This is left to the system administrator.
</p>
<p>
Debian uses the serial devices <code>/dev/ttyS*</code>. Programs using the old
<code>/dev/cu*</code> devices should be changed to use <code>/dev/ttyS*</code>.
</p>
<p>
Named pipes needed by the package must be created in the <code>postinst</code>
script[<a href="#f94" name="fr94">94</a>] and removed in the <code>prerm</code>
or <code>postrm</code> script as appropriate.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-config-files">10.7 Configuration files</h2>
<hr>
<h3 id="s10.7.1">10.7.1 Definitions</h3>
<dl>
<dt>configuration file</dt>
<dd>
<p>
A file that affects the operation of a program, or provides site- or
host-specific information, or otherwise customizes the behavior of a program.
Typically, configuration files are intended to be modified by the system
administrator (if needed or desired) to conform to local policy or to provide
more useful site-specific behavior.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>conffile</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
A file listed in a package's <samp>conffiles</samp> file, and is treated
specially by <code>dpkg</code> (see <a href="#s-configdetails">Details of
configuration, Section 6.7</a>).
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<p>
The distinction between these two is important; they are not interchangeable
concepts. Almost all <samp>conffile</samp>s are configuration files, but many
configuration files are not <samp>conffiles</samp>.
</p>
<p>
As noted elsewhere, <code>/etc/init.d</code> scripts, <code>/etc/default</code>
files, scripts installed in
<code>/etc/cron.{hourly,daily,weekly,monthly}</code>, and cron configuration
installed in <code>/etc/cron.d</code> must be treated as configuration files.
In general, any script that embeds configuration information is de-facto a
configuration file and should be treated as such.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s10.7.2">10.7.2 Location</h3>
<p>
Any configuration files created or used by your package must reside in
<code>/etc</code>. If there are several, consider creating a subdirectory of
<code>/etc</code> named after your package.
</p>
<p>
If your package creates or uses configuration files outside of
<code>/etc</code>, and it is not feasible to modify the package to use
<code>/etc</code> directly, put the files in <code>/etc</code> and create
symbolic links to those files from the location that the package requires.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s10.7.3">10.7.3 Behavior</h3>
<p>
Configuration file handling must conform to the following behavior:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
local changes must be preserved during a package upgrade, and
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
configuration files must be preserved when the package is removed, and only
deleted when the package is purged.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
Obsolete configuration files without local changes should be removed by the
package during upgrade.[<a href="#f95" name="fr95">95</a>]
</p>
<p>
The easy way to achieve this behavior is to make the configuration file a
<samp>conffile</samp>. This is appropriate only if it is possible to
distribute a default version that will work for most installations, although
some system administrators may choose to modify it. This implies that the
default version will be part of the package distribution, and must not be
modified by the maintainer scripts during installation (or at any other time).
</p>
<p>
In order to ensure that local changes are preserved correctly, no package may
contain or make hard links to conffiles.[<a href="#f96" name="fr96">96</a>]
</p>
<p>
The other way to do it is via the maintainer scripts. In this case, the
configuration file must not be listed as a <samp>conffile</samp> and must not
be part of the package distribution. If the existence of a file is required
for the package to be sensibly configured it is the responsibility of the
package maintainer to provide maintainer scripts which correctly create, update
and maintain the file and remove it on purge. (See <a
href="#ch-maintainerscripts">Package maintainer scripts and installation
procedure, Chapter 6</a> for more information.) These scripts must be
idempotent (i.e., must work correctly if <code>dpkg</code> needs to re-run them
due to errors during installation or removal), must cope with all the variety
of ways <code>dpkg</code> can call maintainer scripts, must not overwrite or
otherwise mangle the user's configuration without asking, must not ask
unnecessary questions (particularly during upgrades), and must otherwise be
good citizens.
</p>
<p>
The scripts are not required to configure every possible option for the
package, but only those necessary to get the package running on a given system.
Ideally the sysadmin should not have to do any configuration other than that
done (semi-)automatically by the <code>postinst</code> script.
</p>
<p>
A common practice is to create a script called
<code><var>package</var>-configure</code> and have the package's
<code>postinst</code> call it if and only if the configuration file does not
already exist. In certain cases it is useful for there to be an example or
template file which the maintainer scripts use. Such files should be in
<code>/usr/share/<var>package</var></code> or
<code>/usr/lib/<var>package</var></code> (depending on whether they are
architecture-independent or not). There should be symbolic links to them from
<code>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</code> if they are examples,
and should be perfectly ordinary <code>dpkg</code>-handled files (<em>not</em>
configuration files).
</p>
<p>
These two styles of configuration file handling must not be mixed, for that way
lies madness: <code>dpkg</code> will ask about overwriting the file every time
the package is upgraded.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s10.7.4">10.7.4 Sharing configuration files</h3>
<p>
If two or more packages use the same configuration file and it is reasonable
for both to be installed at the same time, one of these packages must be
defined as <em>owner</em> of the configuration file, i.e., it will be the
package which handles that file as a configuration file. Other packages that
use the configuration file must depend on the owning package if they require
the configuration file to operate. If the other package will use the
configuration file if present, but is capable of operating without it, no
dependency need be declared.
</p>
<p>
If it is desirable for two or more related packages to share a configuration
file <em>and</em> for all of the related packages to be able to modify that
configuration file, then the following should be done:
</p>
<!-- ol type="1" start="1" -->
<li>
<p>
One of the related packages (the "owning" package) will manage the
configuration file with maintainer scripts as described in the previous
section.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
The owning package should also provide a program that the other packages may
use to modify the configuration file.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
The related packages must use the provided program to make any desired
modifications to the configuration file. They should either depend on the core
package to guarantee that the configuration modifier program is available or
accept gracefully that they cannot modify the configuration file if it is not.
(This is in addition to the fact that the configuration file may not even be
present in the latter scenario.)
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<p>
Sometimes it's appropriate to create a new package which provides the basic
infrastructure for the other packages and which manages the shared
configuration files. (The <samp>sgml-base</samp> package is a good example.)
</p>
<p>
If the configuration file cannot be shared as described above, the packages
must be marked as conflicting with each other. Two packages that specify the
same file as a <samp>conffile</samp> must conflict. This is an instance of the
general rule about not sharing files. Neither alternatives nor diversions are
likely to be appropriate in this case; in particular, <code>dpkg</code> does
not handle diverted <samp>conffile</samp>s well.
</p>
<p>
When two packages both declare the same <samp>conffile</samp>, they may see
left-over configuration files from each other even though they conflict with
each other. If a user removes (without purging) one of the packages and
installs the other, the new package will take over the <samp>conffile</samp>
from the old package. If the file was modified by the user, it will be treated
the same as any other locally modified <samp>conffile</samp> during an upgrade.
</p>
<p>
The maintainer scripts must not alter a <samp>conffile</samp> of <em>any</em>
package, including the one the scripts belong to.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s10.7.5">10.7.5 User configuration files ("dotfiles")</h3>
<p>
The files in <code>/etc/skel</code> will automatically be copied into new user
accounts by <code>adduser</code>. No other program should reference the files
in <code>/etc/skel</code>.
</p>
<p>
Therefore, if a program needs a dotfile to exist in advance in
<code>$HOME</code> to work sensibly, that dotfile should be installed in
<code>/etc/skel</code> and treated as a configuration file.
</p>
<p>
However, programs that require dotfiles in order to operate sensibly are a bad
thing, unless they do create the dotfiles themselves automatically.
</p>
<p>
Furthermore, programs should be configured by the Debian default installation
to behave as closely to the upstream default behavior as possible.
</p>
<p>
Therefore, if a program in a Debian package needs to be configured in some way
in order to operate sensibly, that should be done using a site-wide
configuration file placed in <code>/etc</code>. Only if the program doesn't
support a site-wide default configuration and the package maintainer doesn't
have time to add it may a default per-user file be placed in
<code>/etc/skel</code>.
</p>
<p>
<code>/etc/skel</code> should be as empty as we can make it. This is
particularly true because there is no easy (or necessarily desirable) mechanism
for ensuring that the appropriate dotfiles are copied into the accounts of
existing users when a package is installed.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s10.8">10.8 Log files</h2>
<p>
Log files should usually be named <code>/var/log/<var>package</var>.log</code>.
If you have many log files, or need a separate directory for permission reasons
(<code>/var/log</code> is writable only by <code>root</code>), you should
usually create a directory named <code>/var/log/<var>package</var></code> and
place your log files there.
</p>
<p>
Log files must be rotated occasionally so that they don't grow indefinitely.
The best way to do this is to install a log rotation configuration file in the
directory <code>/etc/logrotate.d</code>, normally named
<code>/etc/logrotate.d/<var>package</var></code>, and use the facilities
provided by <code>logrotate</code>. [<a href="#f97" name="fr97">97</a>] Here
is a good example for a logrotate config file (for more information see
<code>logrotate(8)</code>):
</p>
<pre>
/var/log/foo/*.log {
rotate 12
weekly
compress
missingok
postrotate
start-stop-daemon -K -p /var/run/foo.pid -s HUP -x /usr/sbin/foo -q
endscript
}
</pre>
<p>
This rotates all files under <code>/var/log/foo</code>, saves 12 compressed
generations, and tells the daemon to reopen its log files after the log
rotation. It skips this log rotation (via <samp>missingok</samp>) if no such
log file is present, which avoids errors if the package is removed but not
purged.
</p>
<p>
Log files should be removed when the package is purged (but not when it is only
removed). This should be done by the <code>postrm</code> script when it is
called with the argument <samp>purge</samp> (see <a
href="#s-removedetails">Details of removal and/or configuration purging,
Section 6.8</a>).
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-permissions-owners">10.9 Permissions and owners</h2>
<p>
The rules in this section are guidelines for general use. If necessary you may
deviate from the details below. However, if you do so you must make sure that
what is done is secure and you should try to be as consistent as possible with
the rest of the system. You should probably also discuss it on
<code>debian-devel</code> first.
</p>
<p>
Files should be owned by <samp>root:root</samp>, and made writable only by the
owner and universally readable (and executable, if appropriate), that is mode
644 or 755.
</p>
<p>
Directories should be mode 755 or (for group-writability) mode 2775. The
ownership of the directory should be consistent with its mode: if a directory
is mode 2775, it should be owned by the group that needs write access to it.[<a
href="#f98" name="fr98">98</a>]
</p>
<p>
Control information files should be owned by <samp>root:root</samp> and either
mode 644 (for most files) or mode 755 (for executables such as <a
href="#s-maintscripts">maintainer scripts</a>).
</p>
<p>
Setuid and setgid executables should be mode 4755 or 2755 respectively, and
owned by the appropriate user or group. They should not be made unreadable
(modes like 4711 or 2711 or even 4111); doing so achieves no extra security,
because anyone can find the binary in the freely available Debian package; it
is merely inconvenient. For the same reason you should not restrict read or
execute permissions on non-set-id executables.
</p>
<p>
Some setuid programs need to be restricted to particular sets of users, using
file permissions. In this case they should be owned by the uid to which they
are set-id, and by the group which should be allowed to execute them. They
should have mode 4754; again there is no point in making them unreadable to
those users who must not be allowed to execute them.
</p>
<p>
It is possible to arrange that the system administrator can reconfigure the
package to correspond to their local security policy by changing the
permissions on a binary: they can do this by using
<code>dpkg-statoverride</code>, as described below.[<a href="#f99"
name="fr99">99</a>] Another method you should consider is to create a group for
people allowed to use the program(s) and make any setuid executables executable
only by that group.
</p>
<p>
If you need to create a new user or group for your package there are two
possibilities. Firstly, you may need to make some files in the binary package
be owned by this user or group, or you may need to compile the user or group id
(rather than just the name) into the binary (though this latter should be
avoided if possible, as in this case you need a statically allocated id).
</p>
<p>
If you need a statically allocated id, you must ask for a user or group id from
the <samp>base-passwd</samp> maintainer, and must not release the package until
you have been allocated one. Once you have been allocated one you must either
make the package depend on a version of the <samp>base-passwd</samp> package
with the id present in <code>/etc/passwd</code> or <code>/etc/group</code>, or
arrange for your package to create the user or group itself with the correct id
(using <samp>adduser</samp>) in its <code>preinst</code> or
<code>postinst</code>. (Doing it in the <code>postinst</code> is to be
preferred if it is possible, otherwise a pre-dependency will be needed on the
<samp>adduser</samp> package.)
</p>
<p>
On the other hand, the program might be able to determine the uid or gid from
the user or group name at runtime, so that a dynamically allocated id can be
used. In this case you should choose an appropriate user or group name,
discussing this on <code>debian-devel</code> and checking with the
<code>base-passwd</code> maintainer that it is unique and that they do not wish
you to use a statically allocated id instead. When this has been checked you
must arrange for your package to create the user or group if necessary using
<code>adduser</code> in the <code>preinst</code> or <code>postinst</code>
script (again, the latter is to be preferred if it is possible).
</p>
<p>
Note that changing the numeric value of an id associated with a name is very
difficult, and involves searching the file system for all appropriate files.
You need to think carefully whether a static or dynamic id is required, since
changing your mind later will cause problems.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s10.9.1">10.9.1 The use of <code>dpkg-statoverride</code></h3>
<p>
This section is not intended as policy, but as a description of the use of
<code>dpkg-statoverride</code>.
</p>
<p>
If a system administrator wishes to have a file (or directory or other such
thing) installed with owner and permissions different from those in the
distributed Debian package, they can use the <code>dpkg-statoverride</code>
program to instruct <code>dpkg</code> to use the different settings every time
the file is installed. Thus the package maintainer should distribute the files
with their normal permissions, and leave it for the system administrator to
make any desired changes. For example, a daemon which is normally required to
be setuid root, but in certain situations could be used without being setuid,
should be installed setuid in the <samp>.deb</samp>. Then the local system
administrator can change this if they wish. If there are two standard ways of
doing it, the package maintainer can use <samp>debconf</samp> to find out the
preference, and call <code>dpkg-statoverride</code> in the maintainer script if
necessary to accommodate the system administrator's choice. Care must be taken
during upgrades to not override an existing setting.
</p>
<p>
Given the above, <code>dpkg-statoverride</code> is essentially a tool for
system administrators and would not normally be needed in the maintainer
scripts. There is one type of situation, though, where calls to
<code>dpkg-statoverride</code> would be needed in the maintainer scripts, and
that involves packages which use dynamically allocated user or group ids. In
such a situation, something like the following idiom can be very helpful in the
package's <code>postinst</code>, where <samp>sysuser</samp> is a dynamically
allocated id:
</p>
<pre>
for i in /usr/bin/foo /usr/sbin/bar
do
# only do something when no setting exists
if ! dpkg-statoverride --list $i >/dev/null 2>&1
then
#include: debconf processing, question about foo and bar
if [ "$RET" = "true" ] ; then
dpkg-statoverride --update --add sysuser root 4755 $i
fi
fi
done
</pre>
<p>
The corresponding code to remove the override when the package is purged would
be:
</p>
<pre>
for i in /usr/bin/foo /usr/sbin/bar
do
if dpkg-statoverride --list $i >/dev/null 2>&1
then
dpkg-statoverride --remove $i
fi
done
</pre>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-filenames">10.10 File names</h2>
<p>
The name of the files installed by binary packages in the system PATH (namely
<samp>/bin</samp>, <samp>/sbin</samp>, <samp>/usr/bin</samp>,
<samp>/usr/sbin</samp> and <samp>/usr/games</samp>) must be encoded in ASCII.
</p>
<p>
The name of the files and directories installed by binary packages outside the
system PATH must be encoded in UTF-8 and should be restricted to ASCII when it
is possible to do so.
</p>
<p><a name="ch-customized-programs"></a></p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#ch-files">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">1</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">2</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">3</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">4</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">5</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">7</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">9</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">10</a> ]
[ 11 ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">12</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br>Chapter 11 - Customized programs
</h1>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-arch-spec">11.1 Architecture specification strings</h2>
<p>
If a program needs to specify an <em>architecture specification string</em> in
some place, it should select one of the strings provided by
<samp>dpkg-architecture -L</samp>. The strings are in the format
<samp><var>os</var>-<var>arch</var></samp>, though the OS part is sometimes
elided, as when the OS is Linux.
</p>
<p>
Note that we don't want to use <samp><var>arch</var>-debian-linux</samp> to
apply to the rule
<samp><var>architecture</var>-<var>vendor</var>-<var>os</var></samp> since this
would make our programs incompatible with other Linux distributions. We also
don't use something like <samp><var>arch</var>-unknown-linux</samp>, since the
<samp>unknown</samp> does not look very good.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-arch-wildcard-spec">11.1.1 Architecture wildcards</h3>
<p>
A package may specify an architecture wildcard. Architecture wildcards are in
the format <samp>any</samp> (which matches every architecture),
<samp><var>os</var></samp>-any, or any-<samp><var>cpu</var></samp>. [<a
href="#f100" name="fr100">100</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s11.2">11.2 Daemons</h2>
<p>
The configuration files <code>/etc/services</code>,
<code>/etc/protocols</code>, and <code>/etc/rpc</code> are managed by the
<code>netbase</code> package and must not be modified by other packages.
</p>
<p>
If a package requires a new entry in one of these files, the maintainer should
get in contact with the <code>netbase</code> maintainer, who will add the
entries and release a new version of the <code>netbase</code> package.
</p>
<p>
The configuration file <code>/etc/inetd.conf</code> must not be modified by the
package's scripts except via the <code>update-inetd</code> script or the
<code>DebianNet.pm</code> Perl module. See their documentation for details on
how to add entries.
</p>
<p>
If a package wants to install an example entry into
<code>/etc/inetd.conf</code>, the entry must be preceded with exactly one hash
character (<samp>#</samp>). Such lines are treated as "commented out by
user" by the <code>update-inetd</code> script and are not changed or
activated during package updates.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s11.3">11.3 Using pseudo-ttys and modifying wtmp, utmp and lastlog</h2>
<p>
Some programs need to create pseudo-ttys. This should be done using Unix98
ptys if the C library supports it. The resulting program must not be installed
setuid root, unless that is required for other functionality.
</p>
<p>
The files <code>/var/run/utmp</code>, <code>/var/log/wtmp</code> and
<code>/var/log/lastlog</code> must be installed writable by group
<samp>utmp</samp>. Programs which need to modify those files must be installed
setgid <samp>utmp</samp>.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s11.4">11.4 Editors and pagers</h2>
<p>
Some programs have the ability to launch an editor or pager program to edit or
display a text document. Since there are lots of different editors and pagers
available in the Debian distribution, the system administrator and each user
should have the possibility to choose their preferred editor and pager.
</p>
<p>
In addition, every program should choose a good default editor/pager if none is
selected by the user or system administrator.
</p>
<p>
Thus, every program that launches an editor or pager must use the EDITOR or
PAGER environment variable to determine the editor or pager the user wishes to
use. If these variables are not set, the programs <code>/usr/bin/editor</code>
and <code>/usr/bin/pager</code> should be used, respectively.
</p>
<p>
These two files are managed through the <code>dpkg</code>
"alternatives" mechanism. Every package providing an editor or pager
must call the <code>update-alternatives</code> script to register as an
alternative for <code>/usr/bin/editor</code> or <code>/usr/bin/pager</code> as
appropriate. The alternative should have a slave alternative for
<code>/usr/share/man/man1/editor.1.gz</code> or
<code>/usr/share/man/man1/pager.1.gz</code> pointing to the corresponding
manual page.
</p>
<p>
If it is very hard to adapt a program to make use of the EDITOR or PAGER
variables, that program may be configured to use
<code>/usr/bin/sensible-editor</code> and <code>/usr/bin/sensible-pager</code>
as the editor or pager program respectively. These are two scripts provided in
the <code>sensible-utils</code> package that check the EDITOR and PAGER
variables and launch the appropriate program, and fall back to
<code>/usr/bin/editor</code> and <code>/usr/bin/pager</code> if the variable is
not set.
</p>
<p>
A program may also use the VISUAL environment variable to determine the user's
choice of editor. If it exists, it should take precedence over EDITOR. This
is in fact what <code>/usr/bin/sensible-editor</code> does.
</p>
<p>
It is not required for a package to depend on <samp>editor</samp> and
<samp>pager</samp>, nor is it required for a package to provide such virtual
packages.[<a href="#f101" name="fr101">101</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-web-appl">11.5 Web servers and applications</h2>
<p>
This section describes the locations and URLs that should be used by all web
servers and web applications in the Debian system.
</p>
<ol type="1" start="1" >
<li>
<p>
Cgi-bin executable files are installed in the directory
</p>
<pre>
/usr/lib/cgi-bin
</pre>
<p>
or a subdirectory of that directory, and the script
</p>
<pre>
/usr/lib/cgi-bin/.../<var>cgi-bin-name</var>
</pre>
<p>
should be referred to as
</p>
<pre>
http://localhost/cgi-bin/.../<var>cgi-bin-name</var>
</pre>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="2" >
<li>
<p>
(Deleted)
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="3" >
<li>
<p>
Access to images
</p>
<p>
It is recommended that images for a package be stored in
<samp>/usr/share/images/<var>package</var></samp> and may be referred to
through an alias <samp>/images/</samp> as
</p>
<pre>
http://localhost/images/<package>/<filename>
</pre>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="4" >
<li>
<p>
Web Document Root
</p>
<p>
Web Applications should try to avoid storing files in the Web Document Root.
Instead they should use the /usr/share/doc/<var>package</var> directory for
documents and register the Web Application via the <code>doc-base</code>
package. If access to the web document root is unavoidable then use
</p>
<pre>
/var/www/html
</pre>
<p>
as the Document Root. This might be just a symbolic link to the location where
the system administrator has put the real document root.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="5" >
<li>
<p>
Providing httpd and/or httpd-cgi
</p>
<p>
All web servers should provide the virtual package <samp>httpd</samp>. If a
web server has CGI support it should provide <samp>httpd-cgi</samp>
additionally.
</p>
<p>
All web applications which do not contain CGI scripts should depend on
<samp>httpd</samp>, all those web applications which <samp>do</samp> contain
CGI scripts, should depend on <samp>httpd-cgi</samp>.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-mail-transport-agents">11.6 Mail transport, delivery and user agents</h2>
<p>
Debian packages which process electronic mail, whether mail user agents (MUAs)
or mail transport agents (MTAs), must ensure that they are compatible with the
configuration decisions below. Failure to do this may result in lost mail,
broken <samp>From:</samp> lines, and other serious brain damage!
</p>
<p>
The mail spool is <code>/var/mail</code> and the interface to send a mail
message is <code>/usr/sbin/sendmail</code> (as per the FHS). On older systems,
the mail spool may be physically located in <code>/var/spool/mail</code>, but
all access to the mail spool should be via the <code>/var/mail</code> symlink.
The mail spool is part of the base system and not part of the MTA package.
</p>
<p>
All Debian MUAs, MTAs, MDAs and other mailbox accessing programs (such as IMAP
daemons) must lock the mailbox in an NFS-safe way. This means that
<samp>fcntl()</samp> locking must be combined with dot locking. To avoid
deadlocks, a program should use <samp>fcntl()</samp> first and dot locking
after this, or alternatively implement the two locking methods in a non
blocking way[<a href="#f102" name="fr102">102</a>]. Using the functions
<samp>maillock</samp> and <samp>mailunlock</samp> provided by the
<samp>liblockfile*</samp>[<a href="#f103" name="fr103">103</a>] packages is the
recommended way to realize this.
</p>
<p>
Mailboxes are generally either mode 600 and owned by <var>user</var> or mode
660 and owned by <samp><var>user</var>:mail</samp>[<a href="#f104"
name="fr104">104</a>]. The local system administrator may choose a different
permission scheme; packages should not make assumptions about the permission
and ownership of mailboxes unless required (such as when creating a new
mailbox). A MUA may remove a mailbox (unless it has nonstandard permissions)
in which case the MTA or another MUA must recreate it if needed.
</p>
<p>
The mail spool is 2775 <samp>root:mail</samp>, and MUAs should be setgid mail
to do the locking mentioned above (and must obviously avoid accessing other
users' mailboxes using this privilege).
</p>
<p>
<code>/etc/aliases</code> is the source file for the system mail aliases (e.g.,
postmaster, usenet, etc.), it is the one which the sysadmin and
<code>postinst</code> scripts may edit. After <code>/etc/aliases</code> is
edited the program or human editing it must call <code>newaliases</code>. All
MTA packages must come with a <code>newaliases</code> program, even if it does
nothing, but older MTA packages did not do this so programs should not fail if
<code>newaliases</code> cannot be found. Note that because of this, all MTA
packages must have <samp>Provides</samp>, <samp>Conflicts</samp> and
<samp>Replaces: mail-transport-agent</samp> control fields.
</p>
<p>
The convention of writing <samp>forward to <var>address</var></samp> in the
mailbox itself is not supported. Use a <samp>.forward</samp> file instead.
</p>
<p>
The <code>rmail</code> program used by UUCP for incoming mail should be
<code>/usr/sbin/rmail</code>. Likewise, <code>rsmtp</code>, for receiving
batch-SMTP-over-UUCP, should be <code>/usr/sbin/rsmtp</code> if it is
supported.
</p>
<p>
If your package needs to know what hostname to use on (for example) outgoing
news and mail messages which are generated locally, you should use the file
<code>/etc/mailname</code>. It will contain the portion after the username and
<samp>@</samp> (at) sign for email addresses of users on the machine (followed
by a newline).
</p>
<p>
Such a package should check for the existence of this file when it is being
configured. If it exists, it should be used without comment, although an MTA's
configuration script may wish to prompt the user even if it finds that this
file exists. If the file does not exist, the package should prompt the user
for the value (preferably using <code>debconf</code>) and store it in
<code>/etc/mailname</code> as well as using it in the package's configuration.
The prompt should make it clear that the name will not just be used by that
package. For example, in this situation the <samp>inn</samp> package could say
something like:
</p>
<pre>
Please enter the "mail name" of your system. This is the
hostname portion of the address to be shown on outgoing
news and mail messages. The default is
<var>syshostname</var>, your system's host name. Mail
name ["<var>syshostname</var>"]:
</pre>
<p>
where <var>syshostname</var> is the output of <samp>hostname --fqdn</samp>.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s11.7">11.7 News system configuration</h2>
<p>
All the configuration files related to the NNTP (news) servers and clients
should be located under <code>/etc/news</code>.
</p>
<p>
There are some configuration issues that apply to a number of news clients and
server packages on the machine. These are:
</p>
<dl>
<dt><code>/etc/news/organization</code></dt>
<dd>
<p>
A string which should appear as the organization header for all messages posted
by NNTP clients on the machine
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><code>/etc/news/server</code></dt>
<dd>
<p>
Contains the FQDN of the upstream NNTP server, or localhost if the local
machine is an NNTP server.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<p>
Other global files may be added as required for cross-package news
configuration.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s11.8">11.8 Programs for the X Window System</h2>
<hr>
<h3 id="s11.8.1">11.8.1 Providing X support and package priorities</h3>
<p>
Programs that can be configured with support for the X Window System must be
configured to do so and must declare any package dependencies necessary to
satisfy their runtime requirements when using the X Window System. If such a
package is of higher priority than the X packages on which it depends, it is
required that either the X-specific components be split into a separate
package, or that an alternative version of the package, which includes X
support, be provided, or that the package's priority be lowered.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s11.8.2">11.8.2 Packages providing an X server</h3>
<p>
Packages that provide an X server that, directly or indirectly, communicates
with real input and display hardware should declare in their
<samp>Provides</samp> control field that they provide the virtual package
<samp>xserver</samp>.[<a href="#f105" name="fr105">105</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s11.8.3">11.8.3 Packages providing a terminal emulator</h3>
<p>
Packages that provide a terminal emulator for the X Window System which meet
the criteria listed below should declare in their <samp>Provides</samp> control
field that they provide the virtual package <samp>x-terminal-emulator</samp>.
They should also register themselves as an alternative for
<code>/usr/bin/x-terminal-emulator</code>, with a priority of 20. That
alternative should have a slave alternative for
<code>/usr/share/man/man1/x-terminal-emulator.1.gz</code> pointing to the
corresponding manual page.
</p>
<p>
To be an <samp>x-terminal-emulator</samp>, a program must:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
Be able to emulate a DEC VT100 terminal, or a compatible terminal.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Support the command-line option <samp>-e <var>command</var></samp>, which
creates a new terminal window[<a href="#f106" name="fr106">106</a>] and runs
the specified <var>command</var>, interpreting the entirety of the rest of the
command line as a command to pass straight to exec, in the manner that
<samp>xterm</samp> does.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Support the command-line option <samp>-T <var>title</var></samp>, which creates
a new terminal window with the window title <var>title</var>.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<hr>
<h3 id="s11.8.4">11.8.4 Packages providing a window manager</h3>
<p>
Packages that provide a window manager should declare in their
<samp>Provides</samp> control field that they provide the virtual package
<samp>x-window-manager</samp>. They should also register themselves as an
alternative for <code>/usr/bin/x-window-manager</code>, with a priority
calculated as follows:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
Start with a priority of 20.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
If the window manager supports the Debian menu system, add 20 points if this
support is available in the package's default configuration (i.e., no
configuration files belonging to the system or user have to be edited to
activate the feature); if configuration files must be modified, add only 10
points.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
If the window manager complies with <code><a
href="http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec">The Window
Manager Specification Project</a></code>, written by the <code><a
href="http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/">Free Desktop Group</a></code>, add 40
points.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
If the window manager permits the X session to be restarted using a
<em>different</em> window manager (without killing the X server) in its default
configuration, add 10 points; otherwise add none.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
That alternative should have a slave alternative for
<code>/usr/share/man/man1/x-window-manager.1.gz</code> pointing to the
corresponding manual page.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s11.8.5">11.8.5 Packages providing fonts</h3>
<p>
Packages that provide fonts for the X Window System[<a href="#f107"
name="fr107">107</a>] must do a number of things to ensure that they are both
available without modification of the X or font server configuration, and that
they do not corrupt files used by other font packages to register information
about themselves.
</p>
<ol type="1" start="1" >
<li>
<p>
Fonts of any type supported by the X Window System must be in a separate binary
package from any executables, libraries, or documentation (except that specific
to the fonts shipped, such as their license information). If one or more of
the fonts so packaged are necessary for proper operation of the package with
which they are associated the font package may be Recommended; if the fonts
merely provide an enhancement, a Suggests relationship may be used. Packages
must not Depend on font packages.[<a href="#f108" name="fr108">108</a>]
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="2" >
<li>
<p>
BDF fonts must be converted to PCF fonts with the <code>bdftopcf</code> utility
(available in the <samp>xfonts-utils</samp> package, <code>gzip</code>ped, and
placed in a directory that corresponds to their resolution:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
100 dpi fonts must be placed in <code>/usr/share/fonts/X11/100dpi/</code>.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
75 dpi fonts must be placed in <code>/usr/share/fonts/X11/75dpi/</code>.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Character-cell fonts, cursor fonts, and other low-resolution fonts must be
placed in <code>/usr/share/fonts/X11/misc/</code>.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="3" >
<li>
<p>
Type 1 fonts must be placed in <code>/usr/share/fonts/X11/Type1/</code>. If
font metric files are available, they must be placed here as well.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="4" >
<li>
<p>
Subdirectories of <code>/usr/share/fonts/X11/</code> other than those listed
above must be neither created nor used. (The <code>PEX</code>,
<code>CID</code>, <code>Speedo</code>, and <code>cyrillic</code> directories
are excepted for historical reasons, but installation of files into these
directories remains discouraged.)
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="5" >
<li>
<p>
Font packages may, instead of placing files directly in the X font directories
listed above, provide symbolic links in that font directory pointing to the
files' actual location in the filesystem. Such a location must comply with the
FHS.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="6" >
<li>
<p>
Font packages should not contain both 75dpi and 100dpi versions of a font. If
both are available, they should be provided in separate binary packages with
<samp>-75dpi</samp> or <samp>-100dpi</samp> appended to the names of the
packages containing the corresponding fonts.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="7" >
<li>
<p>
Fonts destined for the <code>misc</code> subdirectory should not be included in
the same package as 75dpi or 100dpi fonts; instead, they should be provided in
a separate package with <samp>-misc</samp> appended to its name.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="8" >
<li>
<p>
Font packages must not provide the files <code>fonts.dir</code>,
<code>fonts.alias</code>, or <code>fonts.scale</code> in a font directory:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<code>fonts.dir</code> files must not be provided at all.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
<code>fonts.alias</code> and <code>fonts.scale</code> files, if needed, should
be provided in the directory
<code>/etc/X11/fonts/<var>fontdir</var>/<var>package</var>.<var>extension</var></code>,
where <var>fontdir</var> is the name of the subdirectory of
<code>/usr/share/fonts/X11/</code> where the package's corresponding fonts are
stored (e.g., <samp>75dpi</samp> or <samp>misc</samp>), <var>package</var> is
the name of the package that provides these fonts, and <var>extension</var> is
either <samp>scale</samp> or <samp>alias</samp>, whichever corresponds to the
file contents.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="9" >
<li>
<p>
Font packages must declare a dependency on <samp>xfonts-utils</samp> in their
<samp>Depends</samp> or <samp>Pre-Depends</samp> control field.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="10" >
<li>
<p>
Font packages that provide one or more <code>fonts.scale</code> files as
described above must invoke <code>update-fonts-scale</code> on each directory
into which they installed fonts <em>before</em> invoking
<code>update-fonts-dir</code> on that directory. This invocation must occur in
both the <code>postinst</code> (for all arguments) and <code>postrm</code> (for
all arguments except <samp>upgrade</samp>) scripts.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="11" >
<li>
<p>
Font packages that provide one or more <code>fonts.alias</code> files as
described above must invoke <code>update-fonts-alias</code> on each directory
into which they installed fonts. This invocation must occur in both the
<code>postinst</code> (for all arguments) and <code>postrm</code> (for all
arguments except <samp>upgrade</samp>) scripts.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="12" >
<li>
<p>
Font packages must invoke <code>update-fonts-dir</code> on each directory into
which they installed fonts. This invocation must occur in both the
<code>postinst</code> (for all arguments) and <code>postrm</code> (for all
arguments except <samp>upgrade</samp>) scripts.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="13" >
<li>
<p>
Font packages must not provide alias names for the fonts they include which
collide with alias names already in use by fonts already packaged.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<ol type="1" start="14" >
<li>
<p>
Font packages must not provide fonts with the same XLFD registry name as
another font already packaged.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-appdefaults">11.8.6 Application defaults files</h3>
<p>
Application defaults files must be installed in the directory
<code>/etc/X11/app-defaults/</code> (use of a localized subdirectory of
<code>/etc/X11/</code> as described in the <em>X Toolkit Intrinsics - C
Language Interface</em> manual is also permitted). They must be registered as
<samp>conffile</samp>s or handled as configuration files.
</p>
<p>
Customization of programs' X resources may also be supported with the provision
of a file with the same name as that of the package placed in the
<code>/etc/X11/Xresources/</code> directory, which must be registered as a
<samp>conffile</samp> or handled as a configuration file.[<a href="#f109"
name="fr109">109</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s11.8.7">11.8.7 Installation directory issues</h3>
<p>
Historically, packages using the X Window System used a separate set of
installation directories from other packages. This practice has been
discontinued and packages using the X Window System should now generally be
installed in the same directories as any other package. Specifically, packages
must not install files under the <code>/usr/X11R6/</code> directory and the
<code>/usr/X11R6/</code> directory hierarchy should be regarded as obsolete.
</p>
<p>
Include files previously installed under <code>/usr/X11R6/include/X11/</code>
should be installed into <code>/usr/include/X11/</code>. For files previously
installed into subdirectories of <code>/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/</code>, package
maintainers should determine if subdirectories of <code>/usr/lib/</code> and
<code>/usr/share/</code> can be used. If not, a subdirectory of
<code>/usr/lib/X11/</code> should be used.
</p>
<p>
Configuration files for window, display, or session managers or other
applications that are tightly integrated with the X Window System may be placed
in a subdirectory of <code>/etc/X11/</code> corresponding to the package name.
Other X Window System applications should use the <code>/etc/</code> directory
unless otherwise mandated by policy (such as for <a
href="#s-appdefaults">Application defaults files, Section 11.8.6</a>).
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-perl">11.9 Perl programs and modules</h2>
<p>
Perl programs and modules should follow the current Perl policy.
</p>
<p>
The Perl policy can be found in the <samp>perl-policy</samp> files in the
<samp>debian-policy</samp> package. It is also available from the Debian web
mirrors at <samp><code><a
href="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/perl-policy/">/doc/packaging-manuals/perl-policy/</a></code></samp>.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-emacs">11.10 Emacs lisp programs</h2>
<p>
Please refer to the "Debian Emacs Policy" for details of how to
package emacs lisp programs.
</p>
<p>
The Emacs policy is available in <code>debian-emacs-policy.gz</code> of the
<code>emacsen-common</code> package. It is also available from the Debian web
mirrors at <samp><code><a
href="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/debian-emacs-policy">/doc/packaging-manuals/debian-emacs-policy</a></code></samp>.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s11.11">11.11 Games</h2>
<p>
The permissions on <code>/var/games</code> are mode 755, owner
<samp>root</samp> and group <samp>root</samp>.
</p>
<p>
Each game decides on its own security policy.
</p>
<p>
Games which require protected, privileged access to high-score files, saved
games, etc., may be made set-<em>group</em>-id (mode 2755) and owned by
<samp>root:games</samp>, and use files and directories with appropriate
permissions (770 <samp>root:games</samp>, for example). They must not be made
set-<em>user</em>-id, as this causes security problems. (If an attacker can
subvert any set-user-id game they can overwrite the executable of any other,
causing other players of these games to run a Trojan horse program. With a
set-group-id game the attacker only gets access to less important game data,
and if they can get at the other players' accounts at all it will take
considerably more effort.)
</p>
<p>
Some packages, for example some fortune cookie programs, are configured by the
upstream authors to install with their data files or other static information
made unreadable so that they can only be accessed through set-id programs
provided. You should not do this in a Debian package: anyone can download the
<code>.deb</code> file and read the data from it, so there is no point making
the files unreadable. Not making the files unreadable also means that you
don't have to make so many programs set-id, which reduces the risk of a
security hole.
</p>
<p>
As described in the FHS, binaries of games should be installed in the directory
<code>/usr/games</code>. This also applies to games that use the X Window
System. Manual pages for games (X and non-X games) should be installed in
<code>/usr/share/man/man6</code>.
</p>
<p><a name="ch-docs"></a></p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">1</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">2</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">3</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">4</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">5</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">7</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">9</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">10</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">11</a> ]
[ 12 ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br>Chapter 12 - Documentation
</h1>
<hr>
<h2 id="s12.1">12.1 Manual pages</h2>
<p>
You should install manual pages in <code>nroff</code> source form, in
appropriate places under <code>/usr/share/man</code>. You should only use
sections 1 to 9 (see the FHS for more details). You must not install a
pre-formatted "cat page".
</p>
<p>
Each program, utility, and function should have an associated manual page
included in the same package. It is suggested that all configuration files
also have a manual page included as well. Manual pages for protocols and other
auxiliary things are optional.
</p>
<p>
If no manual page is available, this is considered as a bug and should be
reported to the Debian Bug Tracking System (the maintainer of the package is
allowed to write this bug report themselves, if they so desire). Do not close
the bug report until a proper man page is available.[<a href="#f110"
name="fr110">110</a>]
</p>
<p>
You may forward a complaint about a missing man page to the upstream authors,
and mark the bug as forwarded in the Debian bug tracking system. Even though
the GNU Project do not in general consider the lack of a man page to be a bug,
we do; if they tell you that they don't consider it a bug you should leave the
bug in our bug tracking system open anyway.
</p>
<p>
Manual pages should be installed compressed using <samp>gzip -9</samp>.
</p>
<p>
If one man page needs to be accessible via several names it is better to use a
symbolic link than the <code>.so</code> feature, but there is no need to fiddle
with the relevant parts of the upstream source to change from <code>.so</code>
to symlinks: don't do it unless it's easy. You should not create hard links in
the manual page directories, nor put absolute filenames in <code>.so</code>
directives. The filename in a <code>.so</code> in a man page should be
relative to the base of the man page tree (usually
<code>/usr/share/man</code>). If you do not create any links (whether
symlinks, hard links, or <samp>.so</samp> directives) in the file system to the
alternate names of the man page, then you should not rely on <code>man</code>
finding your man page under those names based solely on the information in the
man page's header.[<a href="#f111" name="fr111">111</a>]
</p>
<p>
Manual pages in locale-specific subdirectories of <code>/usr/share/man</code>
should use either UTF-8 or the usual legacy encoding for that language
(normally the one corresponding to the shortest relevant locale name in
<code>/usr/share/i18n/SUPPORTED</code>). For example, pages under
<code>/usr/share/man/fr</code> should use either UTF-8 or ISO-8859-1.[<a
href="#f112" name="fr112">112</a>]
</p>
<p>
A country name (the <samp>DE</samp> in <samp>de_DE</samp>) should not be
included in the subdirectory name unless it indicates a significant difference
in the language, as this excludes speakers of the language in other
countries.[<a href="#f113" name="fr113">113</a>]
</p>
<p>
If a localized version of a manual page is provided, it should either be
up-to-date or it should be obvious to the reader that it is outdated and the
original manual page should be used instead. This can be done either by a note
at the beginning of the manual page or by showing the missing or changed
portions in the original language instead of the target language.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s12.2">12.2 Info documents</h2>
<p>
Info documents should be installed in <code>/usr/share/info</code>. They
should be compressed with <samp>gzip -9</samp>.
</p>
<p>
The <code>install-info</code> program maintains a directory of installed info
documents in <code>/usr/share/info/dir</code> for the use of info readers.
This file must not be included in packages other than
<code>install-info</code>.
</p>
<p>
<code>install-info</code> is automatically invoked when appropriate using dpkg
triggers. Packages other than <code>install-info</code> <em>should not</em>
invoke <code>install-info</code> directly and <em>should not</em> depend on,
recommend, or suggest <code>install-info</code> for this purpose.
</p>
<p>
Info readers requiring the <code>/usr/share/info/dir</code> file should depend
on <code>install-info</code>.
</p>
<p>
Info documents should contain section and directory entry information in the
document for the use of <code>install-info</code>. The section should be
specified via a line starting with <samp>INFO-DIR-SECTION</samp> followed by a
space and the section of this info page. The directory entry or entries should
be included between a <samp>START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY</samp> line and an
<samp>END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY</samp> line. For example:
</p>
<pre>
INFO-DIR-SECTION Individual utilities
START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
* example: (example). An example info directory entry.
END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
</pre>
<p>
To determine which section to use, you should look at
<code>/usr/share/info/dir</code> on your system and choose the most relevant
(or create a new section if none of the current sections are relevant).[<a
href="#f114" name="fr114">114</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-docs-additional">12.3 Additional documentation</h2>
<p>
Any additional documentation that comes with the package may be installed at
the discretion of the package maintainer. It is often a good idea to include
text information files (<code>README</code>s, FAQs, and so forth) that come
with the source package in the binary package. However, you don't need to
install the instructions for building and installing the package, of course!
</p>
<p>
Plain text documentation should be compressed with <samp>gzip -9</samp> unless
it is small.
</p>
<p>
If a package comes with large amounts of documentation that many users of the
package will not require, you should create a separate binary package to
contain it so that it does not take up disk space on the machines of users who
do not need or want it installed. As a special case of this rule, shared
library documentation of any appreciable size should always be packaged with
the library development package (<a href="#s-sharedlibs-dev">Development files,
Section 8.4</a>) or in a separate documentation package, since shared libraries
are frequently installed as dependencies of other packages by users who have
little interest in documentation of the library itself. The documentation
package for the package <var>package</var> is conventionally named
<var>package</var>-doc (or <var>package</var>-doc-<var>language-code</var> if
there are separate documentation packages for multiple languages).
</p>
<p>
Additional documentation included in the package should be installed under
<code>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></code>. If the documentation is
packaged separately, as <var>package</var>-doc for example, it may be installed
under either that path or into the documentation directory for the separate
documentation package (<code>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>-doc</code> in
this example). However, installing the documentation into the documentation
directory of the main package is preferred since it is independent of the
packaging method and will be easier for users to find.
</p>
<p>
Any separate package providing documentation must still install standard
documentation files in its own <code>/usr/share/doc</code> directory as
specified in the rest of this policy. See, for example, <a
href="#s-copyrightfile">Copyright information, Section 12.5</a> and <a
href="#s-changelogs">Changelog files, Section 12.7</a>.
</p>
<p>
Packages must not require the existence of any files in
<code>/usr/share/doc/</code> in order to function [<a href="#f115"
name="fr115">115</a>]. Any files that are used or read by programs but are
also useful as stand alone documentation should be installed elsewhere, such as
under <code>/usr/share/<var>package</var>/</code>, and then included via
symbolic links in <code>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></code>.
</p>
<p>
<code>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></code> may be a symbolic link to
another directory in <code>/usr/share/doc</code> only if the two packages both
come from the same source and the first package Depends on the second.[<a
href="#f116" name="fr116">116</a>]
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s12.4">12.4 Preferred documentation formats</h2>
<p>
The unification of Debian documentation is being carried out via HTML.
</p>
<p>
If the package comes with extensive documentation in a markup format that can
be converted to various other formats you should if possible ship HTML versions
in a binary package.[<a href="#f117" name="fr117">117</a>] The documentation
must be installed as specified in <a href="#s-docs-additional">Additional
documentation, Section 12.3</a>.
</p>
<p>
Other formats such as PostScript may be provided at the package maintainer's
discretion.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-copyrightfile">12.5 Copyright information</h2>
<p>
Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of its copyright
information and distribution license in the file
<code>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</code>. This file must
neither be compressed nor be a symbolic link.
</p>
<p>
In addition, the copyright file must say where the upstream sources (if any)
were obtained, and should name the original authors.
</p>
<p>
Packages in the <em>contrib</em> or <em>non-free</em> archive areas should
state in the copyright file that the package is not part of the Debian
distribution and briefly explain why.
</p>
<p>
A copy of the file which will be installed in
<code>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</code> should be in
<code>debian/copyright</code> in the source package.
</p>
<p>
<code>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></code> may be a symbolic link to
another directory in <code>/usr/share/doc</code> only if the two packages both
come from the same source and the first package Depends on the second. These
rules are important because <code>copyright</code> files must be extractable by
mechanical means.
</p>
<p>
Packages distributed under the Apache license (version 2.0), the Artistic
license, the GNU GPL (versions 1, 2, or 3), the GNU LGPL (versions 2, 2.1, or
3), and the GNU FDL (versions 1.2 or 1.3) should refer to the corresponding
files under <code>/usr/share/common-licenses</code>,[<a href="#f118"
name="fr118">118</a>] rather than quoting them in the copyright file.
</p>
<p>
You should not use the copyright file as a general <code>README</code> file.
If your package has such a file it should be installed in
<code>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/README</code> or
<code>README.Debian</code> or some other appropriate place.
</p>
<p>
All copyright files must be encoded in UTF-8.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-copyrightformat">12.5.1 Machine-readable copyright information</h3>
<p>
A specification for a standard, machine-readable format for
<code>debian/copyright</code> files is maintained as part of the
<code>debian-policy</code> package. This document may be found in the
<code>copyright-format</code> files in the <code>debian-policy</code> package.
It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at <samp><code><a
href="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/copyright-format/1.0/">/doc/packaging-manuals/copyright-format/1.0/</a></code></samp>.
</p>
<p>
Use of this format is optional.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s12.6">12.6 Examples</h2>
<p>
Any examples (configurations, source files, whatever), should be installed in a
directory <code>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</code>. These files
should not be referenced by any program: they're there for the benefit of the
system administrator and users as documentation only. Architecture-specific
example files should be installed in a directory
<code>/usr/lib/<var>package</var>/examples</code> with symbolic links to them
from <code>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</code>, or the latter
directory itself may be a symbolic link to the former.
</p>
<p>
If the purpose of a package is to provide examples, then the example files may
be installed into <code>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></code>.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-changelogs">12.7 Changelog files</h2>
<p>
Packages that are not Debian-native must contain a compressed copy of the
<code>debian/changelog</code> file from the Debian source tree in
<code>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></code> with the name
<code>changelog.Debian.gz</code>.
</p>
<p>
If an upstream changelog is available, it should be accessible as
<code>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.gz</code> in plain text. If
the upstream changelog is distributed in HTML, it should be made available in
that form as <code>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.html.gz</code>
and a plain text <code>changelog.gz</code> should be generated from it using,
for example, <samp>lynx -dump -nolist</samp>. If the upstream changelog files
do not already conform to this naming convention, then this may be achieved
either by renaming the files, or by adding a symbolic link, at the maintainer's
discretion.[<a href="#f119" name="fr119">119</a>]
</p>
<p>
All of these files should be installed compressed using <samp>gzip -9</samp>,
as they will become large with time even if they start out small.
</p>
<p>
If the package has only one changelog which is used both as the Debian
changelog and the upstream one because there is no separate upstream maintainer
then that changelog should usually be installed as
<code>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.gz</code>; if there is a
separate upstream maintainer, but no upstream changelog, then the Debian
changelog should still be called <code>changelog.Debian.gz</code>.
</p>
<p>
For details about the format and contents of the Debian changelog file, please
see <a href="#s-dpkgchangelog">Debian changelog: <code>debian/changelog</code>,
Section 4.4</a>.
</p>
<p><a name="ap-pkg-scope"></a></p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#ch-docs">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">1</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">2</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">3</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">4</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">5</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">7</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">9</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">10</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">11</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">12</a> ]
[ A ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br>Appendix A - Introduction and scope of these appendices</h1>
<hr>
<p>
These appendices are taken essentially verbatim from the now-deprecated
Packaging Manual, version 3.2.1.0. They are the chapters which are likely to
be of use to package maintainers and which have not already been included in
the policy document itself. Most of these sections are very likely not
relevant to policy; they should be treated as documentation for the packaging
system. Please note that these appendices are included for convenience, and
for historical reasons: they used to be part of policy package, and they have
not yet been incorporated into dpkg documentation. However, they still have
value, and hence they are presented here.
</p>
<p>
They have not yet been checked to ensure that they are compatible with the
contents of policy, and if there are any contradictions, the version in the
main policy document takes precedence. The remaining chapters of the old
Packaging Manual have also not been read in detail to ensure that there are not
parts which have been left out. Both of these will be done in due course.
</p>
<p>
Certain parts of the Packaging manual were integrated into the Policy Manual
proper, and removed from the appendices. Links have been placed from the old
locations to the new ones.
</p>
<p>
<code>dpkg</code> is a suite of programs for creating binary package files and
installing and removing them on Unix systems.[<a href="#f120"
name="fr120">120</a>]
</p>
<p>
The binary packages are designed for the management of installed executable
programs (usually compiled binaries) and their associated data, though source
code examples and documentation are provided as part of some packages.
</p>
<p>
This manual describes the technical aspects of creating Debian binary packages
(<code>.deb</code> files). It documents the behavior of the package management
programs <code>dpkg</code>, <code>dselect</code> et al. and the way they
interact with packages.
</p>
<p>
This manual does not go into detail about the options and usage of the package
building and installation tools. It should therefore be read in conjunction
with those programs' man pages.
</p>
<p>
The utility programs which are provided with <code>dpkg</code> not described in
detail here, are documented in their man pages.
</p>
<p>
It is assumed that the reader is reasonably familiar with the <code>dpkg</code>
System Administrators' manual. Unfortunately this manual does not yet exist.
</p>
<p>
The Debian version of the FSF's GNU hello program is provided as an example for
people wishing to create Debian packages. However, while the examples are
helpful, they do not replace the need to read and follow the Policy and
Programmer's Manual.
</p>
<p><a name="ap-pkg-binarypkg"></a></p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">1</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">2</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">3</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">4</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">5</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">7</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">9</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">10</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">11</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">12</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A</a> ]
[ B ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br>Appendix B - Binary packages (from old Packaging Manual)</h1>
<hr>
<p>
See <code>deb(5)</code> and <a href="#s-pkg-controlarea">Package control
information files, Section B.2</a>.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-pkg-bincreating">B.1 Creating package files - <code>dpkg-deb</code></h2>
<p>
All manipulation of binary package files is done by <code>dpkg-deb</code>; it's
the only program that has knowledge of the format. (<code>dpkg-deb</code> may
be invoked by calling <code>dpkg</code>, as <code>dpkg</code> will spot that
the options requested are appropriate to <code>dpkg-deb</code> and invoke that
instead with the same arguments.)
</p>
<p>
In order to create a binary package you must make a directory tree which
contains all the files and directories you want to have in the file system data
part of the package. In Debian-format source packages this directory is
usually <code>debian/tmp</code>, relative to the top of the package's source
tree.
</p>
<p>
They should have the locations (relative to the root of the directory tree
you're constructing) ownerships and permissions which you want them to have on
the system when they are installed.
</p>
<p>
With current versions of <code>dpkg</code> the uid/username and gid/groupname
mappings for the users and groups being used should be the same on the system
where the package is built and the one where it is installed.
</p>
<p>
You need to add one special directory to the root of the miniature file system
tree you're creating: <code>DEBIAN</code>. It should contain the control
information files, notably the binary package control file (see <a
href="#s-pkg-controlfile">The main control information file:
<samp>control</samp>, Section B.3</a>).
</p>
<p>
The <code>DEBIAN</code> directory will not appear in the file system archive of
the package, and so won't be installed by <code>dpkg</code> when the package is
unpacked.
</p>
<p>
When you've prepared the package, you should invoke:
</p>
<pre>
dpkg --build <var>directory</var>
</pre>
<p>
This will build the package in <code><var>directory</var>.deb</code>.
(<code>dpkg</code> knows that <samp>--build</samp> is a <code>dpkg-deb</code>
option, so it invokes <code>dpkg-deb</code> with the same arguments to build
the package.)
</p>
<p>
See the man page <code>dpkg-deb(8)</code> for details of how to examine the
contents of this newly-created file. You may find the output of following
commands enlightening:
</p>
<pre>
dpkg-deb --info <var>filename</var>.deb
dpkg-deb --contents <var>filename</var>.deb
dpkg --contents <var>filename</var>.deb
</pre>
<p>
To view the copyright file for a package you could use this command:
</p>
<pre>
dpkg --fsys-tarfile <var>filename</var>.deb | tar xOf - --wildcards \*/copyright | pager
</pre>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-pkg-controlarea">B.2 Package control information files</h2>
<p>
The control information portion of a binary package is a collection of files
with names known to <code>dpkg</code>. It will treat the contents of these
files specially - some of them contain information used by <code>dpkg</code>
when installing or removing the package; others are scripts which the package
maintainer wants <code>dpkg</code> to run.
</p>
<p>
It is possible to put other files in the package control information file area,
but this is not generally a good idea (though they will largely be ignored).
</p>
<p>
Here is a brief list of the control information files supported by
<code>dpkg</code> and a summary of what they're used for.
</p>
<dl>
<dt><samp>control</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
This is the key description file used by <code>dpkg</code>. It specifies the
package's name and version, gives its description for the user, states its
relationships with other packages, and so forth. See <a
href="#s-sourcecontrolfiles">Source package control files --
<code>debian/control</code>, Section 5.2</a> and <a
href="#s-binarycontrolfiles">Binary package control files --
<code>DEBIAN/control</code>, Section 5.3</a>.
</p>
<p>
It is usually generated automatically from information in the source package by
the <code>dpkg-gencontrol</code> program, and with assistance from
<code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code>. See <a href="#s-pkg-sourcetools">Tools for
processing source packages, Section C.1</a>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>postinst</samp>, <samp>preinst</samp>, <samp>postrm</samp>, <samp>prerm</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
These are executable files (usually scripts) which <code>dpkg</code> runs
during installation, upgrade and removal of packages. They allow the package
to deal with matters which are particular to that package or require more
complicated processing than that provided by <code>dpkg</code>. Details of
when and how they are called are in <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">Package
maintainer scripts and installation procedure, Chapter 6</a>.
</p>
<p>
It is very important to make these scripts idempotent. See <a
href="#s-idempotency">Maintainer scripts idempotency, Section 6.2</a>.
</p>
<p>
The maintainer scripts are not guaranteed to run with a controlling terminal
and may not be able to interact with the user. See <a
href="#s-controllingterminal">Controlling terminal for maintainer scripts,
Section 6.3</a>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>conffiles</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
This file contains a list of configuration files which are to be handled
automatically by <code>dpkg</code> (see <a
href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">Configuration file handling (from old Packaging
Manual), Appendix E</a>). Note that not necessarily every configuration file
should be listed here.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt><samp>shlibs</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
This file contains a list of the shared libraries supplied by the package, with
dependency details for each. This is used by <code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> when
it determines what dependencies are required in a package control file. The
<samp>shlibs</samp> file format is described on <a href="#s-shlibs">The
<code>shlibs</code> File Format, Section 8.6.4.2</a>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-pkg-controlfile">B.3 The main control information file: <samp>control</samp></h2>
<p>
The most important control information file used by <code>dpkg</code> when it
installs a package is <samp>control</samp>. It contains all the package's
"vital statistics".
</p>
<p>
The binary package control files of packages built from Debian sources are made
by a special tool, <code>dpkg-gencontrol</code>, which reads
<code>debian/control</code> and <code>debian/changelog</code> to find the
information it needs. See <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">Source packages (from
old Packaging Manual), Appendix C</a> for more details.
</p>
<p>
The fields in binary package control files are listed in <a
href="#s-binarycontrolfiles">Binary package control files --
<code>DEBIAN/control</code>, Section 5.3</a>.
</p>
<p>
A description of the syntax of control files and the purpose of the fields is
available in <a href="#ch-controlfields">Control files and their fields,
Chapter 5</a>.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="sB.4">B.4 Time Stamps</h2>
<p>
See <a href="#s-timestamps">Time Stamps, Section 4.7</a>.
</p>
<p><a name="ap-pkg-sourcepkg"></a></p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">1</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">2</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">3</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">4</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">5</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">7</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">9</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">10</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">11</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">12</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B</a> ]
[ C ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br>Appendix C - Source packages (from old Packaging Manual)</h1>
<hr>
<p>
The Debian binary packages in the distribution are generated from Debian
sources, which are in a special format to assist the easy and automatic
building of binaries.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-pkg-sourcetools">C.1 Tools for processing source packages</h2>
<p>
Various tools are provided for manipulating source packages; they pack and
unpack sources and help build of binary packages and help manage the
distribution of new versions.
</p>
<p>
They are introduced and typical uses described here; see
<code>dpkg-source(1)</code> for full documentation about their arguments and
operation.
</p>
<p>
For examples of how to construct a Debian source package, and how to use those
utilities that are used by Debian source packages, please see the
<code>hello</code> example package.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-pkg-dpkg-source">C.1.1 <code>dpkg-source</code> - packs and unpacks Debian source packages</h3>
<p>
This program is frequently used by hand, and is also called from
package-independent automated building scripts such as
<code>dpkg-buildpackage</code>.
</p>
<p>
To unpack a package it is typically invoked with
</p>
<pre>
dpkg-source -x <var>.../path/to/filename</var>.dsc
</pre>
<p>
with the <code><var>filename</var>.tar.gz</code> and
<code><var>filename</var>.diff.gz</code> (if applicable) in the same directory.
It unpacks into <code><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></code>, and if
applicable <code><var>package</var>-<var>version</var>.orig</code>, in the
current directory.
</p>
<p>
To create a packed source archive it is typically invoked:
</p>
<pre>
dpkg-source -b <var>package</var>-<var>version</var>
</pre>
<p>
This will create the <code>.dsc</code>, <code>.tar.gz</code> and
<code>.diff.gz</code> (if appropriate) in the current directory.
<code>dpkg-source</code> does not clean the source tree first - this must be
done separately if it is required.
</p>
<p>
See also <a href="#s-pkg-sourcearchives">Source packages as archives, Section
C.3</a>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-pkg-dpkg-buildpackage">C.1.2 <code>dpkg-buildpackage</code> - overall package-building control script</h3>
<p>
See <code>dpkg-buildpackage(1)</code>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-pkg-dpkg-gencontrol">C.1.3 <code>dpkg-gencontrol</code> - generates binary package control files</h3>
<p>
This program is usually called from <code>debian/rules</code> (see <a
href="#s-pkg-sourcetree">The Debian package source tree, Section C.2</a>) in
the top level of the source tree.
</p>
<p>
This is usually done just before the files and directories in the temporary
directory tree where the package is being built have their permissions and
ownerships set and the package is constructed using <code>dpkg-deb/</code> [<a
href="#f121" name="fr121">121</a>].
</p>
<p>
<code>dpkg-gencontrol</code> must be called after all the files which are to go
into the package have been placed in the temporary build directory, so that its
calculation of the installed size of a package is correct.
</p>
<p>
It is also necessary for <code>dpkg-gencontrol</code> to be run after
<code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> so that the variable substitutions created by
<code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> in <code>debian/substvars</code> are available.
</p>
<p>
For a package which generates only one binary package, and which builds it in
<code>debian/tmp</code> relative to the top of the source package, it is
usually sufficient to call <code>dpkg-gencontrol</code>.
</p>
<p>
Sources which build several binaries will typically need something like:
</p>
<pre>
dpkg-gencontrol -Pdebian/tmp-<var>pkg</var> -p<var>package</var>
</pre>
<p>
The <samp>-P</samp> tells <code>dpkg-gencontrol</code> that the package is
being built in a non-default directory, and the <samp>-p</samp> tells it which
package's control file should be generated.
</p>
<p>
<code>dpkg-gencontrol</code> also adds information to the list of files in
<code>debian/files</code>, for the benefit of (for example) a future invocation
of <code>dpkg-genchanges</code>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps">C.1.4 <code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> - calculates shared library dependencies</h3>
<p>
See <code>dpkg-shlibdeps(1)</code>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-pkg-dpkg-distaddfile">C.1.5 <code>dpkg-distaddfile</code> - adds a file to <code>debian/files</code></h3>
<p>
Some packages' uploads need to include files other than the source and binary
package files.
</p>
<p>
<code>dpkg-distaddfile</code> adds a file to the <code>debian/files</code> file
so that it will be included in the <code>.changes</code> file when
<code>dpkg-genchanges</code> is run.
</p>
<p>
It is usually invoked from the <samp>binary</samp> target of
<code>debian/rules</code>:
</p>
<pre>
dpkg-distaddfile <var>filename</var> <var>section</var> <var>priority</var>
</pre>
<p>
The <var>filename</var> is relative to the directory where
<code>dpkg-genchanges</code> will expect to find it - this is usually the
directory above the top level of the source tree. The
<code>debian/rules</code> target should put the file there just before or just
after calling <code>dpkg-distaddfile</code>.
</p>
<p>
The <var>section</var> and <var>priority</var> are passed unchanged into the
resulting <code>.changes</code> file.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-pkg-dpkg-genchanges">C.1.6 <code>dpkg-genchanges</code> - generates a <code>.changes</code> upload control file</h3>
<p>
See <code>dpkg-genchanges(1)</code>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-pkg-dpkg-parsechangelog">C.1.7 <code>dpkg-parsechangelog</code> - produces parsed representation of a changelog</h3>
<p>
See <code>dpkg-parsechangelog(1)</code>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-pkg-dpkg-architecture">C.1.8 <code>dpkg-architecture</code> - information about the build and host system</h3>
<p>
See <code>dpkg-architecture(1)</code>.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-pkg-sourcetree">C.2 The Debian package source tree</h2>
<p>
The source archive scheme described later is intended to allow a Debian package
source tree with some associated control information to be reproduced and
transported easily. The Debian package source tree is a version of the
original program with certain files added for the benefit of the packaging
process, and with any other changes required made to the rest of the source
code and installation scripts.
</p>
<p>
The extra files created for Debian are in the subdirectory <code>debian</code>
of the top level of the Debian package source tree. They are described below.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-pkg-debianrules">C.2.1 <code>debian/rules</code> - the main building script</h3>
<p>
See <a href="#s-debianrules">Main building script: <code>debian/rules</code>,
Section 4.9</a>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-pkg-srcsubstvars">C.2.2 <code>debian/substvars</code> and variable substitutions</h3>
<p>
See <a href="#s-substvars">Variable substitutions:
<code>debian/substvars</code>, Section 4.10</a>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="sC.2.3">C.2.3 <code>debian/files</code></h3>
<p>
See <a href="#s-debianfiles">Generated files list: <code>debian/files</code>,
Section 4.12</a>.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="sC.2.4">C.2.4 <code>debian/tmp</code></h3>
<p>
This is the canonical temporary location for the construction of binary
packages by the <samp>binary</samp> target. The directory <code>tmp</code>
serves as the root of the file system tree as it is being constructed (for
example, by using the package's upstream makefiles install targets and
redirecting the output there), and it also contains the <samp>DEBIAN</samp>
subdirectory. See <a href="#s-pkg-bincreating">Creating package files -
<code>dpkg-deb</code>, Section B.1</a>.
</p>
<p>
If several binary packages are generated from the same source tree it is usual
to use several <code>debian/tmp<var>something</var></code> directories, for
example <code>tmp-a</code> or <code>tmp-doc</code>.
</p>
<p>
Whatever <code>tmp</code> directories are created and used by
<samp>binary</samp> must of course be removed by the <samp>clean</samp> target.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="s-pkg-sourcearchives">C.3 Source packages as archives</h2>
<p>
As it exists on the FTP site, a Debian source package consists of three related
files. You must have the right versions of all three to be able to use them.
</p>
<dl>
<dt>Debian source control file - <samp>.dsc</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
This file is a control file used by <code>dpkg-source</code> to extract a
source package. See <a href="#s-debiansourcecontrolfiles">Debian source
control files -- <samp>.dsc</samp>, Section 5.4</a>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>Original source archive - <code><var>package</var>_<var>upstream-version</var>.orig.tar.gz</code></dt>
<dd>
<p>
This is a compressed (with <samp>gzip -9</samp>) <code>tar</code> file
containing the source code from the upstream authors of the program.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<dl>
<dt>Debian package diff - <code><var>package</var>_<var>upstream_version-revision</var>.diff.gz</code></dt>
<dd>
<p>
This is a unified context diff (<samp>diff -u</samp>) giving the changes which
are required to turn the original source into the Debian source. These changes
may only include editing and creating plain files. The permissions of files,
the targets of symbolic links and the characteristics of special files or pipes
may not be changed and no files may be removed or renamed.
</p>
<p>
All the directories in the diff must exist, except the <code>debian</code>
subdirectory of the top of the source tree, which will be created by
<code>dpkg-source</code> if necessary when unpacking.
</p>
<p>
The <code>dpkg-source</code> program will automatically make the
<code>debian/rules</code> file executable (see below).
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<p>
If there is no original source code - for example, if the package is specially
prepared for Debian or the Debian maintainer is the same as the upstream
maintainer - the format is slightly different: then there is no diff, and the
tarfile is named <code><var>package</var>_<var>version</var>.tar.gz</code>, and
preferably contains a directory named
<code><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></code>.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="sC.4">C.4 Unpacking a Debian source package without <code>dpkg-source</code></h2>
<p>
<samp>dpkg-source -x</samp> is the recommended way to unpack a Debian source
package. However, if it is not available it is possible to unpack a Debian
source archive as follows:
</p>
<!-- ol type="1" start="1" -->
<li>
<p>
Untar the tarfile, which will create a <code>.orig</code> directory.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Rename the <code>.orig</code> directory to
<code><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></code>.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Create the subdirectory <code>debian</code> at the top of the source tree.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Apply the diff using <samp>patch -p0</samp>.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Untar the tarfile again if you want a copy of the original source code
alongside the Debian version.
</p>
</li>
</ol>
<p>
It is not possible to generate a valid Debian source archive without using
<code>dpkg-source</code>. In particular, attempting to use <code>diff</code>
directly to generate the <code>.diff.gz</code> file will not work.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="sC.4.1">C.4.1 Restrictions on objects in source packages</h3>
<p>
The source package may not contain any hard links [<a href="#f122"
name="fr122">122</a>] [<a href="#f123" name="fr123">123</a>], device special
files, sockets or setuid or setgid files. [<a href="#f124"
name="fr124">124</a>]
</p>
<p>
The source packaging tools manage the changes between the original and Debian
source using <code>diff</code> and <code>patch</code>. Turning the original
source tree as included in the <code>.orig.tar.gz</code> into the Debian
package source must not involve any changes which cannot be handled by these
tools. Problematic changes which cause <code>dpkg-source</code> to halt with
an error when building the source package are:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
Adding or removing symbolic links, sockets or pipes.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Changing the targets of symbolic links.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Creating directories, other than <code>debian</code>.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Changes to the contents of binary files.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
Changes which cause <code>dpkg-source</code> to print a warning but continue
anyway are:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
Removing files, directories or symlinks. [<a href="#f125"
name="fr125">125</a>]
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Changed text files which are missing the usual final newline (either in the
original or the modified source tree).
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
Changes which are not represented, but which are not detected by
<code>dpkg-source</code>, are:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
Changing the permissions of files (other than <code>debian/rules</code>) and
directories.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<p>
The <code>debian</code> directory and <code>debian/rules</code> are handled
specially by <code>dpkg-source</code> - before applying the changes it will
create the <code>debian</code> directory, and afterwards it will make
<code>debian/rules</code> world-executable.
</p>
<p><a name="ap-pkg-controlfields"></a></p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">1</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">2</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">3</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">4</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">5</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">7</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">9</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">10</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">11</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">12</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C</a> ]
[ D ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br>Appendix D - Control files and their fields (from old Packaging Manual)</h1>
<hr>
<p>
Many of the tools in the <code>dpkg</code> suite manipulate data in a common
format, known as control files. Binary and source packages have control data
as do the <code>.changes</code> files which control the installation of
uploaded files, and <code>dpkg</code>'s internal databases are in a similar
format.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="sD.1">D.1 Syntax of control files</h2>
<p>
See <a href="#s-controlsyntax">Syntax of control files, Section 5.1</a>.
</p>
<p>
It is important to note that there are several fields which are optional as far
as <code>dpkg</code> and the related tools are concerned, but which must appear
in every Debian package, or whose omission may cause problems.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="sD.2">D.2 List of fields</h2>
<p>
See <a href="#s-controlfieldslist">List of fields, Section 5.6</a>.
</p>
<p>
This section now contains only the fields that didn't belong to the Policy
manual.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-pkg-f-Filename">D.2.1 <samp>Filename</samp> and <samp>MSDOS-Filename</samp></h3>
<p>
These fields in <samp>Packages</samp> files give the filename(s) of (the parts
of) a package in the distribution directories, relative to the root of the
Debian hierarchy. If the package has been split into several parts the parts
are all listed in order, separated by spaces.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-pkg-f-Size">D.2.2 <samp>Size</samp> and <samp>MD5sum</samp></h3>
<p>
These fields in <code>Packages</code> files give the size (in bytes, expressed
in decimal) and MD5 checksum of the file(s) which make(s) up a binary package
in the distribution. If the package is split into several parts the values for
the parts are listed in order, separated by spaces.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-pkg-f-Status">D.2.3 <samp>Status</samp></h3>
<p>
This field in <code>dpkg</code>'s status file records whether the user wants a
package installed, removed or left alone, whether it is broken (requiring
re-installation) or not and what its current state on the system is. Each of
these pieces of information is a single word.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-pkg-f-Config-Version">D.2.4 <samp>Config-Version</samp></h3>
<p>
If a package is not installed or not configured, this field in
<code>dpkg</code>'s status file records the last version of the package which
was successfully configured.
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="s-pkg-f-Conffiles">D.2.5 <samp>Conffiles</samp></h3>
<p>
This field in <code>dpkg</code>'s status file contains information about the
automatically-managed configuration files held by a package. This field should
<em>not</em> appear anywhere in a package!
</p>
<hr>
<h3 id="sD.2.6">D.2.6 Obsolete fields</h3>
<p>
These are still recognized by <code>dpkg</code> but should not appear anywhere
any more.
</p>
<dl>
<dt><samp>Revision</samp></dt>
<dt><samp>Package-Revision</samp></dt>
<dt><samp>Package_Revision</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
The Debian revision part of the package version was at one point in a separate
control field. This field went through several names.
</p>
</dd>
<dt><samp>Recommended</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
Old name for <samp>Recommends</samp>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt><samp>Optional</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
Old name for <samp>Suggests</samp>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt><samp>Class</samp></dt>
<dd>
<p>
Old name for <samp>Priority</samp>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<p><a name="ap-pkg-conffiles"></a></p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">1</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">2</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">3</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">4</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">5</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">7</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">9</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">10</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">11</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">12</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D</a> ]
[ E ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br>Appendix E - Configuration file handling (from old Packaging Manual)</h1>
<hr>
<p>
<code>dpkg</code> can do a certain amount of automatic handling of package
configuration files.
</p>
<p>
Whether this mechanism is appropriate depends on a number of factors, but
basically there are two approaches to any particular configuration file.
</p>
<p>
The easy method is to ship a best-effort configuration in the package, and use
<code>dpkg</code>'s conffile mechanism to handle updates. If the user is
unlikely to want to edit the file, but you need them to be able to without
losing their changes, and a new package with a changed version of the file is
only released infrequently, this is a good approach.
</p>
<p>
The hard method is to build the configuration file from scratch in the
<code>postinst</code> script, and to take the responsibility for fixing any
mistakes made in earlier versions of the package automatically. This will be
appropriate if the file is likely to need to be different on each system.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="sE.1">E.1 Automatic handling of configuration files by <code>dpkg</code></h2>
<p>
A package may contain a control information file called <samp>conffiles</samp>.
This file should be a list of filenames of configuration files needing
automatic handling, separated by newlines. The filenames should be absolute
pathnames, and the files referred to should actually exist in the package.
</p>
<p>
When a package is upgraded <code>dpkg</code> will process the configuration
files during the configuration stage, shortly before it runs the package's
<code>postinst</code> script,
</p>
<p>
For each file it checks to see whether the version of the file included in the
package is the same as the one that was included in the last version of the
package (the one that is being upgraded from); it also compares the version
currently installed on the system with the one shipped with the last version.
</p>
<p>
If neither the user nor the package maintainer has changed the file, it is left
alone. If one or the other has changed their version, then the changed version
is preferred - i.e., if the user edits their file, but the package maintainer
doesn't ship a different version, the user's changes will stay, silently, but
if the maintainer ships a new version and the user hasn't edited it the new
version will be installed (with an informative message). If both have changed
their version the user is prompted about the problem and must resolve the
differences themselves.
</p>
<p>
The comparisons are done by calculating the MD5 message digests of the files,
and storing the MD5 of the file as it was included in the most recent version
of the package.
</p>
<p>
When a package is installed for the first time <code>dpkg</code> will install
the file that comes with it, unless that would mean overwriting a file already
on the file system.
</p>
<p>
However, note that <code>dpkg</code> will <em>not</em> replace a conffile that
was removed by the user (or by a script). This is necessary because with some
programs a missing file produces an effect hard or impossible to achieve in
another way, so that a missing file needs to be kept that way if the user did
it.
</p>
<p>
Note that a package should <em>not</em> modify a <code>dpkg</code>-handled
conffile in its maintainer scripts. Doing this will lead to <code>dpkg</code>
giving the user confusing and possibly dangerous options for conffile update
when the package is upgraded.
</p>
<hr>
<h2 id="sE.2">E.2 Fully-featured maintainer script configuration handling</h2>
<p>
For files which contain site-specific information such as the hostname and
networking details and so forth, it is better to create the file in the
package's <code>postinst</code> script.
</p>
<p>
This will typically involve examining the state of the rest of the system to
determine values and other information, and may involve prompting the user for
some information which can't be obtained some other way.
</p>
<p>
When using this method there are a couple of important issues which should be
considered:
</p>
<p>
If you discover a bug in the program which generates the configuration file, or
if the format of the file changes from one version to the next, you will have
to arrange for the postinst script to do something sensible - usually this will
mean editing the installed configuration file to remove the problem or change
the syntax. You will have to do this very carefully, since the user may have
changed the file, perhaps to fix the very problem that your script is trying to
deal with - you will have to detect these situations and deal with them
correctly.
</p>
<p>
If you do go down this route it's probably a good idea to make the program that
generates the configuration file(s) a separate program in
<code>/usr/sbin</code>, by convention called
<code><var>package</var>config</code> and then run that if appropriate from the
post-installation script. The <samp><var>package</var>config</samp> program
should not unquestioningly overwrite an existing configuration - if its mode of
operation is geared towards setting up a package for the first time (rather
than any arbitrary reconfiguration later) you should have it check whether the
configuration already exists, and require a <samp>--force</samp> flag to
overwrite it.
</p>
<p><a name="ap-pkg-alternatives"></a></p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">1</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">2</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">3</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">4</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">5</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">7</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">9</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">10</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">11</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">12</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E</a> ]
[ F ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br>Appendix F - Alternative versions of an interface - <code>update-alternatives</code> (from old Packaging Manual)</h1>
<hr>
<p>
When several packages all provide different versions of the same program or
file it is useful to have the system select a default, but to allow the system
administrator to change it and have their decisions respected.
</p>
<p>
For example, there are several versions of the <code>vi</code> editor, and
there is no reason to prevent all of them from being installed at once, each
under their own name (<code>nvi</code>, <code>vim</code> or whatever).
Nevertheless it is desirable to have the name <samp>vi</samp> refer to
something, at least by default.
</p>
<p>
If all the packages involved cooperate, this can be done with
<code>update-alternatives</code>.
</p>
<p>
Each package provides its own version under its own name, and calls
<code>update-alternatives</code> in its postinst to register its version (and
again in its prerm to deregister it).
</p>
<p>
See the man page <code>update-alternatives(8)</code> for details.
</p>
<p>
If <code>update-alternatives</code> does not seem appropriate you may wish to
consider using diversions instead.
</p>
<p><a name="ap-pkg-diversions"></a></p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">1</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">2</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">3</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">4</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">5</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">7</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">9</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">10</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">11</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">12</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F</a> ]
[ G ]
[ <a href="#index">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br>Appendix G - Diversions - overriding a package's version of a file (from old Packaging Manual)</h1>
<hr>
<p>
It is possible to have <code>dpkg</code> not overwrite a file when it
reinstalls the package it belongs to, and to have it put the file from the
package somewhere else instead.
</p>
<p>
This can be used locally to override a package's version of a file, or by one
package to override another's version (or provide a wrapper for it).
</p>
<p>
Before deciding to use a diversion, read <a
href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">Alternative versions of an interface -
<code>update-alternatives</code> (from old Packaging Manual), Appendix F</a> to
see if you really want a diversion rather than several alternative versions of
a program.
</p>
<p>
There is a diversion list, which is read by <code>dpkg</code>, and updated by a
special program <code>dpkg-divert</code>. Please see
<code>dpkg-divert(8)</code> for full details of its operation.
</p>
<p>
When a package wishes to divert a file from another, it should call
<code>dpkg-divert</code> in its preinst to add the diversion and rename the
existing file. For example, supposing that a <code>smailwrapper</code> package
wishes to install a wrapper around <code>/usr/sbin/smail</code>:
</p>
<pre>
dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --add --rename \
--divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
</pre>
<p>
The <samp>--package smailwrapper</samp> ensures that
<code>smailwrapper</code>'s copy of <code>/usr/sbin/smail</code> can bypass the
diversion and get installed as the true version. It's safe to add the
diversion unconditionally on upgrades since it will be left unchanged if it
already exists, but <code>dpkg-divert</code> will display a message. To
suppress that message, make the command conditional on the version from which
the package is being upgraded:
</p>
<pre>
if [ upgrade != "$1" ] || dpkg --compare-versions "$2" lt 1.0-2; then
dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --add --rename \
--divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
fi
</pre>
<p>
where <samp>1.0-2</samp> is the version at which the diversion was first added
to the package. Running the command during abort-upgrade is pointless but
harmless.
</p>
<p>
The postrm has to do the reverse:
</p>
<pre>
if [ remove = "$1" -o abort-install = "$1" -o disappear = "$1" ]; then
dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --remove --rename \
--divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
fi
</pre>
<p>
If the diversion was added at a particular version, the postrm should also
handle the failure case of upgrading from an older version (unless the older
version is so old that direct upgrades are no longer supported):
</p>
<pre>
if [ abort-upgrade = "$1" ] && dpkg --compare-versions "$2" lt 1.0-2; then
dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --remove --rename \
--divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
fi
</pre>
<p>
where <samp>1.0-2</samp> is the version at which the diversion was first added
to the package. The postrm should not remove the diversion on upgrades both
because there's no reason to remove the diversion only to immediately re-add it
and since the postrm of the old package is run after unpacking so the removal
of the diversion will fail.
</p>
<p>
Do not attempt to divert a file which is vitally important for the system's
operation - when using <code>dpkg-divert</code> there is a time, after it has
been diverted but before <code>dpkg</code> has installed the new version, when
the file does not exist.
</p>
<p>
Do not attempt to divert a conffile, as <code>dpkg</code> does not handle it
well.
</p>
<hr>
<h1>
Debian Policy Manual
<br>Footnotes</h1>
<h2><a href="#fr1" name="f1">1</a></h2>
<p>
Informally, the criteria used for inclusion is that the material meet one of
the following requirements:
</p>
<dl>
<dt>Standard interfaces</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The material presented represents an interface to the packaging system that is
mandated for use, and is used by, a significant number of packages, and
therefore should not be changed without peer review. Package maintainers can
then rely on this interface not changing, and the package management software
authors need to ensure compatibility with this interface definition. (Control
file and changelog file formats are examples.)
</p>
</dd>
<dt>Chosen Convention</dt>
<dd>
<p>
If there are a number of technically viable choices that can be made, but one
needs to select one of these options for inter-operability. The version number
format is one example.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<p>
Please note that these are not mutually exclusive; selected conventions often
become parts of standard interfaces.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr2" name="f2">2</a></h2>
<p>
Compare RFC 2119. Note, however, that these words are used in a different way
in this document.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr3" name="f3">3</a></h2>
<p>
The Debian archive software uses the term "component" internally and
in the Release file format to refer to the division of an archive. The Debian
Social Contract simply refers to "areas." This document uses
terminology similar to the Social Contract.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr4" name="f4">4</a></h2>
<p>
See <code><a href="http://www.debian.org/intro/free">What Does Free
Mean?</a></code> for more about what we mean by free software.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr5" name="f5">5</a></h2>
<p>
It is possible that there are policy requirements which the package is unable
to meet, for example, if the source is unavailable. These situations will need
to be handled on a case-by-case basis.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr6" name="f6">6</a></h2>
<p>
This is an important criterion because we are trying to produce, amongst other
things, a free Unix.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr7" name="f7">7</a></h2>
<p>
A sample implementation of such a whitelist written for the Mailman mailing
list management software is used for mailing lists hosted by alioth.debian.org.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr8" name="f8">8</a></h2>
<p>
The detailed procedure for gracefully orphaning a package can be found in the
Debian Developer's Reference (see <a href="#s-related">Related documents,
Section 1.4</a>).
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr9" name="f9">9</a></h2>
<p>
The blurb that comes with a program in its announcements and/or
<code>README</code> files is rarely suitable for use in a description. It is
usually aimed at people who are already in the community where the package is
used.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr10" name="f10">10</a></h2>
<p>
Essential is needed in part to avoid unresolvable dependency loops on upgrade.
If packages add unnecessary dependencies on packages in this set, the chances
that there <strong>will</strong> be an unresolvable dependency loop caused by
forcing these Essential packages to be configured first before they need to be
is greatly increased. It also increases the chances that frontends will be
unable to <strong>calculate</strong> an upgrade path, even if one exists.
</p>
<p>
Also, functionality is rarely ever removed from the Essential set, but
<em>packages</em> have been removed from the Essential set when the
functionality moved to a different package. So depending on these packages
<em>just in case</em> they stop being essential does way more harm than good.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr11" name="f11">11</a></h2>
<p>
<code>Debconf</code> or another tool that implements the Debian Configuration
Management Specification will also be installed, and any versioned dependencies
on it will be satisfied before preconfiguration begins.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr12" name="f12">12</a></h2>
<p>
See the file <code>upgrading-checklist</code> for information about policy
which has changed between different versions of this document.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr13" name="f13">13</a></h2>
<p>
Rationale:
</p>
<ul>
<li>
<p>
This allows maintaining the list separately from the policy documents (the list
does not need the kind of control that the policy documents do).
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Having a separate package allows one to install the build-essential packages on
a machine, as well as allowing other packages such as tasks to require
installation of the build-essential packages using the depends relation.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
The separate package allows bug reports against the list to be categorized
separately from the policy management process in the BTS.
</p>
</li>
</ul>
<h2><a href="#fr14" name="f14">14</a></h2>
<p>
The reason for this is that dependencies change, and you should list all those
packages, and <em>only</em> those packages that <em>you</em> need directly.
What others need is their business. For example, if you only link against
<code>libimlib</code>, you will need to build-depend on
<code>libimlib2-dev</code> but not against any <samp>libjpeg*</samp> packages,
even though <samp>libimlib2-dev</samp> currently depends on them: installation
of <code>libimlib2-dev</code> will automatically ensure that all of its
run-time dependencies are satisfied.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr15" name="f15">15</a></h2>
<p>
Mistakes in changelogs are usually best rectified by making a new changelog
entry rather than "rewriting history" by editing old changelog
entries.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr16" name="f16">16</a></h2>
<p>
Although there is nothing stopping an author who is also the Debian maintainer
from using this changelog for all their changes, it will have to be renamed if
the Debian and upstream maintainers become different people. In such a case,
however, it might be better to maintain the package as a non-native package.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr17" name="f17">17</a></h2>
<p>
To be precise, the string should match the following Perl regular expression:
</p>
<pre>
/closes:\s*(?:bug)?\#?\s?\d+(?:,\s*(?:bug)?\#?\s?\d+)*/i
</pre>
<p>
Then all of the bug numbers listed will be closed by the archive maintenance
software (<code>dak</code>) using the <var>version</var> of the changelog
entry.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr18" name="f18">18</a></h2>
<p>
In the case of a sponsored upload, the uploader signs the files, but the
changelog maintainer name and address are those of the person who prepared this
release. If the preparer of the release is not one of the usual maintainers of
the package (as listed in the <a
href="#s-f-Maintainer"><samp>Maintainer</samp></a> or <a
href="#s-f-Uploaders"><samp>Uploaders</samp></a> control fields of the
package), the first line of the changelog is conventionally used to explain why
a non-maintainer is uploading the package. The Debian Developer's Reference
(see <a href="#s-related">Related documents, Section 1.4</a>) documents the
conventions used.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr19" name="f19">19</a></h2>
<p>
This is the same as the format generated by <samp>date -R</samp>.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr20" name="f20">20</a></h2>
<p>
The rationale is that there is some information conveyed by knowing the age of
the file, for example, you could recognize that some documentation is very old
by looking at the modification time, so it would be nice if the modification
time of the upstream source would be preserved.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr21" name="f21">21</a></h2>
<p>
This is not currently detected when building source packages, but only when
extracting them.
</p>
<p>
Hard links may be permitted at some point in the future, but would require a
fair amount of work.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr22" name="f22">22</a></h2>
<p>
Setgid directories are allowed.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr23" name="f23">23</a></h2>
<p>
Another common way to do this is for <samp>build</samp> to depend on
<code>build-stamp</code> and to do nothing else, and for the
<code>build-stamp</code> target to do the building and to <samp>touch
build-stamp</samp> on completion. This is especially useful if the build
routine creates a file or directory called <samp>build</samp>; in such a case,
<samp>build</samp> will need to be listed as a phony target (i.e., as a
dependency of the <samp>.PHONY</samp> target). See the documentation of
<code>make</code> for more information on phony targets.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr24" name="f24">24</a></h2>
<p>
This split allows binary-only builds to not install the dependencies required
for the <samp>build-indep</samp> target and skip any resource-intensive build
tasks that are only required when building architecture-independent binary
packages.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr25" name="f25">25</a></h2>
<p>
The <code>fakeroot</code> package often allows one to build a package correctly
even without being root.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr26" name="f26">26</a></h2>
<p>
Some packages support any delimiter, but whitespace is the easiest to parse
inside a makefile and avoids ambiguity with flag values that contain commas.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr27" name="f27">27</a></h2>
<p>
Packages built with <samp>make</samp> can often implement this by passing the
<samp>-j</samp><var>n</var> option to <samp>make</samp>.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr28" name="f28">28</a></h2>
<p>
<code>files.new</code> is used as a temporary file by
<code>dpkg-gencontrol</code> and <code>dpkg-distaddfile</code> - they write a
new version of <samp>files</samp> here before renaming it, to avoid leaving a
corrupted copy if an error occurs.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr29" name="f29">29</a></h2>
<p>
For example, parts of the GNU build system work like this.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr30" name="f30">30</a></h2>
<p>
Having multiple copies of the same code in Debian is inefficient, often creates
either static linking or shared library conflicts, and, most importantly,
increases the difficulty of handling security vulnerabilities in the duplicated
code.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr31" name="f31">31</a></h2>
<hr>
<p>
<code>dpkg</code>'s internal databases are in a similar format.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr32" name="f32">32</a></h2>
<p>
The paragraphs are also sometimes referred to as stanzas.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr33" name="f33">33</a></h2>
<p>
This folding method is similar to RFC 5322, allowing control files that contain
only one paragraph and no multiline fields to be read by parsers written for
RFC 5322.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr34" name="f34">34</a></h2>
<p>
It is customary to leave a space after the package name if a version number is
specified.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr35" name="f35">35</a></h2>
<p>
In the past, people specified the full version number in the Standards-Version
field, for example "2.3.0.0". Since minor patch-level changes don't
introduce new policy, it was thought it would be better to relax policy and
only require the first 3 components to be specified, in this example
"2.3.0". All four components may still be used if someone wishes to
do so.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr36" name="f36">36</a></h2>
<p>
Alphanumerics are <samp>A-Za-z0-9</samp> only.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr37" name="f37">37</a></h2>
<p>
One common use of <samp>~</samp> is for upstream pre-releases. For example,
<samp>1.0~beta1~svn1245</samp> sorts earlier than <samp>1.0~beta1</samp>, which
sorts earlier than <samp>1.0</samp>.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr38" name="f38">38</a></h2>
<p>
The author of this manual has heard of a package whose versions went
<samp>1.1</samp>, <samp>1.2</samp>, <samp>1.3</samp>, <samp>1</samp>,
<samp>2.1</samp>, <samp>2.2</samp>, <samp>2</samp> and so forth.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr39" name="f39">39</a></h2>
<p>
Completely empty lines will not be rendered as blank lines. Instead, they will
cause the parser to think you're starting a whole new record in the control
file, and will therefore likely abort with an error.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr40" name="f40">40</a></h2>
<p>
Example distribution names in the Debian archive used in <code>.changes</code>
files are:
</p>
<dl>
<dt><em>unstable</em></dt>
<dd>
<p>
This distribution value refers to the <em>developmental</em> part of the Debian
distribution tree. Most new packages, new upstream versions of packages and
bug fixes go into the <em>unstable</em> directory tree.
</p>
</dd>
<dt><em>experimental</em></dt>
<dd>
<p>
The packages with this distribution value are deemed by their maintainers to be
high risk. Oftentimes they represent early beta or developmental packages from
various sources that the maintainers want people to try, but are not ready to
be a part of the other parts of the Debian distribution tree.
</p>
</dd>
</dl>
<p>
Others are used for updating stable releases or for security uploads. More
information is available in the Debian Developer's Reference, section "The
Debian archive".
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr41" name="f41">41</a></h2>
<p>
The source formats currently supported by the Debian archive software are
<samp>1.0</samp>, <samp>3.0 (native)</samp>, and <samp>3.0 (quilt)</samp>.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr42" name="f42">42</a></h2>
<p>
Other urgency values are supported with configuration changes in the archive
software but are not used in Debian. The urgency affects how quickly a package
will be considered for inclusion into the <samp>testing</samp> distribution and
gives an indication of the importance of any fixes included in the upload.
<samp>Emergency</samp> and <samp>critical</samp> are treated as synonymous.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr43" name="f43">43</a></h2>
<p>
A space after each comma is conventional.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr44" name="f44">44</a></h2>
<p>
That is, the parts which are not the <samp>.dsc</samp>.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr45" name="f45">45</a></h2>
<p>
This is so that if an error occurs, the user interrupts <code>dpkg</code> or
some other unforeseen circumstance happens you don't leave the user with a
badly-broken package when <code>dpkg</code> attempts to repeat the action.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr46" name="f46">46</a></h2>
<p>
This can happen if the new version of the package no longer pre-depends on a
package that had been partially upgraded.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr47" name="f47">47</a></h2>
<p>
For example, suppose packages foo and bar are "Installed" with foo
depending on bar. If an upgrade of bar were started and then aborted, and then
an attempt to remove foo failed because its <code>prerm</code> script failed,
foo's <samp>postinst abort-remove</samp> would be called with bar only
"Half-Installed".
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr48" name="f48">48</a></h2>
<p>
This is often done by checking whether the command or facility the
<code>postrm</code> intends to call is available before calling it. For
example:
</p>
<pre>
if [ "$1" = purge ] && [ -e /usr/share/debconf/confmodule ]; then
. /usr/share/debconf/confmodule
db_purge
fi
</pre>
<p>
in <code>postrm</code> purges the <code>debconf</code> configuration for the
package if <code>debconf</code> is installed.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr49" name="f49">49</a></h2>
<p>
Part of the problem is due to what is arguably a bug in <code>dpkg</code>.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr50" name="f50">50</a></h2>
<p>
Historical note: Truly ancient (pre-1997) versions of <code>dpkg</code> passed
<samp><unknown></samp> (including the angle brackets) in this case. Even
older ones did not pass a second argument at all, under any circumstance. Note
that upgrades using such an old dpkg version are unlikely to work for other
reasons, even if this old argument behavior is handled by your postinst script.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr51" name="f51">51</a></h2>
<p>
This approach makes dependency resolution easier. If two packages A and B are
being upgraded, the installed package A depends on exactly the installed
package B, and the new package A depends on exactly the new package B (a common
situation when upgrading shared libraries and their corresponding development
packages), satisfying the dependencies at every stage of the upgrade would be
impossible. This relaxed restriction means that both new packages can be
unpacked together and then configured in their dependency order.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr52" name="f52">52</a></h2>
<p>
It is possible that a future release of <code>dpkg</code> may add the ability
to specify a version number for each virtual package it provides. This feature
is not yet present, however, and is expected to be used only infrequently.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr53" name="f53">53</a></h2>
<p>
To see why <samp>Breaks</samp> is normally needed in addition to
<samp>Replaces</samp>, consider the case of a file in the package
<code>foo</code> being taken over by the package <code>foo-data</code>.
<samp>Replaces</samp> will allow <code>foo-data</code> to be installed and take
over that file. However, without <samp>Breaks</samp>, nothing requires
<code>foo</code> to be upgraded to a newer version that knows it does not
include that file and instead depends on <code>foo-data</code>. Nothing would
prevent the new <code>foo-data</code> package from being installed and then
removed, removing the file that it took over from <code>foo</code>. After that
operation, the package manager would think the system was in a consistent
state, but the <code>foo</code> package would be missing one of its files.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr54" name="f54">54</a></h2>
<p>
Replaces is a one way relationship. You have to install the replacing package
after the replaced package.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr55" name="f55">55</a></h2>
<p>
There is no Build-Depends-Arch; this role is essentially met with
Build-Depends. Anyone building the <samp>build-indep</samp> and
<samp>binary-indep</samp> targets is assumed to be building the whole package,
and therefore installation of all build dependencies is required.
</p>
<p>
The autobuilders use <samp>dpkg-buildpackage -B</samp>, which calls
<samp>build</samp>, not <samp>build-arch</samp> since it does not yet know how
to check for its existence, and <samp>binary-arch</samp>. The purpose of the
original split between <samp>Build-Depends</samp> and
<samp>Build-Depends-Indep</samp> was so that the autobuilders wouldn't need to
install extra packages needed only for the binary-indep targets. But without a
build-arch/build-indep split, this didn't work, since most of the work is done
in the build target, not in the binary target.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr56" name="f56">56</a></h2>
<p>
<samp>Build-Depends</samp> in the source package is not adequate since it
(rightfully) does not document the exact version used in the build.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr57" name="f57">57</a></h2>
<p>
The archive software might reject packages that refer to non-existent sources.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr58" name="f58">58</a></h2>
<p>
This is a convention of shared library versioning, but not a requirement. Some
libraries use the <samp>SONAME</samp> as the full library file name instead and
therefore do not need a symlink. Most, however, encode additional information
about backwards-compatible revisions as a minor version number in the file
name. The <samp>SONAME</samp> itself only changes when binaries linked with
the earlier version of the shared library may no longer work, but the filename
may change with each release of the library. See <a
href="#s-sharedlibs-runtime">Run-time shared libraries, Section 8.1</a> for
more information.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr59" name="f59">59</a></h2>
<p>
The package management system requires the library to be placed before the
symbolic link pointing to it in the <code>.deb</code> file. This is so that
when <code>dpkg</code> comes to install the symlink (overwriting the previous
symlink pointing at an older version of the library), the new shared library is
already in place. In the past, this was achieved by creating the library in
the temporary packaging directory before creating the symlink. Unfortunately,
this was not always effective, since the building of the tar file in the
<code>.deb</code> depended on the behavior of the underlying file system. Some
file systems (such as reiserfs) reorder the files so that the order of creation
is forgotten. Since version 1.7.0, <code>dpkg</code> reorders the files itself
as necessary when building a package. Thus it is no longer important to
concern oneself with the order of file creation.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr60" name="f60">60</a></h2>
<p>
These are currently <code>/usr/local/lib</code> plus directories under
<code>/lib</code> and <code>/usr/lib</code> matching the multiarch triplet for
the system architecture.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr61" name="f61">61</a></h2>
<p>
During install or upgrade, the preinst is called before the new files are
unpacked, so calling "ldconfig" is pointless. The preinst of an
existing package can also be called if an upgrade fails. However, this happens
during the critical time when a shared libs may exist on-disk under a temporary
name. Thus, it is dangerous and forbidden by current policy to call
"ldconfig" at this time.
</p>
<p>
When a package is installed or upgraded, "postinst configure" runs
after the new files are safely on-disk. Since it is perfectly safe to invoke
ldconfig unconditionally in a postinst, it is OK for a package to simply put
ldconfig in its postinst without checking the argument. The postinst can also
be called to recover from a failed upgrade. This happens before any new files
are unpacked, so there is no reason to call "ldconfig" at this point.
</p>
<p>
For a package that is being removed, prerm is called with all the files intact,
so calling ldconfig is useless. The other calls to "prerm" happen in
the case of upgrade at a time when all the files of the old package are
on-disk, so again calling "ldconfig" is pointless.
</p>
<p>
postrm, on the other hand, is called with the "remove" argument just
after the files are removed, so this is the proper time to call
"ldconfig" to notify the system of the fact that the shared libraries
from the package are removed. The postrm can be called at several other times.
At the time of "postrm purge", "postrm abort-install", or
"postrm abort-upgrade", calling "ldconfig" is useless
because the shared lib files are not on-disk. However, when "postrm"
is invoked with arguments "upgrade", "failed-upgrade", or
"disappear", a shared lib may exist on-disk under a temporary
filename.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr62" name="f62">62</a></h2>
<p>
For example, a <code><var>package-name</var>-config</code> script or
<code>pkg-config</code> configuration files.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr63" name="f63">63</a></h2>
<p>
This wording allows the development files to be split into several packages,
such as a separate architecture-independent
<code><var>libraryname</var>-headers</code>, provided that the development
package depends on all the required additional packages.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr64" name="f64">64</a></h2>
<p>
Previously, <samp>${Source-Version}</samp> was used, but its name was confusing
and it has been deprecated since dpkg 1.13.19.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr65" name="f65">65</a></h2>
<p>
A <code>shlibs</code> file represents an SONAME as a library name and version
number, such as <samp>libfoo VERSION</samp>, instead of recording the actual
SONAME. If the SONAME doesn't match one of the two expected formats
(<samp>libfoo-VERSION.so</samp> or <samp>libfoo.so.VERSION</samp>), it cannot
be represented.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr66" name="f66">66</a></h2>
<p>
<code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> will use a program like <code>objdump</code> or
<code>readelf</code> to find the libraries and the symbols in those libraries
directly needed by the binaries or shared libraries in the package.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr67" name="f67">67</a></h2>
<p>
The easiest way to call <code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> correctly is to use a
package helper framework such as <code>debhelper</code>. If you are using
<code>debhelper</code>, the <code>dh_shlibdeps</code> program will do this work
for you. It will also correctly handle multi-binary packages.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr68" name="f68">68</a></h2>
<p>
<code>dh_shlibdeps</code> from the <samp>debhelper</samp> suite will
automatically add this option if it knows it is processing a udeb.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr69" name="f69">69</a></h2>
<p>
Again, <code>dh_shlibdeps</code> and <code>dh_gencontrol</code> will handle
everything except the addition of the variable to the control file for you if
you're using <code>debhelper</code>, including generating separate
<code>substvars</code> files for each binary package and calling
<code>dpkg-gencontrol</code> with the appropriate flags.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr70" name="f70">70</a></h2>
<p>
A good example of where this helps is the following. We could update
<samp>libimlib</samp> with a new version that supports a new revision of a
graphics format called dgf (but retaining the same major version number) and
depends on a new library package <code>libdgf4</code> instead of the older
<code>libdgf3</code>. If we used <code>ldd</code> to add dependencies for
every library directly or indirectly linked with a binary, every package that
uses <samp>libimlib</samp> would need to be recompiled so it would also depend
on <code>libdgf4</code> in order to retire the older <code>libdgf3</code>
package. Since dependencies are only added based on ELF <samp>NEEDED</samp>
attribute, packages using <samp>libimlib</samp> can rely on
<samp>libimlib</samp> itself having the dependency on an appropriate version of
<samp>libdgf</samp> and do not need rebuilding.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr71" name="f71">71</a></h2>
<p>
An example of an "unreasonable" program is one that uses library
interfaces that are documented as internal and unsupported. If the only
programs or libraries affected by a change are "unreasonable" ones,
other techniques, such as declaring <samp>Breaks</samp> relationships with
affected packages or treating their usage of the library as bugs in those
packages, may be appropriate instead of changing the SONAME. However, the
default approach is to change the SONAME for any change to the ABI that could
break a program.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr72" name="f72">72</a></h2>
<p>
An example may clarify. Suppose the source package <samp>foo</samp> generates
two binary packages, <samp>libfoo2</samp> and <samp>foo-runtime</samp>. When
building the binary packages, the contents of the packages are staged in the
directories <code>debian/libfoo2</code> and <code>debian/foo-runtime</code>
respectively. (<code>debian/tmp</code> could be used instead of one of these.)
Since <samp>libfoo2</samp> provides the <samp>libfoo</samp> shared library, it
will contain a <samp>symbols</samp> file, which will be installed in
<code>debian/libfoo2/DEBIAN/symbols</code>, eventually to be included as a
control file in that package. When <code>dpkg-shlibdeps</code> is run on the
executable <code>debian/foo-runtime/usr/bin/foo-prog</code>, it will examine
the <code>debian/libfoo2/DEBIAN/symbols</code> file to determine whether
<samp>foo-prog</samp>'s library dependencies are satisfied by any of the
libraries provided by <samp>libfoo2</samp>. Since those binaries were linked
against the just-built shared library as part of the build process, the
<code>symbols</code> file for the newly-built <samp>libfoo2</samp> must take
precedence over a <code>symbols</code> file for any other <samp>libfoo2</samp>
package already installed on the system.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr73" name="f73">73</a></h2>
<p>
This can be determined by using the command
</p>
<pre>
readelf -d /usr/lib/libz.so.1.2.3.4 | grep SONAME
</pre>
<h2><a href="#fr74" name="f74">74</a></h2>
<p>
An example of where this may be needed is with a library that implements the
libGL interface. All GL implementations provide the same set of base
interfaces, and then may provide some additional interfaces only used by
programs that require that specific GL implementation. So, for example,
libgl1-mesa-glx may use the following <code>symbols</code> file:
</p>
<pre>
libGL.so.1 libgl1
| libgl1-mesa-glx #MINVER#
publicGlSymbol@Base 6.3-1
[...]
implementationSpecificSymbol@Base 6.5.2-7 1
[...]
</pre>
<p>
Binaries or shared libraries using only <samp>publicGlSymbol</samp> would
depend only on <samp>libgl1</samp> (which may be provided by multiple
packages), but ones using <samp>implementationSpecificSymbol</samp> would get a
dependency on <samp>libgl1-mesa-glx (>= 6.5.2-7)</samp>
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr75" name="f75">75</a></h2>
<p>
This field should normally not be necessary, since if the behavior of any
symbol has changed, the corresponding symbol <var>minimal-version</var> should
have been increased. But including it makes the <samp>symbols</samp> system
more robust by tightening the dependency in cases where the package using the
shared library specifically requires at least a particular version of the
shared library development package for some reason.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr76" name="f76">76</a></h2>
<p>
If you are using <samp>debhelper</samp>, <code>dh_makeshlibs</code> will take
care of calling either <code>dpkg-gensymbols</code> or generating a
<code>shlibs</code> file as appropriate.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr77" name="f77">77</a></h2>
<p>
This is what <code>dh_makeshlibs</code> in the <code>debhelper</code> suite
does. If your package also has a udeb that provides a shared library,
<code>dh_makeshlibs</code> can automatically generate the <samp>udeb:</samp>
lines if you specify the name of the udeb with the <samp>--add-udeb</samp>
option.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr78" name="f78">78</a></h2>
<p>
This is necessary in order to reserve the directories for use in
cross-installation of library packages from other architectures, as part of
<samp>multiarch</samp>.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr79" name="f79">79</a></h2>
<p>
This is necessary for architecture-dependant headers file to coexist in a
<samp>multiarch</samp> setup.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr80" name="f80">80</a></h2>
<p>
This directory is used as mount point to mount virtual filesystems to get
access to kernel information.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr81" name="f81">81</a></h2>
<p>
These directories are used to store translators and as a set of standard names
for mount points, respectively.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr82" name="f82">82</a></h2>
<p>
<samp>/lib/lsb/init-functions</samp>, which assists in writing LSB-compliant
init scripts, may fail if <samp>set -e</samp> is in effect and echoing status
messages to the console fails, for example.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr83" name="f83">83</a></h2>
<p>
Creating, modifying or removing a file in <code>/usr/lib/mime/packages/</code>
using maintainer scripts will not activate the trigger. In that case, it can
be done by calling <samp>dpkg-trigger --no-await /usr/lib/mime/packages</samp>
from the maintainer script after creating, modifying, or removing the file.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr84" name="f84">84</a></h2>
<p>
If you are using GCC, <samp>-fPIC</samp> produces code with relocatable
position independent code, which is required for most architectures to create a
shared library, with i386 and perhaps some others where non position
independent code is permitted in a shared library.
</p>
<p>
Position independent code may have a performance penalty, especially on
<samp>i386</samp>. However, in most cases the speed penalty must be measured
against the memory wasted on the few architectures where non position
independent code is even possible.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr85" name="f85">85</a></h2>
<p>
Some of the reasons why this might be required is if the library contains hand
crafted assembly code that is not relocatable, the speed penalty is excessive
for compute intensive libs, and similar reasons.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr86" name="f86">86</a></h2>
<p>
Some of the reasons for linking static libraries with the <samp>-fPIC</samp>
flag are if, for example, one needs a Perl API for a library that is under
rapid development, and has an unstable API, so shared libraries are pointless
at this phase of the library's development. In that case, since Perl needs a
library with relocatable code, it may make sense to create a static library
with relocatable code. Another reason cited is if you are distilling various
libraries into a common shared library, like <samp>mklibs</samp> does in the
Debian installer project.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr87" name="f87">87</a></h2>
<p>
You might also want to use the options <samp>--remove-section=.comment</samp>
and <samp>--remove-section=.note</samp> on both shared libraries and
executables, and <samp>--strip-debug</samp> on static libraries.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr88" name="f88">88</a></h2>
<p>
A common example are the so-called "plug-ins", internal shared
objects that are dynamically loaded by programs using <code>dlopen(3)</code>.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr89" name="f89">89</a></h2>
<p>
These files store, among other things, all libraries on which that shared
library depends. Unfortunately, if the <code>.la</code> file is present and
contains that dependency information, using <code>libtool</code> when linking
against that library will cause the resulting program or library to be linked
against those dependencies as well, even if this is unnecessary. This can
create unneeded dependencies on shared library packages that would otherwise be
hidden behind the library ABI, and can make library transitions to new SONAMEs
unnecessarily complicated and difficult to manage.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr90" name="f90">90</a></h2>
<p>
Single UNIX Specification, version 3, which is also IEEE 1003.1-2004 (POSIX),
and is available on the World Wide Web from <code><a
href="http://www.unix.org/version3/online.html">The Open Group</a></code> after
free registration.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr91" name="f91">91</a></h2>
<p>
These features are in widespread use in the Linux community and are implemented
in all of bash, dash, and ksh, the most common shells users may wish to use as
<code>/bin/sh</code>.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr92" name="f92">92</a></h2>
<p>
This is necessary to allow top-level directories to be symlinks. If linking
<code>/var/run</code> to <code>/run</code> were done with the relative symbolic
link <code>../run</code>, but <code>/var</code> were a symbolic link to
<code>/srv/disk1</code>, the symbolic link would point to <code>/srv/run</code>
rather than the intended target.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr93" name="f93">93</a></h2>
<p>
This notification could be done via a (low-priority) debconf message, or an
echo (printf) statement.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr94" name="f94">94</a></h2>
<p>
It's better to use <code>mkfifo</code> rather than <code>mknod</code> to create
named pipes so that automated checks for packages incorrectly creating device
files with <code>mknod</code> won't have false positives.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr95" name="f95">95</a></h2>
<p>
The <code>dpkg-maintscript-helper</code> tool, available from the
<code>dpkg</code> package, can help for this task.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr96" name="f96">96</a></h2>
<p>
Rationale: There are two problems with hard links. The first is that some
editors break the link while editing one of the files, so that the two files
may unwittingly become unlinked and different. The second is that
<code>dpkg</code> might break the hard link while upgrading
<samp>conffile</samp>s.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr97" name="f97">97</a></h2>
<p>
The traditional approach to log files has been to set up <em>ad hoc</em> log
rotation schemes using simple shell scripts and cron. While this approach is
highly customizable, it requires quite a lot of sysadmin work. Even though the
original Debian system helped a little by automatically installing a system
which can be used as a template, this was deemed not enough.
</p>
<p>
The use of <code>logrotate</code>, a program developed by Red Hat, is better,
as it centralizes log management. It has both a configuration file
(<code>/etc/logrotate.conf</code>) and a directory where packages can drop
their individual log rotation configurations (<code>/etc/logrotate.d</code>).
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr98" name="f98">98</a></h2>
<p>
When a package is upgraded, and the owner or permissions of a file included in
the package has changed, dpkg arranges for the ownership and permissions to be
correctly set upon installation. However, this does not extend to directories;
the permissions and ownership of directories already on the system does not
change on install or upgrade of packages. This makes sense, since otherwise
common directories like <samp>/usr</samp> would always be in flux. To
correctly change permissions of a directory the package owns, explicit action
is required, usually in the <samp>postinst</samp> script. Care must be taken
to handle downgrades as well, in that case.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr99" name="f99">99</a></h2>
<p>
Ordinary files installed by <code>dpkg</code> (as opposed to
<samp>conffile</samp>s and other similar objects) normally have their
permissions reset to the distributed permissions when the package is
reinstalled. However, the use of <code>dpkg-statoverride</code> overrides this
default behavior.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr100" name="f100">100</a></h2>
<p>
Internally, the package system normalizes the GNU triplets and the Debian
arches into Debian arch triplets (which are kind of inverted GNU triplets),
with the first component of the triplet representing the libc and ABI in use,
and then does matching against those triplets. However, such triplets are an
internal implementation detail that should not be used by packages directly.
The libc and ABI portion is handled internally by the package system based on
the <var>os</var> and <var>cpu</var>.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr101" name="f101">101</a></h2>
<p>
The Debian base system already provides an editor and a pager program.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr102" name="f102">102</a></h2>
<p>
If it is not possible to establish both locks, the system shouldn't wait for
the second lock to be established, but remove the first lock, wait a (random)
time, and start over locking again.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr103" name="f103">103</a></h2>
<p>
You will need to depend on <samp>liblockfile1 (>>1.01)</samp> to use
these functions.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr104" name="f104">104</a></h2>
<p>
There are two traditional permission schemes for mail spools: mode 600 with all
mail delivery done by processes running as the destination user, or mode 660
and owned by group mail with mail delivery done by a process running as a
system user in group mail. Historically, Debian required mode 660 mail spools
to enable the latter model, but that model has become increasingly uncommon and
the principle of least privilege indicates that mail systems that use the first
model should use permissions of 600. If delivery to programs is permitted,
it's easier to keep the mail system secure if the delivery agent runs as the
destination user. Debian Policy therefore permits either scheme.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr105" name="f105">105</a></h2>
<p>
This implements current practice, and provides an actual policy for usage of
the <samp>xserver</samp> virtual package which appears in the virtual packages
list. In a nutshell, X servers that interface directly with the display and
input hardware or via another subsystem (e.g., GGI) should provide
<samp>xserver</samp>. Things like <samp>Xvfb</samp>, <samp>Xnest</samp>, and
<samp>Xprt</samp> should not.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr106" name="f106">106</a></h2>
<p>
"New terminal window" does not necessarily mean a new top-level X
window directly parented by the window manager; it could, if the terminal
emulator application were so coded, be a new "view" in a
multiple-document interface (MDI).
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr107" name="f107">107</a></h2>
<p>
For the purposes of Debian Policy, a "font for the X Window System"
is one which is accessed via X protocol requests. Fonts for the Linux console,
for PostScript renderer, or any other purpose, do not fit this definition. Any
tool which makes such fonts available to the X Window System, however, must
abide by this font policy.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr108" name="f108">108</a></h2>
<p>
This is because the X server may retrieve fonts from the local file system or
over the network from an X font server; the Debian package system is empowered
to deal only with the local file system.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr109" name="f109">109</a></h2>
<p>
Note that this mechanism is not the same as using app-defaults; app-defaults
are tied to the client binary on the local file system, whereas X resources are
stored in the X server and affect all connecting clients.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr110" name="f110">110</a></h2>
<p>
It is not very hard to write a man page. See the <code><a
href="http://www.schweikhardt.net/man_page_howto.html">Man-Page-HOWTO</a></code>,
<code>man(7)</code>, the examples created by <code>dh_make</code>, the helper
program <code>help2man</code>, or the directory
<code>/usr/share/doc/man-db/examples</code>.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr111" name="f111">111</a></h2>
<p>
Supporting this in <code>man</code> often requires unreasonable processing time
to find a manual page or to report that none exists, and moves knowledge into
man's database that would be better left in the file system. This support is
therefore deprecated and will cease to be present in the future.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr112" name="f112">112</a></h2>
<p>
<code>man</code> will automatically detect whether UTF-8 is in use. In future,
all manual pages will be required to use UTF-8.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr113" name="f113">113</a></h2>
<p>
At the time of writing, Chinese and Portuguese are the main languages with such
differences, so <code>pt_BR</code>, <code>zh_CN</code>, and <code>zh_TW</code>
are all allowed.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr114" name="f114">114</a></h2>
<p>
Normally, info documents are generated from Texinfo source. To include this
information in the generated info document, if it is absent, add commands like:
</p>
<pre>
@dircategory Individual utilities
@direntry
* example: (example). An example info directory entry.
@end direntry
</pre>
<p>
to the Texinfo source of the document and ensure that the info documents are
rebuilt from source during the package build.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr115" name="f115">115</a></h2>
<p>
The system administrator should be able to delete files in
<code>/usr/share/doc/</code> without causing any programs to break.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr116" name="f116">116</a></h2>
<p>
Please note that this does not override the section on changelog files below,
so the file <code>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.Debian.gz</code>
must refer to the changelog for the current version of <var>package</var> in
question. In practice, this means that the sources of the target and the
destination of the symlink must be the same (same source package and version).
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr117" name="f117">117</a></h2>
<p>
Rationale: The important thing here is that HTML documentation should be
available from <em>some</em> binary package.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr118" name="f118">118</a></h2>
<p>
In particular, <code>/usr/share/common-licenses/Apache-2.0</code>,
<code>/usr/share/common-licenses/Artistic</code>,
<code>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL-1</code>,
<code>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL-2</code>,
<code>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL-3</code>,
<code>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-2</code>,
<code>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-2.1</code>,
<code>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-3</code>,
<code>/usr/share/common-licenses/GFDL-1.2</code>, and
<code>/usr/share/common-licenses/GFDL-1.3</code> respectively. The University
of California BSD license is also included in <code>base-files</code> as
<code>/usr/share/common-licenses/BSD</code>, but given the brevity of this
license, its specificity to code whose copyright is held by the Regents of the
University of California, and the frequency of minor wording changes, its text
should be included in the copyright file rather than referencing this file.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr119" name="f119">119</a></h2>
<p>
Rationale: People should not have to look in places for upstream changelogs
merely because they are given different names or are distributed in HTML
format.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr120" name="f120">120</a></h2>
<p>
<code>dpkg</code> is targeted primarily at Debian, but may work on or be ported
to other systems.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr121" name="f121">121</a></h2>
<p>
This is so that the control file which is produced has the right permissions
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr122" name="f122">122</a></h2>
<p>
This is not currently detected when building source packages, but only when
extracting them.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr123" name="f123">123</a></h2>
<p>
Hard links may be permitted at some point in the future, but would require a
fair amount of work.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr124" name="f124">124</a></h2>
<p>
Setgid directories are allowed.
</p>
<h2><a href="#fr125" name="f125">125</a></h2>
<p>
Renaming a file is not treated specially - it is seen as the removal of the old
file (which generates a warning, but is otherwise ignored), and the creation of
the new one.
</p>
<hr>
<p>
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">previous</a> ]
[ <a href="#contents">Contents</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">1</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-archive">2</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-binary">3</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-source">4</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-controlfields">5</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-maintainerscripts">6</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-relationships">7</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-sharedlibs">8</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-opersys">9</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-files">10</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-customized-programs">11</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-docs">12</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-scope">A</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-binarypkg">B</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-sourcepkg">C</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-controlfields">D</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-conffiles">E</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-alternatives">F</a> ]
[ <a href="#ap-pkg-diversions">G</a> ]
[ <a href="#ch-scope">next</a> ]
</p>
<hr>
<p>
Debian Policy Manual
</p>
<address>
version 3.9.8.0, 2016-04-06<br>
<br>
<a href="#s-authors">The Debian Policy Mailing List</a><br>
<br>
</address>
<hr>
</body>
</html>
|